PC_Programming_Manual
PC_Programming_Manual
Manuals and supporting information are provided on the Panasonic Web site at:
http://panasonic.net/pcc/support/pbx/
Introduction
Introduction
About this Programming Manual
The PC Programming Manual is designed to serve as a system programming reference for the Panasonic
Pure IP-PBX. It explains how to programme this PBX using Web Maintenance Console.
The PC Programming Manual is divided into the following sections:
Section 1, Overview
Provides an overview of programming the PBX.
Trademarks
• Microsoft, Outlook, Internet Explorer, Windows and Windows Vista are either registered trademarks or
trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries.
• Intel and Intel Core are trademarks of Intel Corporation in the U.S. and other countries.
• Mozilla and Firefox are registered trademarks of the Mozilla Foundation.
2 PC Programming Manual
Introduction
• All other trademarks identified herein are the property of their respective owners.
• Microsoft product screen shot(s) reprinted with permission from Microsoft Corporation.
Notice
• During a long programming session, it is highly recommended that you periodically save the system data
to the Storage Memory Card. If the PBX undergoes a sudden power failure or if the system is reset for
some reason, all the system data in RAM will be lost. However, if system data has been saved to the
Storage Memory Card, it can be easily reloaded.
• To save the system data to the Storage Memory Card, (1) click the button on the Home screen of Web
Maintenance Console before resetting the PBX or turning off the power, or (2) logout from Web
Maintenance Console so that the PBX automatically saves the system data.
NOTES
• The contents of this manual apply to PBXs with a certain software version, as indicated on the cover of
this manual. To confirm the software version of your PBX, see How do I confirm the software version
of the PBX or installed cards? in Maintenance Console Software in 2.3 Frequently Asked Questions
(FAQ).
• Some optional hardware, software, and features are not available in some countries/areas, or for some
PBX models. Please consult your certified Panasonic dealer for more information.
• Product specifications, including text displayed by the software, are subject to change without notice.
• In this manual, the suffix of each model number (e.g., KX-NS1000NE) is omitted unless necessary.
• Operation of the KX-NS0154 depends on the PBX software file version and the firmware version of the
KX-NS0154. You can confirm the compatibility on the Panasonic Web site:
http://panasonic.net/pcc/support/pbx
PC Programming Manual 3
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
1 Overview .................................................................................................13
1.1 Introduction .....................................................................................................................14
1.1.1 For Your Safety ..............................................................................................................14
1.1.2 Introduction .....................................................................................................................16
1.1.3 Entering Characters .......................................................................................................17
1.2 PC Programming .............................................................................................................21
1.2.1 Starting Web Maintenance Console ...............................................................................21
1.2.2 PC Programming Using Off-line Mode ...........................................................................25
1.2.2.1 Editing and Printing Terminal Labels in Off-line Mode ................................................30
1.2.3 PBX Configuration Types ...............................................................................................31
1.2.3.1 One-look Networking Survivability ...............................................................................33
2 Introduction of Web Maintenance Console .........................................35
2.1 Introduction .....................................................................................................................36
2.1.1 Web Maintenance Console Accounts ............................................................................36
2.1.2 Access Levels ................................................................................................................38
2.1.3 Logging in to Web Maintenance Console .......................................................................42
2.1.4 Easy Setup Wizard .........................................................................................................43
2.1.5 Software Interface ..........................................................................................................44
2.1.6 Card Status ....................................................................................................................48
2.1.7 Extension Number Setting ..............................................................................................49
2.2 Logout ..............................................................................................................................50
2.3 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ) ..............................................................................51
3 Web Maintenance Console Home Screen ............................................61
3.1 Home Screen ...................................................................................................................62
3.1.1 Home Screen—Add Site Wizard ....................................................................................65
4 Status ......................................................................................................67
4.1 Status—Equipment Status .............................................................................................68
4.1.1 Status—Equipment Status—UPS ..................................................................................68
4.1.2 Status—Equipment Status—CS Information ..................................................................69
4.1.3 Status—Equipment Status—PS Information ..................................................................70
4.1.4 Status—Equipment Status—UM Port status ..................................................................71
4.1.5 Status—Equipment Status—USB ..................................................................................72
5 System Control .......................................................................................73
5.1 System Control—Program Update ................................................................................74
5.1.1 System Control—Program Update—Download Program File ........................................76
5.1.2 System Control—Program Update—Update Program File ............................................78
5.1.3 System Control—Program Update—Plug and Update ..................................................80
5.2 System Control—MOH ....................................................................................................81
5.2.1 System Control—MOH—Install ......................................................................................81
5.2.2 System Control—MOH—Delete .....................................................................................82
5.2.3 System Control—MOH—Status / Backup ......................................................................83
5.3 System Control—FAX Card ............................................................................................84
5.4 System Control—System Reset ....................................................................................85
5.5 System Control—System Shutdown .............................................................................86
6 Tool ..........................................................................................................87
6.1 Tool—System Data Backup ...........................................................................................88
6.1.1 Tool—System Data Backup—Backup to USB ...............................................................88
4 PC Programming Manual
Table of Contents
PC Programming Manual 5
Table of Contents
6 PC Programming Manual
Table of Contents
PC Programming Manual 7
Table of Contents
8 PC Programming Manual
Table of Contents
PC Programming Manual 9
Table of Contents
10 PC Programming Manual
Table of Contents
PC Programming Manual 11
Table of Contents
12 PC Programming Manual
Section 1
Overview
PC Programming Manual 13
1.1.1 For Your Safety
1.1 Introduction
The following types of symbols are used to classify and describe the type of instructions to be
observed.
This symbol is used to alert users to a specific operating procedure that must not be performed.
This symbol is used to alert users to a specific operating procedure that must be followed in
order to operate the unit safely.
14 PC Programming Manual
1.1.1 For Your Safety
WARNING
• Unplug the PBX from the AC outlet if it emits smoke, an abnormal smell or makes unusual noise. These
conditions can cause fire or electric shock. Confirm that smoke has stopped and contact an authorised
Panasonic Factory Service Centre.
CAUTION
• Do not remove the Storage Memory Card while power is supplied to the PBX. Doing so may cause the
PBX to fail to start when you try to restart the system.
PC Programming Manual 15
1.1.2 Introduction
1.1.2 Introduction
These programming instructions are designed to serve as an overall system programming reference for the
PBX. Each feature in the PBX has default settings that can be changed to customise the PBX to your
requirements. These settings control the functions of the PBX, and changing them is referred to as "system
programming".
Programming can be performed by system installers, on-site managers, and individual users. However,
managers and individual users may only change a limited number of settings. For details, see 2.1.1 Web
Maintenance Console Accounts.
All features and settings of the PBX can be programmed through system programming with Web Maintenance
Console. Starting Web Maintenance Console is described in 1.2 PC Programming. Individual system
programming items are described from Section 3 Web Maintenance Console Home Screen.
Programming Modes
There are two different modes available for programming using Web Maintenance Console:
• On-line Mode
On-line mode allows you to use Web Maintenance Console on a PC that is connected to the PBX to modify
the system data and settings used by the PBX. Settings can be modified and results are displayed in real
time. Modifications to settings change the information in the PBX’s temporary memory (DRAM). To finalise
the changes, you must either save the changes to the PBX’s Storage Memory Card by clicking or log
out of Web Maintenance Console by clicking . For details, see Web Maintenance Console Features
in 2.1.5 Software Interface.
• Off-line Mode
Off-line mode allows you to connect to a version of Web Maintenance Console running on your PC. Using
Off-line mode, you can create new system data files and make modifications to system data files stored
on your PC, without being connected to the PBX. After you finish configuring settings, they can be saved
and uploaded to the PBX, which will update the PBX’s settings. For details, see Uploading Programmed
Settings to the PBX in 1.2.2 PC Programming Using Off-line Mode.
16 PC Programming Manual
1.1.3 Entering Characters
Table 1 (Standard)
PC Programming Manual 17
1.1.3 Entering Characters
18 PC Programming Manual
1.1.3 Entering Characters
PC Programming Manual 19
1.1.3 Entering Characters
20 PC Programming Manual
1.2.1 Starting Web Maintenance Console
1.2 PC Programming
System Requirements
Required Operating System
• Microsoft® Windows® Vista® Business, Windows 7, Windows 8, Windows 8 Professional, Windows 8.1 or
Windows 8.1 Professional operating system
Note
In Windows 8 / 8.1 and Windows 8 / 8.1 Professional, Web Maintenance Console runs only in desktop
mode. It is not available from the Windows 8 / 8.1 Start screen.
Always apply the latest updates to your Web browser software. For details, refer to your Web browser’s
documentation. Only the browsers and browser versions listed above are supported for use with Web
Maintenance Console.
Note
When using Windows Internet Explorer, there may be a delay when displaying some screens of Web
Maintenance Console. A message may be displayed that reads "Stop running this script?". This message
is automatically displayed when a script takes a long time to complete. If this message is displayed, click
No to continue using Web Maintenance Console. If you click Yes, you will have to close the browser window
for Web Maintenance Console and log in again. For information about disabling this prompt, refer to your
Web browser’s on-line support resources.
Browser Setting Requirements
The following functions must be enabled in the Web browser’s settings to use Web Maintenance Console:
• SSL 3.0
• Cookies
• JavaScript
• The ability to download files
• The display of animations
• The display of images
PC Programming Manual 21
1.2.1 Starting Web Maintenance Console
For details regarding the above settings, refer to your Web browser’s documentation.
Recommended Specification
Copyright (C) 1991-2, RSA Data Security, Inc. Created 1991. All rights reserved.
Licence to copy and use this software is granted provided that it is identified as the "RSA Data Security, Inc.
MD5 Message-Digest Algorithm" in all material mentioning or referencing this software or this function.
Licence is also granted to make and use derivative works provided that such works are identified as "derived
from the RSA Data Security, Inc. MD5 Message-Digest Algorithm" in all material mentioning or referencing the
derived work.
RSA Data Security, Inc. makes no representations concerning either the merchantability of this software or
the suitability of this software for any particular purpose. It is provided "as is" without express or implied warranty
of any kind.
These notices must be retained in any copies of any part of this documentation and/or software.
Note
• When connecting to Web Maintenance Console over the Internet, the use of an encrypted
communication method, such as SSL, is strongly recommended. For details, contact your network’s
administrator.
22 PC Programming Manual
1.2.1 Starting Web Maintenance Console
Notice
• When connecting the PC to the MNT port, if the PC is set to obtain the IP address automatically,
the IP address of the PC will be set to an appropriate IP address to establish a connection to the
PBX. For more information about the connection procedure, refer to "5.2 PC Connection" in the
Installation Manual.
2. Access Web Maintenance Console:
MNT Port connection:
Launch your Web browser and in the address bar, enter one of the following addresses exactly as shown:
– 223.0.0.1
or
– http://kx-ns1000.
Note
• If entering "http://kx-ns1000.", be sure to include the period at the end as shown.
• If connecting using 223.0.0.1 takes a long time, configure a static IP address for the PC.
Note
• The IP address and Web Maintenance Console port number for the PBX can be changed from
their default values. If settings for the LAN port’s IP address or port number have been forgotten,
connect using the MNT port connection as described above and confirm the LAN port’s IP address
in 28.1 Network Service—[1] IP Address/Ports—Basic Settings, and the port in 28.2.3 Network
Service—[2-4] Server Feature—HTTP.
• You can also connect to the PBX in On-line mode using the Off-line Web Maintenance Console
Programme Launcher. For details, see Connecting in On-line Mode using the Programme
Launcher in 1.2.2 PC Programming Using Off-line Mode.
PC Programming Manual 23
1.2.1 Starting Web Maintenance Console
3. The Web Maintenance Console login screen is displayed. For details about logging in, see 2.1.3 Logging
in to Web Maintenance Console.
• If this is the first time the PBX is accessed (i.e., it is in its initialised, factory default state), you must log
in using the Installer level account. Once you log in, the Easy Setup Wizard will launch. For details,
see 2.1.4 Easy Setup Wizard.
• If the PBX has been set up using the Easy Setup Wizard, PBX system programming can be performed.
To perform programming, enter the login name and password according to your status and
authorisation level. For details about the differences between levels of authorisation, see 2.1.1 Web
Maintenance Console Accounts.
4. After you successfully log in to Web Maintenance Console, the Home screen will be displayed and
programming can be performed. For details about accessing the different features of Web Maintenance
Console, see 2.1.5 Software Interface.
24 PC Programming Manual
1.2.2 PC Programming Using Off-line Mode
Installation
Note
• Be sure to install and use the latest version of "Off-line WEB-Maintenance Console".
• Before beginning the installation of Off-line Web Maintenance Console, the following software must be
installed on the PC:
– Microsoft .NET Framework 2.0
– Microsoft .NET Framework 4
This software can be downloaded from Microsoft’s online Download Center.
• To install or uninstall the software on a PC running Windows Vista Business, Windows 7, Windows 8,
Windows 8 Professional, Windows 8.1, or Windows 8.1 Professional, you must be logged in as a user
in the "Administrators" group.
1. Copy the "Off-line WEB-Maintenance Console" setup file to your PC.
2. Double-click the setup file to run the installer.
3. Follow the on-screen instructions provided by the installation wizard.
PC Programming Manual 25
1.2.2 PC Programming Using Off-line Mode
Note
Off-line Web Maintenance Console cannot be used when the PBX Web Manager for Unified PC
Maintenance Console (for KX-TDA/KX-TDE/KX-NCP PBXs) is running on the PC.
To disable the PBX Web Manager:
1. In the Unified PC Maintenance Console launcher, click Option®PBX Web Manager.
2. Deselect the Enable Web Server check box.
3. Click OK.
Starting a New System Data File
You can start a new session of PBX programming in Off-line mode. You can then programme PBX settings in
Off-line Web Maintenance Console and then save them to a file you can later upload to the PBX.
Note
Since selecting this option creates a blank system data file, uploading this file to the PBX will overwrite all
previous settings. Use this function only when necessary.
26 PC Programming Manual
1.2.2 PC Programming Using Off-line Mode
Notice
Only system data created using software version 001.10000 or later can be converted this way. System
data created using software version 001.00000 cannot be converted.
Options
You can specify the display language of the Programme Launcher, as well as set the web server port number
for Off-line Web Maintenance Console. In the Programme Launcher, click Options and change the settings
as necessary.
Adding Additional Languages
PC Programming Manual 27
1.2.2 PC Programming Using Off-line Mode
Additional display language files may be made available. To add a display language not listed in the language
selection menu, select Additional language, and then click Browse to specify the language file. After
specifying a language file, click OK to change to the selected language.
IP Terminal Utility
Click the IP Terminal button to launch the IP Terminal setup utility. This utility is identical to the IP Terminal
utility included with the Unified PC Maintenance Console for KX-TDA/KX-TDE/KX-NCP PBXs.
Some items are not programmable when in Off-line mode, and those items will be greyed out. Some tools and
utilities are also not available in Off-line mode. For details, refer to 2.1.2 Access Levels.
Notice
• In Off-line mode, changes made in 6.8 Tool—Screen Customise will not be reflected in On-line mode.
This is because these settings are not stored in the system data file (DCSYS).
• When you load the system data file to the PBX, you must install any required activation keys in On-line
mode. Activation keys are required for mailboxes. Settings such as mailbox passwords will be cleared
if the number of activation keys for mailboxes is insufficient.
28 PC Programming Manual
1.2.2 PC Programming Using Off-line Mode
Notice
• If the PC running the Off-line Web Maintenance Console is shut down, the Web browser is closed, or
the user logs out, any changes that have not been saved will be lost. Be sure to regularly save data
while programming.
• When you upload a system setting file to the PBX, all existing settings on the PBX will be overwritten
with the settings in the file, including settings you may not want to change. To change only specific
settings in Off-line mode, follow the procedure below:
1. Use the "File Transfer PBX to PC" utility in On-line mode to save a file with the PBX’s current
settings. For details, refer to 7.2.2 Utility—File—File Transfer PBX to PC.
2. Use the Open -Offline Mode command in the Programme Launcher to load the PBX system file
in Off-line mode.
For details, refer to Opening an Existing System Data File above.
3. Perform the desired programming in Off-line mode, and then click the icon to save the modified
system settings to your PC.
4. Log in to Web Maintenance Console in On-line mode, and then use the "File Transfer PC to
PBX" utility to upload the modified data to the PBX.
• When programming in Off-line mode, be careful when programming the following parameters:
– 20.1.2 UM Configuration—[1-2] Mailbox Settings—Full Setting—Mailbox Parameters—
Mailbox Password (Message Client)
– 20.1.2 UM Configuration—[1-2] Mailbox Settings—Full Setting—Notification
Parameters— E-mail/Text Message Device—Device No. 1, 2, 3—E-mail Address
These parameters require an activation key (KX-NSU2xx) to function. If these items are programmed
in Off-line mode, but the PBX does not have the required activation key installed, the values specified
for these parameters will be cleared when the data is uploaded to the PBX.
PC Programming Manual 29
1.2.2 PC Programming Using Off-line Mode
4. Once the settings have been configured, click Key Label Print on the settings screen. Follow the Key
Label Print Wizard to print the key labels or to output the data as a PDF file.
30 PC Programming Manual
1.2.3 PBX Configuration Types
Global Data Global data is related to the function of the PBX network as a whole. These settings
are unified network-wide, including extension and calling configurations.
Local Data Local data is related to the settings and functions of each Slave unit PBX. Local
data includes UM configuration settings and network settings.
Connection Connection data includes setting information for connecting the Master unit to
Data Slave units in the One-look network.
Note
When a single KX-NS1000 is used in a stand-alone configuration or other
networking configuration, for programming purposes it still must be set as the
Master unit.
Slave Unit Slave units receive programming information from the Master unit for all
system-wide functions, such as extension information and call handling. Each
Slave unit also contains local data programming settings, but these local settings
are still specified using the Master unit. When you log in to a Slave unit, you may
view all global data settings, but only that Slave unit’s local data and connection
data may be viewed. The only setting data that can be specified using a Slave unit
is connection data.
If a Slave unit is set to OUS, its resources cannot be used but otherwise the
One-look network will still function. The resources of the OUS Slave unit may be
used again when it is returned to INS status.
PC Programming Manual 31
1.2.3 PBX Configuration Types
32 PC Programming Manual
1.2.3 PBX Configuration Types
PC Programming Manual 33
1.2.3 PBX Configuration Types
34 PC Programming Manual
Section 2
Introduction of Web Maintenance Console
PC Programming Manual 35
2.1.1 Web Maintenance Console Accounts
2.1 Introduction
*1
The total number of administrator and user accounts combined cannot exceed 1512.
Note
• User (User) accounts cannot be used when programming in Off-line mode. For details, refer to
1.2.2 PC Programming Using Off-line Mode.
36 PC Programming Manual
2.1.1 Web Maintenance Console Accounts
For more information about creating and managing end user accounts, see Section 8 Users.
CAUTION
To the Administrator or Installer regarding account passwords
1. Please provide all system passwords to the customer.
2. To avoid unauthorised access and possible abuse of the PBX, keep the passwords secret, and inform
the customer of the importance of the passwords, and the possible dangers if they become known to
others.
3. The PBX has no passwords set initially. For security, select an installer password as soon as the PBX
system is installed at the site.
4. Change the passwords periodically.
5. It is strongly recommended that passwords of 10 numbers or characters be used for maximum
protection against unauthorised access.
PC Programming Manual 37
2.1.2 Access Levels
The options available for each programming mode and access level are shown below.
The access levels are abbreviated as follows:
U: User (User); A: User (Administrator); I: Installer
Note
User (User) accounts cannot be used when programming in Off-line mode.
A check mark indicates that the menu option is available for that access level.
Home Screen
Menu Option Off-line On-line
A I U A I
Site Selection ü ü ü ü ü
Add Site ü ü
System Information ü ü ü ü ü
Logout ü ü ü ü ü
Tool
Menu Option Off-line On-line
A I U A I
38 PC Programming Manual
2.1.2 Access Levels
A I U A I
Import®Quick Dial ü ü
Import®SIP Extension ü ü
Import®V-IPGW16 GW Settings ü ü
Import®V-IPGW16 DN2IP ü ü
Import®V-SIPGW16 Settings ü ü
Import®V-SIPGW16 Provider ü ü
Export®Feature - Speed Dial and Caller ID ü ü ü ü
Export®Incoming Call - DDI/DID Table ü ü
Export®ARS - Leading Digit ü ü
Export®ARS - Except Code ü ü
Export®ARS - Routing Plan ü ü
Export®Wired Extension ü ü
Export®PS Extension ü ü
Export®Quick Dial ü ü
Export®SIP Extension ü ü
Export®V-IPGW16 GW Settings ü ü
Export®V-IPGW16 DN2IP ü ü
Export®V-SIPGW16 Settings ü ü
Export®V-SIPGW16 Provider ü ü
Screen Customise ü ü
UM Data Backup ü
UM Data Restore ü
UM Backup History ü
DXDP All OUS ü
Contact information ü ü ü ü
UT Option Setting ü ü
URL Information ü ü
Utility
Menu Option Off-line On-line
A I U A I
Diagnosis®Card Diagnosis ü ü
PC Programming Manual 39
2.1.2 Access Levels
A I U A I
Diagnosis®Ping ü
File Transfer PC to PBX ü
File Transfer PBX to PC ü
File View ü
File Delete ü
Message File Transfer PC to PBX ü
Message File Transfer PBX to PC ü
Error Log ü ü
Syslog ü
Web-MC Event Log ü ü
UM System Log ü
ISDN/QSIG Protocol Trace ü
V-IPGW16 Protocol Trace ü
V-SIPGW16 Protocol Trace ü
Air Sync Group ü
LAN Sync Group ü
Fax - Protocol Trace ü
Fax - Task sequence Trace ü
UM System Trace (Internal) ü
T1/E1 Signalling Bit Monitor ü
T1/E1 Line Trace ü
Digital Trunk Error Report ü
IP Extension Statistical Information ü
UM View Reports ü ü
E-mail Report ü ü
IP-CS Information ® IP-CS Statistical Information ü
IP-CS Information ® LAN Sync Information ü
Activation Key Installation ü
Email Notification—Alert ü ü
Email Notification—System Analysis ü
Email Notification—Test Email ü
40 PC Programming Manual
2.1.2 Access Levels
A I U A I
UM Command ü
Router Command ü
UM – System Prompts Customisation ü ü
Automatic Two-way Recording ü ü ü ü
UM - System Maintenance ü ü
CS-Web Connection ü ü
PC Programming Manual 41
2.1.3 Logging in to Web Maintenance Console
Login Screen
Login Restrictions
• Up to 32 User (User) and User (Administrator) level accounts may log in at one time to Web Maintenance
Console in On-line mode.
• Only 1 user may log in using the Installer level account at a time. If someone using the Installer level account
is logged in to Web Maintenance Console and is making changes, and another user logs in using the
Installer level account, the user logging in may override the other logged-in user so that programming can
be performed (a warning screen will be displayed for the user that is about to override the currently
logged-in user).
• Users can view only menus and setting items they may access according to their account level. For User
(Administrator) level accounts, the items that can be viewed can be set by the Installer level account. For
details, see 6.8 Tool—Screen Customise.
• If two logged-in users change the same setting, the change made last will be the effective setting.
• If a user attempts to log in, but enters an incorrect password three times, the failure is recorded in the error
log of the PBX and the user may not attempt to log in again for a 5-minute period.
42 PC Programming Manual
2.1.4 Easy Setup Wizard
PC Programming Manual 43
2.1.5 Software Interface
Main Window
When you log in to Web Maintenance Console, the main window is displayed. For information about connecting
to Web Maintenance Console and logging in, see 1.2.1 Starting Web Maintenance Console.
The main window of Web Maintenance Console is divided into several areas, as shown below:
2
1 3
Button Description
Clicking this button will load the Home Screen. From the Home Screen, you can:
• View the status of connected PBXs in the One-look network
• Add PBXs to your One-look network
• Select a PBX to perform programming
For more information, see 3.1 Home Screen.
Home Screen
Clicking this button will display the Maintenance Screen tree view items. From the
Maintenance Screen, you can:
• Check the status and equipment of the selected PBX
• Backup or update PBX system files
• Use tools and reports to monitor and analyse system usage
Maintenance For more information, see Maintenance Screen Tree View Items below.
Screen
44 PC Programming Manual
2.1.5 Software Interface
Button Description
Clicking this button will display the Setup Screen tree view items. From the Setup
Screen, you can:
• Configure PBX hardware and virtual cards
• Programme settings for extensions and call handling
• Configure network settings and auxiliary PBX functions
Setup Screen
• Configure the Unified Messaging (UM) system
For more information, see Setup Screen Tree View Items below.
Button Description
Clicking this button will save any changes made to settings to the Storage Memory
Card. Programming changes that are not saved will be lost if the PBX is reset or is
turned off. Changes may also be lost if Web Maintenance Console is suddenly
Save Data terminated or the PC running Web Maintenance Console loses power unexpectedly.
Be sure to save the data periodically while programming, especially during long
programming sessions.
Clicking this button displays the Web Maintenance Console software version,
copyright notices, and licences.
System Note
Information Licence information is not displayed when programming in Off-line mode.
Clicking this button will save any programming changes to the PBX’s Storage Memory
Card and log you out of Web Maintenance Console. For more information, see
2.2 Logout.
Logout
PC Programming Manual 45
2.1.5 Software Interface
Users • Manage, view, and add PBX user profiles and account information
For details, see Section 8 Users.
PBX Configuration • Configure PBX hardware settings for cards, equipment, and networking
• Configure network-wide programming such as BGM and Class of Service
• Configure dialling features, call routing, and incoming call settings
• Configure call logging (SMDR) and other PBX maintenance items
For details, see Section 9 PBX Configuration—[1] Configuration to
Section 19 PBX Configuration—[11] Maintenance.
UM Configuration • Configure Unified Messaging mailboxes and voice mail subscriber settings
• Configure service settings and system parameters
• Configure hardware options
For details, see Section 20 UM Configuration—[1] Mailbox Settings to
Section 26 UM Configuration—[7] System Security.
Router • Confirm the status of the built-in router and its settings
Configuration • Configure built-in router settings and connections
• Configure WAN/LAN settings for the built-in router
• Configure security for the built-in router, such as a firewall
For details, see Section 27 Router Configuration.
Network Service • Configure server and client features for the PBX
• Configure connections settings and network security
For details, see Section 28 Network Service.
46 PC Programming Manual
2.1.5 Software Interface
Note
On some screens, the site selection menu will be inactive. This means that the currently displayed
programming items are set for the Master unit PBX only, and cannot be set for each Slave unit.
Standard Buttons
There are standard buttons that are displayed on many screens within the Maintenance Console.
The standard buttons are as follows:
Button Function
Individual items can also be copied and pasted in a manner similar to other software programmes. Press
"Ctrl"+"c" to copy a highlighted (orange-coloured) programming item entry, select a target cell by pressing the
keyboard arrow keys, and then press "Ctrl"+"v" to paste the copied information to the selected cell.
PC Programming Manual 47
2.1.6 Card Status
48 PC Programming Manual
2.1.7 Extension Number Setting
To select multiple extension numbers, select the type of extension to display, highlight the extensions you wish
to add, then click the Add button. When finished, click OK. Data for the selected extensions will be added to
the first free spaces on the original screen.
Extension Type
Selects the types of extension numbers to display in Extension Numbers & Names List. Multiple items
can be selected. Items that are not available are shown with a grey checkbox.
Value Range
Wired Extension, Portable Station, ICD Group, PS Ring Group, OGM (DISA), External Pager, Fax Unit, UM /
VM Extension, UM Group, VM(DPT) Group, VM(DTMF) Group
Value Range
Matching extensions
Available Column
Specifies which fields in the original form to add extension data to. For example, if both extension numbers
and names can be entered in the original form, it is possible to specify that extension name data not be
transferred, by deselecting that field here.
To select or deselect a field, click its name.
Value Range
Available fields
Value Range
Selected extensions
PC Programming Manual 49
2.2 Logout
2.2 Logout
To logout of Web Maintenance Console, click the button to end the programming session and return to the
Login screen. When this option is chosen, system data is automatically saved from the temporary memory
(DRAM) of the PBX to the Storage Memory Card.
To logout
1. Click the button.
A confirmation message will be displayed.
2. Click Yes.
Note
• If the PC running the Web browser that is connected to Web Maintenance Console is shut down, or
the Web browser is closed, any changes that have not been saved to the Storage Memory Card will
be lost. To save settings while programming, click the button on the Home screen. Always end your
programming session by clicking the button.
• If you are logged in but do not perform any operations in Web Maintenance Console for 60 minutes
(default value), you will be automatically logged out.
50 PC Programming Manual
2.3 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ)
Title Description
Connection
Q The Maintenance Console cannot connect to the PBX via a LAN connection.
A • Is the PC connected to the LAN?
• Have the IP address and port number of the PBX been set correctly? For more details,
see 28.1 Network Service—[1] IP Address/Ports.
• Is the login name and password correct?
Q Can I perform initial setup of the PBX without being connected to the PBX?
A • Yes. This is possible in Off-line mode.
Create a new system data file in Off-line mode (see 1.2.2 PC Programming Using
Off-line Mode), modify settings as necessary, and then upload this file to the PBX
later (see 7.2.1 Utility—File—File Transfer PC to PBX).
Q Not all of the characters of a setting can be displayed because the column is too
narrow.
A • Move the mouse to the line between the names of 2 setting items, at the top of the
table.
The pointer will change to a double arrow. Click and drag the line to the right until all
characters are displayed.
PC Programming Manual 51
2.3 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ)
Card Status
Q The status of a new card will not change to "INS".
A • With the new card installed, does the total number of extensions or trunks exceed the
maximum supported by the PBX?
• Is the type of card installed in the slot different from the card type set as "Pre-Install"
for that slot? Confirm that the correct card is installed in the slot.
• Is the card firmly and fully installed in the slot? Confirm that the card is installed
correctly in the slot.
• Confirm that the card is not damaged.
Portable Stations
Q I cannot register Portable Stations using the method described in 9.31 PBX
Configuration—[1-2] Configuration—Portable Station.
A • Do the PINs (Personal Identification Numbers) of the PBX and the Portable Station
match? Confirm that they are the same.
• Is the Portable Station within transmission range of the CS?
• Has the Portable Station previously been registered at another location?
It is not possible to register a Portable Station at 2 locations, so use the Forced
De-registration option to delete the previous registration.
Q The Portable Station I want to de-register is broken, and will not turn on, or is not
available, or the registration information was deleted first from the Portable Station,
so it cannot be de-registered.
52 PC Programming Manual
2.3 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ)
A • The Portable Station can be forcibly de-registered by following the procedure shown
in Forced De-registration of 9.31 PBX Configuration—[1-2]
Configuration—Portable Station.
Q I changed the extension number of a Portable Station, but the display of the Portable
Station still shows the old extension number.
A • Turn the Portable Station off and back on again, to force it to re-register its location.
Q I changed the FCO of a Portable Station, but the display of the Portable Station still
shows the old FCO.
A • Turn the Portable Station off and back on again, to force it to re-register its location.
Q If I delete the extension number of a Portable Station, and then turn the Portable
Station off and back on again, it does not function correctly.
A • Do not delete the extension number of the Portable Station, as this information is
necessary for it to operate.
Numbering
Q How do I change the extension number of a wired extension?
A • Change the extension number of the target port to the new number, and click Apply.
Next, set the port to OUS status, and then back to INS status.
Q I changed the extension number of a wired extension while the extension was
engaged in a call, but the display still shows the previous extension number.
A • The extension number will not change while the extension is in use. When the
conversation is finished, set the port to OUS status, and then back to INS status.
Q How do I change the extension numbering plan from 3-digit numbers to 4-digit
numbers?
A • Perform the following steps:
1. Open the 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering
Plan—Main screen.
2. Enter a 2-digit number in Leading Number, or change No. of Additional
Digits from "x" to "xx".
For more details, see What is the procedure to modify the Numbering Plan?
in Numbering.
PC Programming Manual 53
2.3 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ)
A • Select 3-digits for default value of Numbering Plan in the Easy Setup Wizard. If you
want to change to a 3-digit extension numbering plan after the PBX system is already
running using a 4-digit extension numbering plan, follow the procedure below. There
are 2 methods of creating a 3-digit numbering plan, using 10.6.1 PBX
Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main:
1. Set the leading number to be 2 digits, with one additional digit. This method allows
a maximum of 10 extensions.
Example: Leading Number = 10; No. of Additional Digits = x
In this example, extension numbers 100 to 109 can be used.
2. Set the leading number to be one digit, with 2 additional digits. This method allows
a maximum of 100 extensions.
Example: Leading Number = 1; No. of Additional Digits = xx
In this example, extension numbers 100 to 199 can be used.
For more details, see What is the procedure to modify the Numbering Plan? in
Numbering.
Q When modifying the Numbering Plan, I cannot change the Leading Number.
A • It is not possible to use the same Leading Number for 2 extension blocks, or to use a
number that could possibly overlap with another Leading Number.
So, for example, if "2" is already set as a Leading Number it is not possible to set
"21" as another Leading Number because of the possible overlap of extension
numbers.
The number you are trying to store cannot be used if it is already being used by:
• A feature number
• Another extension block
• A Dial setting (see 17.1 PBX Configuration—[9-1] Private Network—TIE
Table)
• Quick Dialling (see 10.6.2 PBX Configuration—[2-6-2] System—Numbering
Plan—Quick Dial)
In any of these cases, choose another number.
54 PC Programming Manual
2.3 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ)
Q When modifying the Numbering Plan, how do I set a 1-digit extension number?
A • Perform the following steps:
1. Clear the Leading Number cell.
2. Click Apply.
3. Set No. of Additional Digits to "None".
4. Click Apply.
5. Enter the desired value in the Leading Number cell.
6. Click Apply.
7. Set all extension ports to OUS status.
8. On the relevant screens, set the extension numbers of extensions to the desired
values.
9. Set all extension ports back to INS status.
PC Programming Manual 55
2.3 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ)
Q I cannot change a feature number on the B/NA DND Call Feature screen.
A • The number you are trying to store is already being used by another call feature.
Please choose a different number.
Q If I reset the PBX directly after modifying settings, the modified settings are not
updated in the PBX.
A • When you click Apply, the settings are updated in the PBX, but are not yet saved to
the Storage Memory Card. If system data is not saved to the Storage Memory Card,
the PBX will restore the data that was last saved to the card in the event that the PBX
is reset, or power is turned off and back on again.
Therefore, before resetting the PBX, click the button on the Home screen to save
the system data to the Storage Memory Card. Also, when you finish a programming
session, be sure to click the button to logout and save the system data to the
Storage Memory Card.
Note
Do not remove the Storage Memory Card while power is supplied to the PBX.
Doing so may cause the PBX to fail to start when you try to restart the system.
Q After reinitialising the PBX, I restored system data from a previous backup.
However, some of the settings have not been restored to their previous values.
56 PC Programming Manual
2.3 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ)
A • The following setting data is not saved to the Storage Memory Card, so will be deleted
when the PBX is initialised. This data is stored in the PBX’s battery backup memory.
• Advice of Charge (AOC)
• Hospitality guest billing data
• Timed Reminder
• ICD Group login status
(All extensions are set to Login by default.)
• Remote Extension Dial Lock
Setting Features
Q How do I change the dialling mode of an analogue trunk?
A • From the 9.25 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Port Property -
LCO Port screen, change the Dialling Mode setting of the target port to "DTMF"
or "Pulse", as required.
PC Programming Manual 57
2.3 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ)
A • Trunk calls made by extensions can be restricted from the 10.7.2 PBX
Configuration—[2-7-2] System—Class of Service—External Call Block screen.
Click in the relevant cells to select the trunk groups that cannot be used by extensions
associated with a particular COS in each time mode.
To prevent extensions associated with a COS from making trunk calls, set all trunk
groups for that COS to "Block" (blue).
Q How do I set up an Incoming Call Distribution (ICD) group to receive trunk calls
directly?
A • Perform the following steps:
1. On the 11.5.1 PBX Configuration—[3-5-1] Group—Incoming Call Distribution
Group—Group Settings screen, enter the floating extension number you chose
for the ICD group in the Floating Extension Number cell.
2. Click Apply.
3. On the 11.5.1.1 PBX Configuration—[3-5-1] Group—Incoming Call
Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List screen, select the ICD
group you created from the ICD Group No. drop-down list.
4. Enter the extension numbers of member extensions in the Extension
Number column.
5. Click Apply.
6. On the DIL tab of the 18.2 PBX Configuration—[10-2] CO & Incoming
Call—DIL Table & Port Settings screen, enter the floating extension number of
the ICD group as the DIL Destination—Day, Lunch, Break, Night of each time
mode.
7. Modify other settings as required from the Group—Incoming Call Distribution
Group submenu.
Q How do I set the queuing operation for an Incoming Call Distribution group?
A • Perform the following steps:
1. On the 11.5.2 PBX Configuration—[3-5-2] Group—Incoming Call Distribution
Group—Queuing Time Table screen, set the actions as required for each
queuing table.
2. On the 11.5.1 PBX Configuration—[3-5-1] Group—Incoming Call Distribution
Group—Group Settings screen, from the Queuing Time Table tab, select the
number of the Queuing Time Table to use in each time mode.
58 PC Programming Manual
2.3 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ)
Q I have set FWD through system programming, but calls are still not being forwarded.
A • Perform the following steps:
1. Check that the Forward / DND settings of the target extension on the 12.1.2 PBX
Configuration—[4-1-2] Extension—Wired Extension—FWD/DND or
12.2.2 PBX Configuration—[4-2-2] Extension—Portable Station—FWD/
DND screen are set to one of the forwarding settings.
2. Create a FWD button on the target extension if one does not already exist.
3. Press the FWD button so that it changes to FWD status.
PC Programming Manual 59
2.3 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ)
60 PC Programming Manual
Section 3
Web Maintenance Console Home Screen
PC Programming Manual 61
3.1 Home Screen
Note
• The first time you login to a PBX using Web Maintenance Console, instead of the Home screen the
Easy Setup Wizard is run. See 2.1.4 Easy Setup Wizard.
Icon Description
Add Slave
Click this button to run the Add Site Wizard to add a PBX as a Slave unit to the
One-look network.
Note
This is displayed only when logged in to the Master unit.
Icon View
Click this button to display the PBXs as icons (as in the above illustration).
62 PC Programming Manual
3.1 Home Screen
Icon Description
List View
Click this button to view the following information in a list format:
• System Capacity Selection
This field indicates the type that is selected for System Capacity Selection
in Easy Setup Wizard. For details, refer to "5.4.1 Easy Setup Wizard" in the
Installation Manual.
• Site status indicator
• Site ID (1–16)
• Site Name
• Location (MIB)
Specified at MIB info—SysLocation in 28.3.3 Network Service—[3-3]
Client Feature—SNMP Agent.
• Status (INS or OUS)
• PBX Mode
• IP Address
• MAC Address
• PBX Version (software version)
• PBX Region
• Data Version
• SRAM Version
You can also perform PBX site management from this screen:
• Click Registration to register Slave units that have been added using the Add
Site Wizard. For details, see 3.1.1 Home Screen—Add Site Wizard. You can
also click De-Registration or Forced De-Registration to remove Slave units
from the One-look network.
– When logged in to a Slave unit, only information for that Slave unit and the
Master unit is displayed.
– You can register or de-register Slave units only in On-line mode.
• In the Backup Master drop-down list, select a site to designate it as the Backup
Master site, and then click OK. For details, see 1.2.3.1 One-look Networking
Survivability.
Note
If you have already designated a Backup Master site and want to select a
different site, first select Unassigned and click OK. Then, select the new
Backup Master site.
PC Programming Manual 63
3.1 Home Screen
These 15 icons represent Slave unit PBXs under the control of the Master unit PBX. Units that have been
registered display a unit name and are coloured in. Remaining available unit positions are shown as greyed
out. You can right-click a registered PBX and select Maintenance, Setup, or Direct Login for that PBX.
Selecting Direct Login will display the Login screen for that PBX. For details about the login procedure,
see 2.1.3 Logging in to Web Maintenance Console.
If the PBX is operating as the Master Backup unit or is in Isolated mode, but the Master unit has been
restored to normal operation, you can right-click the PBX’s icon and select Normal Mode to restore the
PBX to normal operation. (It will reconnect to the Master unit PBX as a Slave unit.)
Note
• For the following items related to the Unified Messaging (UM) programming of a Slave unit, you
must select Direct Login to log in to the PBX that the UM Group in which programming will be
performed belongs to:
– 4.1.4 Status—Equipment Status—UM Port status
– 4.1.5 Status—Equipment Status—USB
– 5.3 System Control—FAX Card
– 6.1.1 Tool—System Data Backup—Backup to USB
– 6.9 Tool—UM Data Backup
– 6.10 Tool—UM Data Restore
– 6.11 Tool—UM Backup History
– 7.3.4 Utility—Log—UM System Log
– 7.4.8 Utility—Monitor/Trace—UM System Trace (Internal)
– 7.4.6 Utility—Monitor/Trace—Fax - Protocol Trace
– 7.4.7 Utility—Monitor/Trace—Fax - Task sequence Trace
– 7.5.3 Utility—Report—UM View Reports
– 7.8 Utility—Command
– 7.9 Utility—UM – System Prompts Customisation
– UM Configuration settings
(For details for UM Configuration settings, see "Section 20 UM Configuration—[1] Mailbox
Settings" to "Section 26 UM Configuration—[7] System Security".)
Icon Description
64 PC Programming Manual
3.1.1 Home Screen—Add Site Wizard
Note
• The PBX to be added must have been configured as a Slave unit using the Easy Setup Wizard. See
2.1.4 Easy Setup Wizard.
• To designate a Backup Master PBX, first add the PBX as a Slave unit to the One-look network using
the Add Site Wizard, and then select it as the Backup Master unit from the List View.
1. To start the Add Site Wizard, click the Add Slave button ( ) on the Home screen. For details about the
Home Screen, see 3.1 Home Screen.
2. Follow the prompts of the Add Site Wizard to complete the following settings:
– PBX Setting
– Registration Setting
– SNTP / Daylight Saving
– Maintenance Setting
Note
• The parameters which appear in the settings above are described in 2.1.4 Easy Setup Wizard.
• If 2 or more sites will be added to the One-look network, repeat steps 1 and 2 for each site.
3. After the Add Site Wizard is completed, click Registration on the List View of the Home screen.
4. A list of KX-NS1000 PBXs set up as Slave units will be displayed under Available Site. Select PBXs by
their assigned site names and click the right arrow to move them to Selected Site for Registration.
Click Next to start the registration process.
5. On the Registration Executing screen, the status of PBXs being registered is displayed.
6. On the Registration Completed screen, the result of the registration process is shown. Click Close to
continue.
Registered Slave PBXs can now be viewed and selected on the Home Screen for programming.
Method Description
De-registration • Registration information and settings for the Slave unit are
deleted from the Master unit.
• The De-registered Slave unit is reset to its initialised state
(factory default state).
Forced De-Registration • Registration information and settings for the Slave unit are
deleted from the Master unit.
• The De-registered Slave unit is not reset to its initialised
state. Information and settings registered on the Slave unit
remain.
PC Programming Manual 65
3.1.1 Home Screen—Add Site Wizard
A removal status screen will be displayed. Each selected PBX will be removed one at a time. After each
successful removal, a confirmation message will appear. Click Continue to proceed to the next PBX to
remove.
5. When all removal is complete, a message will be displayed. Click Close to finish.
66 PC Programming Manual
Section 4
Status
PC Programming Manual 67
4.1.1 Status—Equipment Status—UPS
68 PC Programming Manual
4.1.2 Status—Equipment Status—CS Information
Item Description
To view CS information
1. From the Target CS I/F Shelf-Slot No. drop-down list, select the target shelf and slot.
• To display information on a single card, select the shelf number, slot number and name of that card.
• To display information on all matching cards, select "All".
2. From the Interval Timer drop-down list, select the number of seconds between each automatic screen
refresh.
3. If you want to save the CS information, click Capture.
a. Create a file for saving the data.
b. Click Start.
c. Click Close.
4. Click Start to begin monitoring.
Monitoring will be performed and the screen will refresh according to the interval specified.
5. Click Stop to end monitoring.
6. If you started to save the CS information in step 3, click Capture, then click Stop to record the information
to the specified file.
7. Click Close to return to the main screen.
PC Programming Manual 69
4.1.3 Status—Equipment Status—PS Information
Item Description
*1
This information is displayed only for PSs connected through a KX-NS0154 IP-CS.
70 PC Programming Manual
4.1.4 Status—Equipment Status—UM Port status
PC Programming Manual 71
4.1.5 Status—Equipment Status—USB
Note
If a mounted memory device is removed from the PBX without first clicking Unmount, the data on the
USB memory device may be damaged.
• None: No USB memory device is detected by the PBX.
This screen can be accessed only in On-line mode.
72 PC Programming Manual
Section 5
System Control
PC Programming Manual 73
5.1 System Control—Program Update
74 PC Programming Manual
5.1 System Control—Program Update
*1
Software updates for PSs (e.g., KX-TCA185) are bundled with software updates for an IP-CS (KX-NS0154 only).
PC Programming Manual 75
5.1.1 System Control—Program Update—Download Program File
Note
• If these operations are performed when logged in to a Slave unit, only the manual method can be used,
and files may only be acquired from a local PC or a USB memory device.
• When using an FTP server with this feature, the programme files to be downloaded to the
KX-NS1000 PBX must be named on the FTP server in a specific way that includes the version number.
Example: "PNT300_xxx_xxx_xxx"
("xxx_xxx_xxx" is the version number.)
Manual
Using manual operations, the location of updated PBX software is specified and downloaded to the Master
unit, and then transferred to any Slave units.
To download programme files manually
1. In Location of program files, specify the location of the updated files from the Look in drop-down list.
The choices are as follows:
• Local PC
Click Browse and specify the location of the updated programme files stored on the PC logged in to
Web Maintenance Console.
• USB Memory
If a USB memory device is inserted into the PBX, the contents of the following directory on the device
will be checked for updated files:
/private/meigroup/psn/ippbx/update
• FTP Server
The PBX connects to the specified FTP server and checks for updated files. Specify an FTP server
from the FTP connection name drop-down list, and specify the number of attempts to connect to the
FTP server in No. of retries.
To specify a new FTP site, see 28.3.1 Network Service—[3-1] Client Feature—FTP.
• Master Unit
The most recent versions of files previously downloaded to the Master unit are displayed.
• NAS
Specify the location of the updated programme files stored on a directory of the NAS to Web
Maintenance Console.
2. Specify which PBX programme files will be automatically downloaded by checking the boxes next to each
hardware item.
3. For FTP Server only
Click Check to confirm the connection to the FTP server. If a connection is established, the Execute button
will become active.
4. Click Execute, and then click OK on the confirmation message that appears. When the transfer is complete,
click OK.
Note
• If downloading cannot be completed within 10 minutes (due to slow network speeds or other connection
problems), the download operation will be cancelled.
• The Master unit’s FTP server function must be enabled for Slave units to download programme files.
See 28.2.2 Network Service—[2-2] Server Feature—FTP.
76 PC Programming Manual
5.1.1 System Control—Program Update—Download Program File
Automatic
The Master unit is set to automatically check an FTP server for updated programme files. If an update is
available, the Master unit will download the data. The downloaded software is then sent over the One-look
network from the Master unit to all Slave units.
To download programme files automatically
1. For Download Server, select an FTP site.
To specify a new FTP site, see 28.3.1 Network Service—[3-1] Client Feature—FTP.
2. For Download mode, select one of the following:
• None: No actions are taken (automatic downloading is disabled).
• Check only: The specified download server is checked at the specified times. If an e-mail is entered
in Email notification, an e-mail notification is sent when updated files have been discovered.
Note
If Check only is selected, updated files will have to be downloaded manually (see the manual
procedure above).
• Download automatically: The specified download server is checked at the specified times. If updated
files are discovered, they will be downloaded automatically to the PBX. If an e-mail is entered in Email
notification, an e-mail notification is sent when updated files have been downloaded.
3. In Check time and date, specify when the PBX will contact the server to check for updates. The check
can be performed on a daily or weekly basis.
4. In Email notification specify up to 2 e-mail addresses that will receive an e-mail notification when updated
files have been discovered or when updated files have been downloaded.
Note
If Download automatically is not selected in step 2, specify at least one e-mail address so that an
administrator will be notified when updated files have been discovered.
5. To begin automatic checking for updates according to Check time and date, click Execute.
6. The PBX will now periodically perform checks and downloads as specified in the settings. Click Download
Cancel on this screen to stop automatic programme updates.
Note
When the system is downloading data from an FTP server, if downloading cannot be completed within 10
minutes (due to slow network speeds or other connection problems), the download operation will be
cancelled.
PC Programming Manual 77
5.1.2 System Control—Program Update—Update Program File
Note
• Before updating programme files, we strongly recommend making a backup of all system files. For
details, refer to the following:
– 6.1 Tool—System Data Backup
– 6.9 Tool—UM Data Backup
• Do not upgrade KX-UT series SIP phones at the same time as the Main unit.
• When upgrading the system software to version 003.xxxxx from an older version (001.xxxxx or
002.xxxxx), the following SRAM data is cleared.
– Timed Reminder
– Remote Station Lock Status
– Room Status
– Login/Logout Status
– SMDR
– Billing Information
– Hotel Check In/Check Out
– Hotel Specifications
Save SRAM data before upgrading the firmware.
When you upgrade the software, a message will be shown. Then, you can save the following SRAM
data into the Storage Memory Card as "smdrdata.zip".
– SMDR
– Billing Information
– Hotel Specifications
• When upgrading the firmware for the Unified Messaging (UM) Programme (PFAX), specify the MPR
card as the target hardware. The MPR card’s firmware will be updated at the same time. Be aware that
a system reset is necessary when doing the update.
Note
• When selecting an item, a warning message may be displayed. Confirm the contents of the warning,
and then click OK to continue.
• If you are updating the software for a PS, select the port of an IP-CS (e.g., KX-NS0154) that
supports this feature.
3. Click Apply.
4. Click on another PBX site tab to programme another PBX in the One-look network as required, and then
repeat steps 1–3. Perform settings for each PBX in the One-look network as required.
78 PC Programming Manual
5.1.2 System Control—Program Update—Update Program File
5. Click Execute.
The programme files are updated to the specified PBXs.
Note
• Updated PBXs reset when the update is complete.
• If this operation is performed when logged in to a Slave unit only the PBX mother board and hardware
specifically registered to the Slave unit may be updated.
Note
When selecting an item, a warning message may be displayed. Confirm the contents of the warning,
and then click OK to continue.
3. In Update Time, specify the time of day when the update will be executed.
4. Click Apply.
5. Click on another PBX site tab to programme another PBX in the One-look network as required, and then
repeat steps 1–4. Perform settings for each PBX in the One-look network as required.
6. Click Execute.
The programme files will be updated to the specified PBXs at the specified time.
Note
• All PBXs in a One-look network must be using the same version of the software. When updating PBXs
connected in a One-look network, note the following:
– Apply the same version of the software update to all the PBXs in the One-look network.
– When updating the programme files for multiple PBXs, an immediate (manual) update is
recommended. For Automatic (timed) updates, set the same Update Time for all PBXs in the
One-look network.
• At most, the process of updating all PBXs in the network can take approximately 30 minutes to
complete.
• For CS programme files, in order for CS cards to be displayed on this screen, the cards must be set
to INS, and the ports of the card must be set to OUS.
PC Programming Manual 79
5.1.3 System Control—Program Update—Plug and Update
80 PC Programming Manual
5.2.1 System Control—MOH—Install
PC Programming Manual 81
5.2.2 System Control—MOH—Delete
82 PC Programming Manual
5.2.3 System Control—MOH—Status / Backup
PC Programming Manual 83
5.3 System Control—FAX Card
84 PC Programming Manual
5.4 System Control—System Reset
PC Programming Manual 85
5.5 System Control—System Shutdown
86 PC Programming Manual
Section 6
Tool
PC Programming Manual 87
6.1.1 Tool—System Data Backup—Backup to USB
Note
• Unified Messaging (UM) data must be backed up using a separate process. See 6.9 Tool—UM Data
Backup.
• Use a USB memory device with a capacity of at least 512 MB. During the backup process, if an error
message is displayed indicating there is not enough free memory space on the USB memory device,
delete other unnecessary files on the USB memory device, or use a USB memory device with a larger
capacity.
Note
The restoration process first requires an initialisation of the PBX, which returns the PBX to its factory default
state. Under the following conditions, restoration may not be possible, even though the PBX has been
initialised.
• The USB memory device hardware is faulty.
88 PC Programming Manual
6.1.2 Tool—System Data Backup—Backup to NAS
Note
• Unified Messaging (UM) data must be backed up using a separate process. See 6.9 Tool—UM Data
Backup.
• Data backed up from the PBX to a NAS cannot be restored directly from the NAS to the PBX. The
backup data must be copied from the NAS to a local PC. Then the data can be restored from the local
PC to the PBX.
• The following characters cannot be used in the names of the backup files: open bracket, close bracket,
space, forward slash ("/"), period ("."), or 0 (zero).
• When using a NAS, make sure there is sufficient network bandwidth.
• Since it is necessary to send large amounts of data to the NAS when using the data backup feature,
we recommend setting up a NAS at each site.
In particular, when backing up to a NAS over a VPN using the built-in router, the NAS will require a
large amount of network bandwidth. Therefore, a NAS will be necessary at each site.
PC Programming Manual 89
6.2 Tool—BRI Automatic Configuration
Note
• To use this tool, the card to be configured must be pre-set to OUS status. For more details, see
2.1.6 Card Status.
• At any time on this screen, you can click Cancel to return to the previous screen without saving.
90 PC Programming Manual
6.3 Tool—NDSS Link Data Clear
PC Programming Manual 91
6.4 Tool—Call Pickup for My Group
Note
This tool can only be activated if all of the following conditions are met:
– The first Quick Dial setting is empty or is already set to " 0".
– " 0" is not used for another feature number.
– The Group Call Pickup feature number has been assigned.
– The Personal Speed Dialling feature number has been assigned.
– The extension user group number does not exceed the highest Call Pickup Group number.
92 PC Programming Manual
6.5 Tool—Extension List View
Type Detail
PC Programming Manual 93
6.6 Tool—Import
6.6 Tool—Import
Allows several types of system data files or tables to be imported.
Except for Speed Dial and Caller ID, this option is only available at Installer level.
The files from which data can be imported are files that were previously saved at this or another PBX using
the Export tool (see 6.7 Tool—Export), or comma-separated value (CSV) files. Unsupported file types cannot
be opened.
For all tables except ARS - Routing Plan, it is possible to edit the CSV file directly using an appropriate editor,
before importing.
The types of data that can be imported using this tool, and the matching destination fields, are as follows:
Note
Imported Speed Dial and Caller ID data can be copied to a specific speed dial destination. The copy range
can be specified by selecting the from/to of the index.
Location Location
DDI/DID Number Dial In Number
DDI/DID Name Dial In Name
DDI/DID Destination-Day Destination-Day
DDI/DID Destination-Lunch Destination-Lunch
DDI/DID Destination-Break Destination-Break
DDI/DID Destination-Night Destination-Night
Tenant Number Tenant Number
Service Group No. Group number for VPS answer
CLI Ring for DDI/DID-Day CLI Ring - Day
CLI Ring for DDI/DID-Lunch CLI Ring - Lunch
CLI Ring for DDI/DID-Break CLI Ring - Break
CLI Ring for DDI/DID-Night CLI Ring - Night
Related programming: 18.3 PBX Configuration—[10-3] CO & Incoming Call—DDI / DID Table
94 PC Programming Manual
6.6 Tool—Import
Location Location
Leading Number Leading Digit
Additional Number of Digits Additional Dial Digits
Routing Plan Number Route Plan Number
Location Location
Leading Number Exception Exception Code
Wired Extension
Data Type Import Destination
PS Extension
Data Type Import Destination
*1
This data can only be exported, and cannot be imported.
PC Programming Manual 95
6.6 Tool—Import
Quick Dial*
Data Type Import Destination
No. Location
Dial Dial
Phone Number Phone Number
SIP Extension
Data Type Import Destination
No. Location
Extension Number Extension Number
Password* Password
V-IPGW16 GW Settings
Data Type Import Destination
No. Location
GW Name GW Name
GW IP Address GW IP Address
GW Group GW Group No.
Connection for IP-GW16 Connection for IP-GW16
Protocol Protocol
Progress Tone Send Mode Progress Tone Send Mode
IP Codec Priority 1st IP Codec Priority 1st
IP Codec Priority 2nd IP Codec Priority 2nd
IP Codec Priority 3rd IP Codec Priority 3rd
Packet Sampling Time (G.711A) Packet Sampling Time (G.711A)
Packet Sampling Time (G.711Mu) Packet Sampling Time (G.711Mu)
Packet Sampling Time (G.729A) Packet Sampling Time (G.729A)
Voice Activity Detection for G.711 Voice Activity Detection for G.711
FAX Sending Method FAX Sending Method
Maximum Bit Rate Maximum Bit Rate
FAX Detection Ability FAX Detection Ability
DTMF DTMF
96 PC Programming Manual
6.6 Tool—Import
V-IPGW16 DN2IP
Data Type Import Destination
No. Location
Leading Number Leading Number
Remaining Number of Digits Remaining Number of Digits
GW No./GW Group Selection GW No./GW Group Selection
GW Group GW Group
GW No. GW No.
V-SIPGW16 Settings
Data Type Import Destination
V-SIPGW16 Provider
Data Type Import Destination
PS Registration
Data Type Import Destination
PC Programming Manual 97
6.6 Tool—Import
Note
Before importing PS registration settings, be sure to de-register any PSs already registered to the
KX-NS1000 PBX.
98 PC Programming Manual
6.7 Tool—Export
6.7 Tool—Export
Allows several types of system data to be exported to files. These files can be used with the Import tool (see
6.6 Tool—Import) to update another PBX.
Except for ARS - Routing Plan, tables are exported as comma-separated value (CSV) files.
Except for Speed Dial and Caller ID, this option is only available at Installer level.
Note
The separator used in CSV files created using the Export tool is decided by the unit specified in List
Separator, found in the Windows Control Panel’s "Regional Options".
PC Programming Manual 99
6.8 Tool—Screen Customise
Note
Before selecting this option, make sure that a USB memory device is connected to the Master Unit
PBX.
• NAS: Back up the data to a NAS. When NAS is selected, a folder selection menu becomes active.
Specify a folder on the NAS for saving the backup data.
6. Click OK to start the backup.
Note
• The system will prepare the data to be backed up, and the backup will begin about 30 seconds later.
The time needed to backup the data will vary depending on the communication speed and the amount
of data that is being backed up.
• Deleted messages will not be backed up when backing up Mailbox Messages.
• To back up the Unified Messaging data of a Slave unit in a One-look network, log in to the Slave unit
and perform the backup operation from the Slave unit.
• When Local PC is selected, individual messages that are larger than 100 MB cannot be backed up.
• Depending on your browser or your browser’s settings, a prompt may appear during the backup for
each file to be downloaded. Be sure to select an action for each prompt that appears.
Note
Before selecting USB Flash Drive (Main Unit), make sure that the USB memory device with the
backup data is connected to the Master unit PBX.
Note
When restoring data from a local PC, up to 40 files can be selected at one time. When there are a large
number of files to restore, they should be restored from the folder on the USB memory device.
3. Click OK to restore the selected file or folder of files.
• Local PC
The results of the data restore will be downloaded from the PBX as a text file called
"UM_data_restore_result.txt". Save the file to your local PC to view its contents.
• USB Flash Drive (Main Unit)
The results of the data restore will be saved in a text file called "UM_data_restore_result.txt" on the
USB memory device. To view this file, you must connect the USB memory device to a PC and then
open the text file.
• NAS
The results of the data restore will be saved in a text file called "UM_data_restore_result.txt" on the
NAS. To view this file, you must connect to the NAS and copy to a PC and then open the text file.
Note
• When restoring multiple items, only files that match the items for which check boxes have been selected
will be restored. Also, even if data exists in the specified folder of the USB memory device, the data
will not be restored unless the check box of the matching item has been selected.
• Data in sub-folders of a selected folder will not be restored.
• If more than one file matches a selected item, the newest file will be restored.
• The following characters cannot be used in the names of the backup files: open bracket, close bracket,
space, forward slash ("/"), period ("."), or 0 (zero).
• The backup file names stored on the USB memory device should not be changed. If the file names are
changed, the system may not be able to detect which backup files correspond to which UM data items.
• A backed up message cannot be restored to the subscriber’s mailbox if the mailbox still contains a
New/Old/Deleted copy of the same message.
• Voice data recorded by users in a KX-TVM series VPS can be converted and used as voice data in
the KX-NS1000’s Unified Messaging system. For details, refer to "5.3 Starting Web Maintenance
Console—KX-TVM System Prompt and Mailbox Data Import" in the Installation Manual.
To set all DXDP/XDP ports to OUS for the currently selected site
1. Access Tool—DXDP All OUS from the Maintenance Screen tree view.
2. Click OK.
Note
The following apply when programming in On-line mode only:
• To apply changes made to these settings for KX-UT series SIP phones connected to Slave unit PBXs
in a One-look network, be sure to click the icon after programming. Otherwise, there may be a delay
of 30 minutes or more before changed settings are applied.
• To set these parameters, all installed V-UTEXT32 cards must first be set to OUS. For details, see
9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Note
• For more information about dial plans, refer to the Administrator Guide of the relevant KX-UT series
SIP phone.
• You can enter up to 500 characters in the dial plan text box.
• You can assign up to 20 dial plans, separating them with a "|" (vertical bar).
• You can assign up to 32 digits per dial plan.
• When OK is clicked, the entered text string will be validated. If there is a validation error, a message
will be displayed.
Specify valid URL addresses for Unified Messaging Plug in and/or Fax Driver Tool, and then click OK.
7.1 Utility—Diagnosis
Card Test
Tests the relevant functions of a card to ensure that it is operating correctly. The tests carried out vary according
to the type of card being tested.
The tests that are performed on each card are listed below.
Note
Tests marked with a "*" are available only for cards installed on a legacy gateway. For details, see 9.29 PBX
Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Legacy-GW1/Legacy-GW2. For more information about
cards installed in legacy gateways, refer to the documentation of the legacy gateway PBX.
Note
To perform this test, it is necessary to set Loopback Test started by Network in 9.28 PBX
Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—CO Setting to "Enable".
Note
• Cards installed in KX-NS1000 PBXs and legacy gateway KX-NCP PBXs cannot be tested using this
utility.
• The cards to be used for testing must be installed in the same legacy gateway PBX.
Line current OFF (Ext->CO) Line current from extension to trunk turns off.
Line current ON (Ext->CO) Line current from extension to trunk turns on.
Off hook detection (CO->Ext) Off-hook generation/detection from trunk to extension
DTMF detection (CO->Ext) DTMF generation/detection from trunk to extension
DP detection (CO->Ext) DP generation/detection from trunk to extension
BELL detection (Ext->CO) BELL generation/detection from extension to trunk
Speech path (Ext->CO) Speech path from extension to trunk
Speech path (CO->Ext) Speech path from trunk to extension
7.1.2 Utility—Diagnosis—Ping
Performs a connection test on network devices. This function sends echo requests to a particular IP address
across an IP network, and displays the result of responses and round-trip time.
This screen can be accessed only in On-line mode.
7.2 Utility—File
To install new main system data that has been copied to the PBX, use the System Reset utility (see 5.4 System
Control—System Reset) for DCSYS files.
The PBX examines the header information of a file to determine 2 things: whether the file contains supported
data, and which system component the file applies to.
Only files whose header information matches that of a system file supported by the PBX can be transferred.
Attempting to transfer any other type of file results in an error message.
The names of all files that can be stored on the Storage Memory Card are as follows:
System Data
Name on Storage Memory Card Corresponding Card
*1
DCSYS-file-format data that is transferred to the PBX is saved as "DCSYS_R".
The files that can be downloaded from the Storage Memory Card are as follows:
• Downloading the DCSYS system data file allows you to make a backup of the configuration of the PBX.
• The error data files are snapshots of the configuration of the PBX taken automatically when a major error
causes a system reset. They can be analysed by your dealer to identify the source of a problem. If there
is only one error data file, its name will be $SYSERR. If there is more than one file, the files will be numbered
in chronological order, up to a maximum of 9 files.
• KX-UT series SIP phone configuration data can be transferred to a PC, and then imported using the
phone’s Web user interface. For details, refer to the Administrator Guide of the relevant KX-UT series SIP
phone.
To view information of programme and activation key files stored in the Storage Memory Card
1. Click on the name of the desired programme or activation key file.
2. Click Detail. The Detail screen will be displayed. You can select different files from the File drop-down
menu to view the details for each file.
3. Activation key files can be deleted on the Detail screen. Follow the procedure below.
a. Click Delete.
A confirmation screen will be displayed.
b. Click OK.
Note
The maximum number of files is 99. Therefore, we recommend deleting activation key files that have
expired.
Note
Programme files cannot be deleted if the Program Update feature’s timed update is set, or if an update is
currently being performed. For details, see 5.1.2 System Control—Program Update—Update Program
File.
Note
• When selecting files to copy to the PBX, the file names (apart from the file extension) cannot be
more than 33 characters in length.
• When selecting G.711 codec WAV files to copy to the PBX, the total file size of all selected files
combined cannot exceed 32 megabytes.
4. Click OK.
• The files will be uploaded. Files that do not contain message data will be ignored.
• An index number (01 to 64) will be appended automatically to the file names of message files
transferred to the PBX.
• When complete, the display will return to the main screen.
7.3 Utility—Log
Button Function
Item Description
BB Site ID
00–15
• Corresponds to site numbers of PBXs in the One-look network (1 to 16)
W Slot Type
For physical slots (including physical slots of legacy gateway PBXs)
– " " (blank)
For KX-NS1000 virtual slots
– "*" (asterisk)
X Shelf Number
• – KX-NS1000 unit: 1
– Legacy gateway: 2–3
– Convert process: 4
– Non-PBX process: 5
YY Slot Number
When X is not 4 or 5
Physical shelf
Mother board slot: 00
Regular slots: 01–05
Legacy gateway
STACK-S card: 00
Optional physical service card slots:
– KX-TDE600/KX-TDA600: 01–10
– KX-TDE620/KX-TDA620: 01–11
– KX-NCP500/KX-NCP1000/KX-NS1020: 01–07
(Slots 04 and 07 are disregarded for KX-NCP500 PBXs)
Virtual shelf
Virtual Trunk slots: 31–46
Virtual Extension slots: 47–66
Virtual IP-CS slots: 67–82
When X is 4
YY: Convert code
When X is 5
YY: Process code
ZZ Port Number
When X is not 4 or 5
ZZ: Optional service card port number (01–XX)
When X is 4
ZZ: Convert code
When X is 5
ZZ: Process number (determined by each process)
Note
When there is no parameter for slot and port number, YY and ZZ will be displayed as "00".
Example: Sub code for the mother board = "01 10000"
7.3.2 Utility—Log—Syslog
Displays a log of system events. Each entry in the log includes the following information:
• Type: Describes the type of system event.
• Date: The date and time the system event occurred.
• Message: Details about the system event.
This screen can be accessed only in On-line mode.
Item Description
7.4 Utility—Monitor/Trace
Note
The file transfer screen can also be accessed from the tree menu (see 7.2.2 Utility—File—File
Transfer PBX to PC).
2. Select the desired trace data file.
3. Click Transfer.
4. Navigate to the folder in which you want to save the file.
5. Enter a file name.
6. Click Save.
7. Click OK.
Note
The file transfer screen can also be accessed from the tree menu (see 7.2.2 Utility—File—File
Transfer PBX to PC).
2. Select the desired trace data file.
3. Click Transfer.
4. Navigate to the folder in which you want to save the file.
5. Enter a file name.
6. Click Save.
7. Click OK.
The displayed items for the Current Sync CS of each CS are as follows:
Item Description
Item Description
Index A unique index for the CS. (This depends on the number of V-IPCS4 cards
and the number of connected CSs.)
Site The site to which the CS is connected.
Shelf Always displays "Virtual".
Slot The slot number of the CS in the selected synchronisation group.
Port The port number of the CS.
Connection The connection status of the CS (OUS/INS/Fault).
LAN Sync Status The current synchronisation status of the CS, as follows:
1. No Sync.: Attempting to establish synchronisation
2. Establishing Sync.: Establishing synchronisation
3. Good: Currently synchronised
4. Keep Sync.: Maintaining synchronisation
5. Unstable: The CS is running unsynchronised
6. Sync. Lost: Synchronisation has been lost
7. Out of system: Cannot communicate with the PBX
8. Sync. Master: CS is the sync master or is a slave acting as the sync
master
LAN Sync Quality Level Shows the quality of the synchronisation, depending on the value of LAN
Sync Status, as follows:
• 1, 7, 8: "–" is displayed.
• 6: The quality of the synchronisation before synchronisation was lost is
displayed.
• Other: A number indicating the quality of the synchronisation (-16384–
16384 ns).
7.5 Utility—Report
Item Description
Item Description
Collection Started Time Date and time the port was last reset.
Port No. Number of the port.
RTP Receive Packet Counter Total number of packets received.
RTP Receive Lost Packet Counter Total number of packets lost.
RTP Receive Abandoned Packet Counter Total number of packets abandoned.
RTP Arrive Packet Interval (MAX.) [ms] Maximum time taken for a packet to
arrive.
RTP Arrive Packet Interval (MIN.) [ms] Minimum time taken for a packet to
arrive.
To view a report
1. In the View Report tab, select the desired report from the Report Parameters drop-down list.
2. Specify a range of mailbox numbers in the From and To boxes, or click Select all mailboxes.
3. Click View Report.
Some reports can be viewed as a table or as a graph. For these reports, select "Table" or "Graph" under
View As before clicking View Report.
To export a report
A report can be printed from Web Maintenance Console or exported as a text file or CSV file.
1. When viewing a report, select Print Out (PC), Text, or Comma-separated values (CSV) from the
drop-down menu.
2. Click Export.
3. If you select Print Out (PC):
A print command is sent to the PC. Follow any prompts to print the report.
If you select Text or Comma-separated values (CSV):
A file save dialogue is displayed. Specify the folder to export the report file to.
To clear a report
For each report, all data can be cleared. Follow the steps below to clear all report data. Some reports can also
be set to automatically clear at specified times.
1. Select the Report Data Clear (Manual) tab.
2. Select the desired report from Report Parameters.
3. Click Report Data Clear.
Mailbox Information Report The mailbox information report displays configuration parameters
(from owner’s extension to e-mail options) for a specified mailbox
or a range of mailboxes. 50 records are displayed at a time for this
report.
Call Account Report*1 The call account report displays information about outgoing call
activity. Information can be shown by UM port or by mailbox. The
report includes date, starting time, used port, connection time,
called telephone number, call type, exit status of each callout, total
callouts number and the connection time for local or long distance
call, and total number of outgoing calls. 400 records are displayed
at a time for this report.
UM Extn. Usage Report*1 The port usage report displays information about each UM port,
such as connection time and percentage of time which each UM
port was busy.
Memory Card Usage Report*1 The memory usage report indicates the amount of storage space
used and the amount of available space. Available space is
expressed in minutes. Information for the number of messages
stored in and deleted from the Unified Messaging system is
displayed.
Mailbox Usage Report*1 The mailbox usage report displays information for a specified
mailbox or range of mailboxes, including the number of recorded
messages, the total time of outgoing calls, external messages,
message notification, group message delivery, and number of
faxes received.
• Specify the mailboxes for which you want to display a report,
then click View Report.
• Items not marked as "current" are accumulated indications
since the last clearing of this report.
100 records are displayed at a time for this report.
Fax Transfer Report*1 The fax transfer report displays information about faxes received
by the Unified Messaging system and transferred to a fax
extension. It includes the fax reception date, the port number used,
and the fax transfer status for a maximum of 64 fax messages.
Fax Server Report The fax server report displays the log of all sent and received
faxes. The report includes the user name or mailbox number that
sent or received the fax, number of pages of the fax document,
and the result of the fax transmission or reception.
Images of sent and received faxes can also be displayed.
Call Handling Statistic Report*1 The call handling statistic report displays both a summary of and
details of Unified Messaging activity over a specified period of time
for the Automated Attendant service. This report includes the total
number of incoming calls, transferred calls, held calls, calls which
left a message, the result of transferred calls, etc.
Custom Service Report*1 The Custom Service report displays information such as Custom
Service settings, message recording status, number of access,
time of access, and number of access to each key.
Message Status Report The message status report provides the status of all messages of
specified subscribers, including faxes.
Subscriber Setup Report The subscriber setup report displays the basic settings (owner’s
name, password, personal greeting, etc.) for a specified mailbox
or range of mailboxes.
Security Information Report The security information report displays information about mailbox
accesses. The report includes the date of the last change and last
access, number of total accesses, login, and failed accesses.
Hourly Statistics Report*1 The hourly statistics report displays information about the number
of incoming or outgoing calls, the connected time per hour, etc.
*1
This report can be set to be automatically cleared according to scheduled settings.
The maximum number of entries included in the report is as follows, depending on the type of the message:
• Voice mail or fax message notifications: 5,000 entries
• Missed call notifications: 1,000 entries
• Other e-mail messages (system messages, etc.): 1,000 entries
Note
Messages sent by the PBX, such as system alerts, will list the user as "System" and the mailbox number
as "—".
If these maximum amounts are exceeded, older records beyond the maximum amount for each type will be
deleted as new entries are recorded. To delete all e-mail report records, click Delete all E-mail report.
Item Description
Item Description
Item Description
Short Term Diag The short term (within the previous 1 hour) diagnosis for LAN
synchronisation.
• Indeterminable: Status cannot be determined.
• Indeterminable (IGPM Querier not found): Status cannot be
determined because the IGPM querier could not be found.
• Under Diagnosis: Diagnosis is being performed.
• OK: Synchronisation is OK.
• Not OK (Signal Jitter): Synchronisation is susceptible to jitter.
• Not OK (Signal delay): Synchronisation is susceptible to delay.
• Conditional OK (Signal delay): Synchronisation is OK, but
delay is possible.
• Out of Sync: Synchronisation cannot be established.
• Out of Sync (10base-T): Synchronisation cannot be
established on a 10Base-T connection.
• Out of Sync (100base-TX half): Synchronisation cannot be
established on a 100Base-TX half-duplex connection.
• Out of Sync (IGPM Querier not found): Synchronisation
cannot be established because an IGPM querier could not be
found.
Long Term Diag The long term diagnosis for LAN synchronisation.
• Indeterminable: Status cannot be determined.
• Indeterminable (IGPM Querier not found): Status cannot be
determined because the IGPM querier could not be found.
• Under Diagnosis: Diagnosis is being performed.
• OK: Synchronisation is OK.
• Not OK (Signal Jitter): Synchronisation is susceptible to jitter.
• Not OK (Signal delay): Synchronisation is susceptible to delay.
• Conditional OK (Signal delay): Synchronisation is OK, but
delay is possible.
• Out of Sync: Synchronisation cannot be established.
• Out of Sync (10base-T): Synchronisation cannot be
established on a 10Base-T connection.
• Out of Sync (100base-TX half): Synchronisation cannot be
established on a 100Base-TX half-duplex connection.
• Out of Sync (IGPM Querier not found): Synchronisation
cannot be established because an IGPM querier could not be
found.
Item Description
System Alarm
An e-mail message will be sent to the specified address when there is a system alarm. The e-mail message
will contain details about the alarm.
1. For Filtering Setting, select the check boxes to specify whether to receive e-mails when there is a Major
alarm, a Minor alarm, or both.
2. Specify one or two e-mail addresses that will receive system alarm alert messages.
Notice
Be sure to enter e-mail addresses correctly. If an address is incorrectly entered, an alert will not be
received when there is a system alarm, or information regarding the PBX may be sent unintentionally
to a third party.
3. In Subject enter the text that will be used for the subject header of e-mails that are sent.
For Format—Message body type, select the check boxes to specify whether to include the subject in the
message body.
• Type1: Message body does not include the subject
• Type2: Message body includes the subject
4. Click OK when finished.
Licence Expiry
• Partner licence (product licences with an expiration date)*1
A notification e-mail will be sent to the specified addresses at midnight, 40 days before the activation key
expires. Or, if the PBX is started within 40 days of the activation key’s expiration, a notification e-mail will
be sent at that time to the specified addresses. Only 1 notification will be sent.
• Non-product licences with an expiration date
A notification e-mail will be sent to the specified addresses at midnight, 10 days before the activation key
expires if the PBX is turned on. If the PBX is started within 10 days of the activation key’s expiration, a
notification e-mail will be sent each time the PBX is started.
*1
For the following activation keys, the e-mail will be sent 40 days before the activation key expires.
• Poltys CA RCS-Extend (1 user)
• Poltys CA RCS-Extend (5 users)
• Poltys CA RCS-Extend (10 users)
• Poltys CA RCS-Extend (128 users)
• Poltys CCAccounting A.L.
• Poltys CCAcc. Enterprise A.L.
• Poltys CCView A.L.
• Poltys CCView add. PBX A.L.
• Poltys CCView Supervisor A.L. (1 user)
• Poltys CCView Supervisor A.L. (5 users)
• Poltys CCView CRM P-up A.L. (1 user)
• Poltys CCView CRM P-up A.L. (5 users)
• Poltys Number notice A.L.
• Poltys CCAgent A.L. (1 user)
• Poltys CCAgent A.L. (5 users)
• Poltys CCRecord Analogue A.L. (4 ports)
• Poltys CCRecord Analogue A.L. (8 ports)
1. Specify one or two e-mail addresses that will receive expiry notice messages.
Notice
Be sure to enter e-mail addresses correctly. If an address is incorrectly entered, an alert will not be
received when activation keys are about to expire, or information regarding the PBX may be sent
unintentionally to a third party.
2. In Subject enter the text that will be used for the subject header of e-mails that are sent.
For Format—Message body type, select the check boxes to specify whether to include the subject in the
message body.
• Type1: Message body does not include the subject
• Type2: Message body includes the subject
3. Click OK when finished.
7.8 Utility—Command
Notice
The system prompts initially installed on the Storage Memory Card cannot be restored to their original state
by initialising or resetting the PBX; any changes made to the initially installed system prompts cannot be
undone. Before changing any system prompts, perform a backup of the initial system prompt data. See
6.9 Tool—UM Data Backup for details. Then, you can restore the system prompts to their initial state by
restoring the backup data. See 6.10 Tool—UM Data Restore for details.
Deleting Prompts
The programmer is able to delete specified system prompts.
To delete a specific system prompt:
1. Select the cell for the desired prompt number.
2. Click Delete.
Recording System Prompts
1. Select the desired system prompt to record, and click Play/Record.
2. Select "Record from extension" or "Import from recorded file".
When "Record from extension" is selected:
1. Specify the extension number of the telephone used for recording, then click Connect.
2. When the specified extension rings, go off-hook.
3. Click Record, Stop, or Play to record or play a system prompt.
4. Click Disconnect.
5. Click OK.
When "Import from recorded file" is selected:
1. Click Browse.
The Open dialogue box appears.
2. Navigate to the folder containing the WAV files you wish to import.
WAV files must meet the following specifications:
– G.711 PCM codec
– 8 kHz, 8-bit sampling rate
– Monaural
– A-law or µ-law encoding
3. Select the desired WAV file.
4. Click Open to import the file.
5. Click OK.
Extension Number
Indicates the extension number of the extension (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Indicates the name of the extension (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Internal Call
Specifies whether intercom calls for the extension will be automatically recorded.
Note
Calls between extensions that are connected in a QSIG network are seen as external calls, irrespective of
whether an activation key for QSIG enhanced features is used. To enable Automatic Two-way Recording
for this type of call, set External Call to On.
Value Range
On, Off
External Call
Specifies whether trunk calls for the extension are automatically recorded.
Value Range
On, Off
Note
External Call must be set to "On" to set this item to "On".
Value Range
On, Off
Supervisor
Indicates the extension designated as a supervisor that may play, delete, or confirm the information of two-way
recordings (reference only).
Value Range
Extension number and user name
UM Group No.
Indicates the UM group number in which the two-way recording will be performed (reference only).
Value Range
Group number and group name
Mailbox Number
Indicates the Unified Messaging mailbox where two-way recordings will be stored (reference only).
Value Range
Mailbox number
Note
• For User (Administrator) accounts to change User (User) account settings, the Installer account must
use the Screen Customise tool to allow User (Administrator) accounts to view the Users—User
Profiles screen. For details, see 6.8 Tool—Screen Customise.
• When a User (User) level account accesses this screen, he may view and edit items for his account
as explained in 8.2.1 Users—Add User—Single User. In addition, some advanced settings are
available for User (User) level accounts only. For details, see 8.1.1 Users—User Profiles—Advanced
setting.
The settings that can be changed in the User Profile List for each user are as follows:
Common
Item Description
FWD/DND
Item Description
Item Description
FWD setting - call from CO Specifies the FWD destination for calls from trunks.
Destination
FWD/DND setting - call from Ext. Specifies the FWD/DND setting for calls from extensions.
Mode
FWD setting - call from Ext. Specifies the FWD destination for calls from extensions.
Destination
For settings and details for FWD/DND items, refer to the following:
• 12.1.2 PBX Configuration—[4-1-2] Extension—Wired Extension—FWD/DND
• 12.2.2 PBX Configuration—[4-2-2] Extension—Portable Station—FWD/DND
Option
Item Description
Rule of copy to extension name Determines how the First Name and Last Name set in User
Profiles is used for the Extension Name of the following settings.
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired
Extension—Extension Settings
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable
Station—Extension Settings
User Controls
• Add Button
To add a user profile for a single extension, click the button to open the Add User Wizard. See
8.2.1 Users—Add User—Single User.
• Edit Button
To edit information on an individual user level, select a user from the list by clicking on the row of the user
to edit, then clicking the button to open the Add User Wizard with the selected user’s information filled
in. See 8.2.1 Users—Add User—Single User.
• Delete Button
To delete users:
1. Check the box(es) next to the user’s name(s) and click the button.
2. A confirmation message will appear. Click OK.
3. The user’s information is deleted from the list.
• Add Range Button
To add multiple user profiles for a range of extensions at one time, click the button. See
8.2.2 Users—Add User—Multiple Users.
Note
• In order to edit the settings of the Unified Message tab by clicking the button, you must be logged
in to the PBX with the associated UM Group that your mailbox is assigned to. If you are logged in to a
PBX that is different from the PBX with the associated UM Group of your mailbox, the following items
will be greyed out:
– Prompt Registration
– Mailbox Password
– Mailbox Password (Message Client)
– Advanced setting
If these items are greyed out, click Direct Login to log in directly to the PBX associated with the UM
Group of your mailbox to make changes to these items.
• The , , and buttons are not visible for User (User) level accounts.
Note
The advanced settings described here are displayed only for User (User) level accounts.
Scenario Name
Specify a name for the scenario for identification.
Value Range
Max. 32 Characters
Value Range
None: Rings the subscriber’s extension.
Call blocking: Handles the call according to the Incomplete Call Handling for No Answer setting for the
subscriber’s extension. The subscriber’s extension will not ring.
Call screening: The caller is prompted to record his or her name. The Unified Messaging system then calls
the subscriber and plays back the caller name. The subscriber can choose whether to answer the call.
Leave a Message: Transfers the caller to the mailbox.
Intercom Paging: Pages the subscriber by intercom.
Transfer to specified Custom Service Menu: Transfers the caller to the specified Custom Service.
Note
This setting can only be set to "Enable" when Call Transfer Status—Selection is set to "Leave a
Message".
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Max. 32 digits
Value Range
Extension: The call is transferred to the user’s extension.
Other: The call is transferred to the telephone number that is specified in Transfer to (Other).
Value Range
Custom Service
Note
If "Call screening" is selected, the transfer destination will hear the call screening prompt before the call is
transferred.
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, , and #)
Note
• This sequence has higher priority than the alternate extension transfer sequence specified in 24.4 UM
Configuration—[5-4] System Parameters—Parameters— PBX Environment—Alternate
Extension Transfer Sequence (Up to 16 digits / [0-9 * # D R F T X , ;]).
• If "Call screening" is selected, the transfer destination will hear the call screening prompt before the
call is transferred.
Value Range
Other, Extension, Covering Extension
If "Other" is specified, enter a maximum of 32 digits consisting of 0–9, , and #.
Note
More than one option can be selected.
Value Range
Leave a Message: Allows the caller to record a message.
Transfer to a covering extension: Transfers the caller to a covering extension.
Page the mailbox owner by intercom paging: Pages the subscriber by intercom.
Transfer to operator: Transfers the caller to an operator.
Return to top menu: Lets the caller return to the top menu and try another extension.
Transfer to specified Custom Service Menu: Transfers the caller to the specified Custom Service.
Note
More than one option can be selected.
Value Range
Leave a Message: Allows the caller to record a message.
Transfer to a covering extension: Transfers the caller to a covering extension.
Page the mailbox owner by intercom paging: Pages the subscriber by intercom.
Transfer to operator: Transfers the caller to an operator.
Return to top menu: Lets the caller return to top menu and try another extension.
Transfer to specified Custom Service Menu: Transfers the caller to the specified Custom Service.
Scenario Setting
You can select scenarios set in 8.1.1 Users—User Profiles—Advanced setting for your extension. A scenario
can be set temporarily, or scenarios can be selected for use according to the Absent Message setting of the
extension of the subscriber. (® 14.5 PBX Configuration—[6-5] Feature—Absent Message)
Temporary Scenario: Setting a scenario here will use that scenario indefinitely. A scenario set here will be
used regardless of the subscriber’s extension status. Selecting "None" will remove the setting.
Absent Message 1–9: The selected scenario will be used when the indicated Absent Message is set at the
extension.
Note
User (User) level accounts may access this screen to edit their account information, but only the items
marked with a "*".
User Information
Item Description
First Name* Specifies the first name of the user (max 20 characters).
Last Name* Specifies the last name of the user (max 20 characters).
Change Language* Select the Web Maintenance Console language displayed for the user from the
drop-down list. Users may select different display languages without affecting
the display of other users.
Site name Select a PBX site from the drop-down list for the account.
Department Specifies a department description of up to 64 characters.
Section Specifies a section description of up to 64 characters.
User Group Select a User Group from the drop-down list.
User groups can be set in Extension Settings:
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired
Extension—Extension Settings
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable
Station—Extension Settings
User Level Select a User Level from the drop-down list.
• The Installer level account may select User (User) or User (Administrator)
levels.
• User (Administrator) level accounts may only select the User (User) level.
The First Name and Last Name set on this screen are applied to system settings as follows.
• The First Name and Last Name are copied to the Extension Name for the user’s extension number in
the following settings.
A. 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main
B. 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main
The format of the extension name is determined by the setting in the User Profiles—Option tab:
– Rule-A: [First Name] [space] [Last Name]
– Rule-B: [Last Name] [,] [First Name]
Notice
If the length of the name copied to the Extension Name is longer than the maximum number of
characters allowed for the setting, the letters at the end of the name exceeding the maximum will be
discarded.
• The First Name and Last Name are copied to the corresponding First Name and Last Name on the
following screen for the specified mailbox number.
C. 20.1.2 UM Configuration—[1-2] Mailbox Settings—Full Setting—Mailbox Parameters
• Changing the name settings in the Extension Settings or Mailbox Settings screens listed above will not
change the First Name or Last Name on this screen (the copying function is one-way).
Contact
Item Description
Extension No. Select an extension for the user from the drop-down list.
Device Displays the device type of the selected extension.
Extension PIN* Specifies the user’s extension PIN.
DDI Specifies the user’s Direct Dial In (DDI) number.
Fax* Specifies the user’s fax number.
Phone (Home)* Specifies the user’s home telephone phone number.
Phone (Mobile)* Specifies the user’s mobile telephone phone number.
Email 1–3* Specifies the user’s e-mail address(es).
The Extension PIN set on this screen is applied to system settings as follows.
• The Extension PIN is copied to the Extension PIN for the user’s extension number in the following
settings.
A. 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main
B. 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main
• If Automatic copy to Mailbox Password is checked when the Extension PIN is input, the Extension
PIN is also copied to the following settings according to the user’s designated mailbox.
– Mailbox Password in the User Profiles—Unified Message tab.
– 20.1.2 UM Configuration—[1-2] Mailbox Settings—Full Setting—Mailbox Parameters— Mailbox
Password
Notice
If the Extension PIN to be copied has less characters than the minimum number of characters required
for the Mailbox Password, the data will not be copied and an error message is displayed. See 26.1 UM
Configuration—[7] System Security—Subscriber— Minimum Password Length (0-16 digits).
The e-mail addresses set for Email 1–3 on this screen are applied to system settings as follows.
• If Use for missed call notification is checked when the Email 1–3 information is input, the user will receive
an e-mail at the address(es) specified when a trunk call is missed.
• If Automatic copy to UM message notification is checked when the Email 1–3 information is input, the
input address(es) are copied to the following setting. This process is one-way; changes to the below setting
will not change the information input on this screen.
– 20.1.2 UM Configuration—[1-2] Mailbox Settings—Full Setting—Notification Parameters— E-mail/
Text Message Device—Device No. 1, 2, 3—E-mail Address
Notice
If the Activation Key for Unified Messaging E-mail Notification (KX-NSU2xx) is not installed, or the number
of activation keys is insufficient, the e-mail address(es) will not be copied and an error message is
displayed.
Unified Message
Item Description
UM Group No. Select a UM group for the user from the drop-down list.
Mailbox Number Enter the UM mailbox for the user.
Class of Service Select a COS for the user from the drop-down list.
(COS)
Prompt Registration* Click Prompt Registration to open the User Prompt Registration screen. The
following prompts can be recorded in this screen:
• Mailbox owner name
• Personal greetings (No Answer, Busy, After Hour, Caller ID Greeting,
Temporary Greeting and Absent Message)
• Interview mailbox questions
• Personal caller ID name
To record a prompt
Select a prompt number and click Play/Record.
When "Record from extension" is selected:
1. Specify the extension number of the telephone used for recording, then
click Connect.
2. When the specified extension rings, go off-hook.
3. Click Record, Stop, or Play to record or play a system prompt.
4. Click Disconnect.
When "Import from recorded file" is selected:
1. Click Browse. The Open dialogue box appears.
2. Navigate to the folder containing the WAV files you wish to import.
3. Select the desired WAV file.
4. Click Open to import the file.
5. Click Upload.
6. Click OK.
To start and stop prompt playback
1. Select the desired prompt.
2. Click Play/Record.
3. Click Play or Stop.
4. Click OK.
To delete a specific prompt
1. Select the desired prompt.
2. Click Delete.
3. Click OK.
Mailbox Password* Click to specify the password for the mailbox.
Note
If Extension PIN is input in the Contact tab, and Automatic copy to
Mailbox Password is checked, the extension PIN will be copied to this
setting and overwrite any previously input data here.
Item Description
Mailbox Password Click to specify the messaging client password for the mailbox.
(Message Client)*
Note
This setting requires the installation of an Activation Key for Unified
Messaging E-mail Notification (KX-NSU2xx) for the number of users that
will be accessing their UM mailbox using a client software programme.
Advanced setting* Click to view the selected mailbox’s settings. See 20.1 UM
Configuration—[1] Mailbox Settings.
Note
When User (User) level accounts access these settings, additional items
are displayed. See 8.1.1 Users—User Profiles—Advanced setting.
Unified Messaging Click to open a new window in your Web browser and access the download
Plug in site for the IMAP Session Controller software.
Fax Driver Tool Click to open a new window in your Web browser and access the download
site for the Fax Driver software.
Telephony Feature
Item Description
Class of Service Select the COS for the user from the drop-down list.
(COS)
Forward / Do Not Specifies the user’s FWD/DND settings for trunk calls.
Disturb—For external For the FWD destination, Phone (Home) or Phone (Mobile) (as specified in
calls* the Contact tab), or a manually input number can be specified.
Forward / Do Not Specifies the user’s FWD/DND settings for extension calls.
Disturb—For internal For the FWD destination, Phone (Home) or Phone (Mobile) (as specified in
calls* the Contact tab), or a manually input number can be specified.
Speed Dialling View/ Click this button to open the Speed Dial screen. The appropriate screen (wired
Edit* extension or portable station) will be opened according to the extension
specified for the user.
Flexible Button View/ Click this button to open the Flexible Button screen. The appropriate screen
Edit* (wired extension or portable station) will be opened according to the extension
specified for the user.
Login Account
Item Description
Note
Login IDs must be unique for each user.
Password* Set a password for the user. (4-16 characters in length)
Re-enter* Re-enter the password for confirmation.
When all relevant information has been set, click OK to add or reflect changes to the user account.
Note
If the user changes any of their own settings, they will be applied to the user the next time they log into
Web Maintenance Console.
Note
When this setting is selected, mailboxes for PS extensions will be created in the UM group of the
Master unit.
• Create mailboxes to the specified UM group:
Mailboxes for the extensions will be created in the UM group that you select from the drop-down list.
4. Click OK.
Settings automatically programmed for each user
• First Name/Last Name
The Extension Name, which is the name displayed on extension LCDs, can be copied all at once to the
First Name and Last Name settings for each extension. The format for copying the Extension Name can
be selected as follows.
1. Click Setup ® Users ® User Profiles.
2. On the Option tab, for Rule of copy to extension name select one of the following.
– Rule-A: [First Name] [space] [Last Name]
– Rule-B: [Last Name] [,] [First Name]
For more information, refer to "5.10 Configuration of Users" in the Installation Manual.
• Login ID: The extension number (i.e., if the extension is "101", the Login ID for the user will also be
"101")
• Password: "PWD" + the extension number for the user (e.g., "PWD101")
Note
• When OK is clicked, if any extensions within the range specified in step 1 already have user accounts
associated with them, the process will not complete, and an error message will be displayed.
• If the Create mailboxes with the same number as the extensions check box is selected and a
mailbox number has already been assigned to another extension, the user profile will be created without
a UM mailbox assigned to it.
• If the maximum number of digits for a mailbox number ( Mailbox No. Max. Length (3-8) in 24.4 UM
Configuration—[5-4] System Parameters—Parameters) is less than the number of digits for the
specified extensions, the maximum number of digits for a mailbox number will be automatically
increased to match the number of digits for the specified extensions.
• A maximum of 500 users can be created at once using this feature.
Note
If ALL has been selected for the Mailbox filter, the button will be disabled. Select a specific
mailbox to enable the button.
5. In the window that appears, enter the extension number in Specify Extension of the extension at which
to play back the messages, and then click Connect.
6. Go off-hook when the extension rings to establish a call with the UM message playback system.
7. During the call, click Play to listen to the currently selected message. If multiple messages were
selected in step 2, you can click Prev and Next to cycle through and listen to the selected messages.
8. When you are finished listening to messages, click Disconnect or go on-hook.
Supervisor selection
Selects the ACD supervisor from a drop-down list.
This operation is available only at the User (Administrator) level.
For details about ACD supervisor settings, see 11.5.4 PBX Configuration–[3-5-4] Group—Incoming Call
Distribution Group—ACD Supervisor.
Value Range
Registered ACD supervisors
Start Monitor
Click the Start Monitor button to start monitoring the target ICD group. This feature requires the Call Centre
Feature Enhancement activation key. If this activation key is not installed, the Start Monitor button is greyed
out.
Basic Settings—Layout
Specifies the layout of monitoring results.
Value Range
1 Group, 4 Groups
Value Range
ICD groups
Value Range
Standard, Simple
Value Range
1–30
Value Range
0–10’00
Value Range
Mode 1, Mode 2, Mode 3
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Supervisor selection
Selects the ACD supervisor from a drop-down list.
This operation is available only at the User (Administrator) level.
Value Range
Registered ACD supervisors
Report Profiles
Follow the procedure below to save/load ACD report profiles. The type of ACD report (Group/Agent/Call) and
filter conditions are saved in each profile.
1. Click the Report Profiles button.
2. To load a previously saved report profile, click a profile to select it, and then click the Load button.
3. To save the current report profile, assign a name in Profile Name (max. 32 characters), and then click the
Save button.
Option
Follow the procedure below to set ACD report options.
1. Click the Option button.
2. Select the ACD Report - Export CSV File Format.
Value Range
Comma(,), Semicolon(;)
3. Click OK.
Group
Group—View Report
To display a report according to groups, follow the procedure below. This feature requires the Call Centre
Feature Enhancement activation key. If this activation key is not installed, the View Report button is greyed
out.
1. Enter the report output conditions and click the View Report button.
2. The ACD Report - Group Report screen is displayed.
3. Results for the following items are displayed.
Item Description
Incoming Calls
Total The number of incoming calls received by the target ICD group.
Answered The number of incoming calls answered by the target ICD group.
Lost The number of incoming calls to the target ICD group cancelled by
the caller.
Overflow The number of overflowed incoming calls to the target ICD group.
Talk Time
Total The total talking time of answered calls for the target ICD group.
(HH:MM:SS)
Average The average talking time of answered calls for the target ICD group.
(HH:MM:SS)
Max. The longest talking time of answered calls for the target ICD group.
(HH:MM:SS)
Wait Time
Wait Time (Answered)
Total The total waiting time of answered calls for the target ICD group.
(HH:MM:SS)
Average The average waiting time of answered calls for the target ICD group.
(HH:MM:SS)
Max. The longest waiting time of answered calls for the target ICD group.
(HH:MM:SS)
Wait Time (Lost)
Total The total waiting time of cancelled calls for the target ICD group.
(HH:MM:SS)
Average The average waiting time of cancelled calls for the target ICD group.
(HH:MM:SS)
Max. The longest waiting time of cancelled calls for the target ICD group.
(HH:MM:SS)
Item Description
Max. Waiting Calls The maximum number of calls waiting in the queue of the target ICD
group.
Value Range
Group, Hour*1, Day, Date, Month, Trunk, Caller ID/CLIP
*1
If Hour is selected, set the monitoring range for the target group (0:00–23:59).
Value Range
Yesterday, Last Week, Last Month, Today, This Week, This Month, Custom Period*1
*1
If Custom Period is selected, set Start Date/Start Time/End Date/End Time also.
Agent
Agent—View Report
To display a report according to agents, follow the procedure below. This feature requires the Call Centre
Feature Enhancement activation key. If this activation key is not installed, the View Report button is greyed
out.
1. Enter the report output conditions and click the View Report button.
2. The ACD Report - Agent Report screen is displayed.
3. Results for the following items are displayed.
Item Description
Total Answer
Total Answer The number of calls that the target agent answers.
Talk Time
Total The total talking time for the target agent. (HH:MM:SS)
Average The average talking time for the target agent. (HH:MM:SS)
Max. The longest talking time for the target agent. (HH:MM:SS)
Login Time The total login time for the target agent. (HH:MM:SS)
Not-ready Time The total not ready time for the target agent. (HH:MM:SS)
Wrap-up Time The total wrap-up time for the target agent. (HH:MM:SS)
Value Range
Agent, Hour*1, Day, Date, Month
*1
If Hour is selected, set the monitoring range for the target group (0:00–23:59).
Value Range
Yesterday, Last Week, Last Month, Today, This Week, This Month, Custom Period*1
*1
If Custom Period is selected, set Start Date/Start Time/End Date/End Time also.
Call
Call—View Report
To display a report according to calls, follow the procedure below. This feature requires the Call Centre Feature
Enhancement activation key. If this activation key is not installed, the View Report button is greyed out.
1. Enter the report output conditions and click the View Report button.
2. The ACD Report - Call Report screen is displayed.
Item Description
Value Range
Yesterday, Last Week, Last Month, Today, This Week, This Month, Custom Period*1
*1
If Custom Period is selected, set Start Date/Start Time/End Date/End Time also.
Value Range
• Caller ID/CLIP Filter: Filtering according to caller ID or CLIP
1. Click Caller ID/CLIP Filter.
2. Set the target caller ID or CLIP (maximum: 10).
• Talk/Wait Duration Filter: Filtering according to continuous talking or waiting time
1. Click Talk/Wait Duration Filter.
2. Select Talk Time or Wait Time from a drop-down list.
3. Set the filtering target duration using one of the following 2 methods.
To set a minimum duration, click Min., and set the duration time (0:00–23:59).
To set a maximum duration, click Max., and set the duration time (0:00–23:59).
• Lost Call Filter: Filtering according to lost calls
1. Click Lost Call Filter.
Note
The Legacy-GW1 and Legacy-GW2 buttons will be greyed out if a STACK-M card has not been installed
or if pre-installation for the card has not been performed. For details, see To pre-install PBXs connected
to the STACK-M card below.
Note
When deleting a physical combination card, both cards must be set to OUS before selecting Delete.
IP-PT: For KX-NT300/KX-NT500 series and KX-NT265 (software version 2.00 or later) IP-PTs
(® 9.15 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—V-IPEXT32—Port Property)
Note
• If Pre-Install is not displayed as described in step 5, pre-installation has already been completed. Click
Legacy-GW1 or Legacy-GW2 on the slot screen to programme the PBXs connected to the
STACK-M card.
• For information about hardware configuration restrictions and conditions for legacy gateways, refer to
Conditions for Connecting Legacy Gateways in 4.6 Stacking Cards in the KX-NS1000 Installation
Manual.
For more information on the virtual cards and other optional cards, see the following sections in the Installation
Manual:
→ 4.4 Virtual Cards
→ 4.5 Physical Trunk and Extension Cards
For information about cards supported by legacy gateway PBXs, see "System Components for Legacy
Gateways" in the KX-NS1000 Installation Manual.
Item Description
Site Indicates the site number (1–16) of the PBX in the One-look Network where the card,
extension, or device is located. For more information about One-look Networking, see
1.2.3 PBX Configuration Types.
Shelf Indicates the physical or virtual shelf where the card, extension, or device is located
in the PBX.
• Shelf "1" is the physical shelf of the KX-NS1000 PBX.
• Shelf "2" corresponds to the physical shelf of the PBX connected to Legacy
Gateway 1.
• Shelf "3" corresponds to the physical shelf of the PBX connected to Legacy
Gateway 2.
Slot Indicates the slot number within the shelf where the card, extension, or device is
located.
Port Indicates the port number assigned to the extension or device.
Physical Shelf
The Site, Shelf, and Slot for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Card Type
Indicates the service cards installed in the slots of the physical shelf (reference only).
Value Range
Card Type:
SLC2: SLC2 card of an installed LCOT2+SLC2, BRI4+SLC2, PRI30+SLC2, or PRI23+SLC2 card
LCOT2: LCOT2 card of an installed LCOT2+SLC2 card
BRI4: BRI4 card of an installed BRI4+SLC2 card
PRI23: PRI23 card of an installed PRI23+SLC2 card
PRI30: PRI30 card of an installed PRI30+SLC2 card
DOORPHONE: DOORPHONE Card
STACK-M: Stacking Master Card for connecting PBXs as legacy gateways
Status
Indicates the card status (reference only).
Value Range
INS: The card is in service.
OUS: The card is out of service.
Fault: The card is not communicating with the network.
Pre-Install: A card has been added to the slot.
Version
Indicates the software version of the installed card (reference only).
Value Range
Version number
Virtual Shelf
The Site, Shelf, and Slot for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Slot Type
Indicates the type of card slot (reference only).
Value Range
Trunk, Extension
Card Type
Indicates the type of virtual card installed (reference only).
Value Range
V-SIPGW16, V-IPGW16, V-IPEXT32, V-SIPEXT32, V-IPCS4, V-UTEXT32
Status
Indicates the card status (reference only).
Value Range
INS: The card is in service.
OUS: The card is out of service.
Fault: The card is not communicating with the network.
Pre-Install: A card has been added to the slot.
Value Range
Card type. Available cards vary by the model of the legacy gateway.
Status
Indicates the card status (reference only).
Value Range
INS: The card is in service.
Version
Indicates the software version of the installed card (reference only).
Value Range
Version number
Note
If you have changed the value for Number of activated IP-GW, you must click Execute to restart the
V-IPGW16 cards for the change to take effect.
Similarly, you can programme how many IP softphones can be used through the IP Softphone/IP Proprietary
Telephone activation key. In Number of activated IP-Softphone, type the number of IP softphones to be used
through the IP Softphone/IP Proprietary Telephone activation key, and then click OK. The remainder is the
number of IP-PTs that can be used through the IP Softphone/IP Proprietary Telephone activation key. By
default, only IP softphones can be used.
Also, you can programme how many VPN connections can be used for multisite connections using an IPsec
(VPN) activation key. In Number of activated IPSec (VPN) for MultiSite, type the number of multisite
connections to be used through an IPsec (VPN) activation key, and then click OK. The remainder is the number
of IPsec (VPN) connections that can be used for another purpose over the VPN.
You can click the Activation Key Installation link to access the Activation Key Installation screen (see
7.6 Utility—Activation Key Installation) for installing activation keys.
• Poltys CCAccounting
• Poltys CCAcc. Enterprise
• Poltys CCView
• Poltys CCView add. PBX
• Poltys CCView Supervisor (5 users)
• Poltys CCView CRM P-up (5 users)
• Poltys Number notice
• Poltys CCAgent (5 users)
• Poltys CCRecord SIP (4 ports)
MPR-ID
Indicates the ID number of the mother board (reference only).
Value Range
ID number of the mother board
Activated Feature
Indicates the type of activation keys (reference only).
Note that the types of activation keys are subject to change without notice. For CA activation keys, refer to the
documentation for CA.
Value Range
IP Phone Capacity (ch): IP Phone capacity
IP Trunk (ch): Activate H.323 IP-GW or SIP-Trunk
IP Proprietary Telephone/IP Softphone (ch): Activate Soft-phone /IP-PT /SIP-MLT
IP Proprietary Telephone (ch): Activate IP-PT/SIP-MLT
SIP Extension (ch): Activate SIP-Phone for 3rd party /IP Conference Phone
IP-CS channel expansion: IP-CS channel expansion to 8ch
One-look Network: Multi site connection with KX-NS1000 PBXs
QSIG Network: QSIG Networking
Built-in Router: Built-in Router function
IPsec (VPN) (16 sessions): IP-VPN (IPsec) for Built-in Router
Recording Time Expansion: Recording time 2h ® 15h
Two-way Recording Control: Two-way recording (Manager control)
Message Backup: UM Message Back UP
UM Port (ch): Unified Message ports
UM/E-mail (user): Email (IMAP4) client / Email Notification (Voice/Fax message)
Two-way Recording (user): Two-way Recording / Two-way Transfer
CTI interface: CTI Server (3rd Party CTI link)
CSTA Multiplexer (session): CSTA(CTI) Multi-session
Mobile Extension (user): Working with cellular phone
CA Basic (No limit): CA Basic
CA Pro (user): CA PRO
CA Supervisor (user): CA ACD Supervisor
CA Network Feature (user): CA Network
CA Operator Console (user): CA Operator Console
CA Thin Client Server: Thin Client Server Connection
Call Centre Feature Enhancement: Built-in ACD Report, Announcement of waiting number for queuing
Poltys C. Bridge: Communication Bridge server
Poltys CA RCS-Start (user): Mobile UC client (RCS) 1year licence
Poltys CA RCS-Extend (user): Mobile UC client (RCS) 1year extension licence
Poltys CCAccounting: CCAccounting
Poltys CCAccounting A.L.: CCAccounting (annual licence)
Poltys CCAcc. Enterprise: CCAccounting Enterprise Edition Additional Connection licence
Poltys CCAcc. Enterprise A.L.: CCAccounting Enterprise Edition Additional Connection licence (annual
licence)
Poltys CCView: CCView
Poltys CCView A.L.: CCView (annual licence)
Poltys CCView add. PBX: CCView Enterprise Edition. Additional PBX Connection licence
Poltys CCView add. PBX A.L.: CCView Enterprise Edition. Additional PBX Connection licence (annual licence)
Poltys CCView Supervisor: CCView Supervisor
Poltys CCView Supervisor A.L.: CCView Supervisor (annual licence)
Poltys CCView CRM P-up: Independent Desktop CRM Popup SW with 1st Party TSP
Poltys CCView CRM P-up A.L.: Independent Desktop CRM Popup SW with 1st Party TSP (annual licence)
Poltys Number notice: Dial Number Notification
Poltys Number notice A.L.: Dial Number Notification (annual licence)
Poltys CCAgent: CCAgent With Internal CRM
Poltys CCAgent A.L.: CCAgent With Internal CRM (annual licence)
Poltys CCRecord Analogue: CCRecord Analog Extensions/Trunks
Poltys CCRecord Analogue A.L.: CCRecord Analog Extensions/Trunks (annual licence)
Poltys CCRecord Digital: CCRecord Digital Extensions
Poltys CCRecord Digital A.L.: CCRecord Digital Extensions (annual licence)
Poltys CCRecord PRI: CCRecord for E1/T1 (PRI)
Poltys CCRecord PRI A.L.: CCRecord for E1/T1 (PRI) (annual licence)
Poltys CCRecord SIP: CCRecord SIP Extensions/Trunks
Poltys CCRecord SIP A.L.: CCRecord SIP Extensions/Trunks (annual licence)
PSDN Option-1: PSDN partner’s optional licence No.1
PSDN Option-2: PSDN partner’s optional licence No.2
Pre-installed
Indicates the number of channels (or CA users) provided by the mother board (reference only).
Value Range
Not applicable.
Activation Key
Indicates the number of channels (or CA users) provided by activation key files on the Storage Memory Card
(reference only).
Value Range
Not applicable.
Features in total
Indicates the total number of channels (or CA users) provided by the mother board and activation key files on
the Storage Memory Card (reference only).
Value Range
Not applicable.
System Total
Indicates the total number of channels (or CA users) provided by activation keys in the One-look network.
Value Range
Not applicable.
Main
DSP CODEC G.711 only (SIP extension)
Specifies whether or not to only use the G.711 codec for SIP extension calls.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
0–300
System Status
CPU Usage
Displays the system CPU’s current processor load, expressed as a percentage of total capacity (reference
only).
Value Range
0–100%
Memory Usage
Displays the amount of system memory currently being used, displayed as a percentage of total capacity
(reference only).
Value Range
0–100%
Multisite
Voice Activity Detection for G.711
Enables the use of the Voice Activity Detection feature for the G.711 codec. This feature conserves bandwidth
by detecting silent periods during a call and suppressing the packets of silence from being sent to the network.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
DTMF
Specifies the type of DTMF tone to be sent out.
Value Range
Inband, Outband (RFC2833), Outband (H.245)
Payload Type
Specifies the payload type for DTMF tones using RFC2833. Programming this parameter is only necessary if
DTMF is set to Outband (RFC2833).
Value Range
96–127
Value Range
500–8000 ms, in units of 500 ms
Value Range
150–240 s
Note
The UDP port specified here and the next contiguous port will be assigned for transmission.
Example: If the value set here is 4560, ports 4560 and 4561 will be assigned.
Value Range
1024–65534
Value Range
1024–65535
Value Range
30, 40, 50, 60, 120, 180, 300, 600, 1800, 3600 s
Value Range
300, 360, 420, 480, 540, 600, 1800, 3600 s
V-IPGW
Call Signalling Model
Specifies whether to carry out a call control (H.225) process directly between the cards or through a gatekeeper.
Value Range
Direct, GateKeeper
Value Range
0 (disabled), 1–1440
Value Range
Terminal, Gateway
Gatekeeper ID to Gatekeeper
Specifies the authentication ID notified to the gatekeeper.
Value Range
Max. 20 Characters
Bandwidth to Gatekeeper
Specifies the used bandwidth information notified to the gatekeeper.
Value Range
1–255 kbps
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65000
GW Settings–Main
GW Name
Specifies the name of the destination gateway device for programming reference.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
GW IP Address
Specifies the IP address of the destination gateway device.
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
GW Group
Specifies the number of the gateway group to which the gateway entry belongs. A maximum of 256 gateway
groups can be created.
Value Range
1–256, None
Value Range
Disable (TDE), Enable (TDA)
Protocol
Specifies the type of protocol for connectionless tunnelling between gateway devices at different locations in
a QSIG network.
Value Range
TCP, UDP
Value Range
External, Internal
GW Settings–Option 1
GW Name
Specifies the name of the destination gateway device for programming reference.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
For 1st:
G.711A, G.711Mu, G.729A
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms
GW Settings–Option 2
GW Name
Specifies the name of the destination gateway device for programming reference.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
G.711 Inband, T.38
Value Range
No Speed Limit, 2400 bps, 4800 bps, 7200 bps, 9600 bps, 12000 bps, 14400 bps
Value Range
Disable, Enable
DTMF
Specifies the method to transport DTMF tones.
Value Range
Inband, Outband (RFC2833), Outband (H.245)
Payload Type
Specifies the payload type for DTMF tones using RFC2833. Programming this parameter is only necessary if
DTMF is set to Outband (RFC2833).
Value Range
96–127
GW Settings–Option 3
GW Name
Specifies the name of the destination gateway device for programming reference.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
272–512
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
0–7
Value Range
0–3
Value Range
Transferred TCF, Local TCF
DN2IP
Leading Number
Specifies the leading digits in dialled numbers by which to associate calls with the appropriate destination.
Value Range
Max. 30 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
0–29
Value Range
GW Group, GW No.
GW Group
Specifies the number of the destination gateway group. This setting is only available when GW No./GW Group
Selection on this screen is set to GW Group.
Value Range
1–256
GW No.
Specifies the number of the destination gateway device. This setting is only available when GW No./GW Group
Selection on this screen is set to GW No..
Value Range
1–512
Main
Storage Memory Size
Indicates the size of the installed storage memory card (reference only).
Value Range
Card Size
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Isolated Mode
Specifies whether the PBX will continue to operate in Isolated mode if the PBX cannot connect to the Master
unit or the Backup Master unit (if set).
Note
• This setting is available for Slave unit PBXs in a One-look network that are not designated as the
Backup Master unit.
• When this item is set to "Disable", system functions for the site will become unavailable if the Master
unit and/or Backup Master unit fails.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
P2P Group
Specifies the peer-to-peer group of the site.
Value Range
1–256
Value Range
P2P Group Name
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Manual, Full Automatic, Extension Input
Value Range
Manual, Full Automatic
VoIP-DSP Options
The settings in this tab relate to IP extensions and IP trunks.
Value Range
0–117
Value Range
0–64
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
0–200 ms
Value Range
0–200 ms
Value Range
0–200 ms
Value Range
1000–65530 ms
Value Range
0–200 ms
Value Range
0–200 ms
Value Range
0–200 ms
Value Range
1000–65530 ms
Value Range
-45– -12 dB
Value Range
-39– -6 dB
Value Range
20–5000 ms
Value Range
20–5000 ms
Value Range
1–3
Value Range
OFF, ON
Value Range
50 ´ n (n=1–100) ms
Value Range
20 ´ n (n=1–250) ms
Value Range
20 ´ n (n=1–250) ms
Value Range
1–3
Value Range
Off, On
Value Range
50 ´ n (n=1–100) ms
Value Range
-13–2 dB
Value Range
-7–8 dB
Value Range
-13–2 dB
Value Range
-7–8 dB
VoIP-DSP Options 2
The settings in this tab relate to communications within a One-look network.
Value Range
64 ms, 128 ms, Off
Value Range
-14–6 dB
Value Range
-14–6 dB
EC Gain
Specifies the Echo Canceller Gain.
Value Range
-14–6 dB
NLP Setting
Specifies the NLP (Non-Linear Processor) setting to control echo sound quality.
Value Range
Disable, Weak, Normal, Strong
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
0–200 ms
Value Range
0–200 ms
Value Range
0–200 ms
Value Range
1000–65530 ms
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms
Port Number
Voice (RTP) UDP Port No. (Server)
Specifies the UDP port used by the system to transmit and receive RTP (Real-time Transfer Protocol) data.
This must be changed if another network application is using the same port.
For voice communications, the system uses 128 contiguous UDP ports, starting from the port number specified
here.
Value Range
1024–64000
For voice communications, an IP-PT uses 128 contiguous UDP ports, starting from the port number specified
here.
To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value.
Value Range
1024–65535
Value Range
1024–65535
Value Range
0–65535 (Setting "0" will close port access for this feature)
Value Range
0–65535 (Setting "0" will close port access for this feature)
Value Range
0–65535 (Setting "0" will close port access for this feature)
Value Range
0–65535 (Setting "0" will close port access for this feature)
Value Range
0–65535
Value Range
1024–65535
Value Range
1024–65535
Value Range
1024–65535
LAN Status
LINK for Main Port
Indicates the current connection status of the main port (reference only).
Value Range
1: Disconnect, 0: Connect
Value Range
1: Disconnect, 0: Connect
Media Relay
Common—NAT - External IP Address
Specifies the NAT device external IP address (common).
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
Blank UDP, None
Value Range
Blank UDP, None
Value Range
10–60 s
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
Register, Blank UDP, None
Value Range
10–60 s
Value Range
10–3600 s
UT Extension—PERIODIC Ability
Specifies whether alive monitoring is performed for connected remote extensions.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
30–3600 s
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
SIP Extension
SIP Location Hold Time Max.
Specifies the maximum length of time that the PBX holds information on the location of SIP Extensions.
Value Range
10–3600 s
Value Range
10–3600 s
Value Range
1–10 s
Value Range
90–3600 s
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 (IP address), Max. 100 characters (host name)
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 (IP address), Max. 100 characters (host name)
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 (IP address), Max. 100 characters (host name)
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
Register, Blank UDP, None
Note
• This interval must be shorter than the NAT binding time of the router. The default value is appropriate
in most cases.
• This setting is available only when NAT - Keep Alive Packet Type is set to "Blank UDP".
Value Range
10–60 s
Note
This setting is available only when NAT - Keep Alive Packet Type is set to "Register".
Value Range
10–3600 s
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 (IP address), Max. 100 characters (host name)
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
30–3600 s
Echo Cancellation
The settings in this tab are for non-IP calls.
Value Range
OFF, 64 ms, 128 ms
Value Range
-14–6 dB
Value Range
-14–6 dB
EC Gain
Specifies the Echo Canceller Gain.
Value Range
-14–6 dB
NLP Setting
Specifies the NLP (Non-Linear Processor) setting to control echo sound quality.
Value Range
Disable, Weak, Normal, Strong
DSP Conference
DSP Digital Gain (Up) on V-IPEXT side for conference
Specifies the DSP Digital Gain for the up voice path for conference calls using an extension of a V-IPEXT card.
Value Range
-14–6 dB
Value Range
-14–6 dB
Value Range
-14–6 dB
Value Range
-14–6 dB
Value Range
OFF, 64 ms, 128 ms
Value Range
-14–6 dB
Value Range
-14–6 dB
Value Range
-14–6 dB
Value Range
Disable, Weak, Normal, Strong
Status
Indicates if a FAX Card is installed in the PBX (reference only).
Value Range
Installed, None
Version
Indicates the version of the FAX Card firmware (reference only).
Value Range
Version Number
Value Range
Extension number
Value Range
OFF, 64 ms, 128 ms
Value Range
-14–6 dB
Value Range
-14–6 dB
EC Gain
Specifies the Echo Canceller Gain.
Value Range
-14–6 dB
NLP Setting
Specifies the NLP (Non-Linear Processor) setting to control echo sound quality.
Value Range
Disable, Weak, Normal, Strong
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
20–5000 ms
Value Range
20–5000 ms
Value Range
1–3
Value Range
OFF, ON
Value Range
1000–60000 (ms)
Value Range
1000–60000 (ms)
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
1000–60000 (ms)
Main
Echo Cancellation Ability
Specifies the echo canceller ability time.
Value Range
OFF, 64 ms, 128 ms
Value Range
-14–6 dB
Value Range
-14–6 dB
EC Gain
Specifies the Echo Canceller Gain.
Value Range
-14–6 dB
NLP Setting
Specifies the NLP (Non-Linear Processor) setting to control echo sound quality.
Value Range
Disable, Weak, Normal, Strong
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
20–5000 ms
Value Range
20–5000 ms
Value Range
1–3
Value Range
OFF, ON
Main
The Port for each item is displayed for your reference. For details, see Common Programming Reference
Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the port.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
UM Group Number
Selects the number of the UM group.
Value Range
1–16
Type
Indicates the types of telephones, devices, or CSs (reference only).
Value Range
IP-EXT, SIP-MLT, SIP, DPT(40V) (KX-DT300 series/KX-DT500 series/KX-T7600 series DPTs), DPT(15V)
(DPTs other than KX-DT300 series/KX-DT500 series/KX-T7600 series), APT, SLT, DSS Console, UM, VM,
Other, CS, High-density CS, IP-CS, SIP-CS, S-PS
Total Count
Indicates the total number of each type of telephone, device, and CS connected to the PBX (reference only).
CSs are counted on the basis of the number of ports in service plus the number of extension ports to which
CSs are connected. For details about CSs connected to the extension cards of legacy gateways, refer to the
documentation for the legacy gateway PBX or the CS.
Value Range
Not applicable.
Icon Description
In this section, the following icons show the different parameter type.
Main
SIP Client Port Number
Specifies the port number of the PBX used for communications with the SIP server.
Value Range
1024–65535
NAT Traversal
Specifies the NAT traversal method.
– STUN: A STUN Server, used alongside the SIP Server, finds out the global IP address of the router with
NAT enabled.
– Fixed IP Addr.: The global IP address of the router with NAT enabled is fixed.
Note
Manual programming is optional except when programming is required depending on the network
conditions.
Value Range
Off, Fixed IP Addr., STUN
Value Range
1024–65535
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Blank UDP, None
Note
This interval must be shorter than the NAT binding time of the router. The default value is appropriate in
most cases.
Value Range
1–60 s
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
STUN Ability
Specifies whether to open a protocol port of the STUN server to enable STUN feature.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
0–8
Value Range
0–1600 ms
Value Range
Disable (High->Low), Disable (Low->High), Enable
Value Range
Mode 1: Searches SIP accounts only.
Mode 2: Searches SIP accounts, then DDI/DID numbers. Searches the SIP trunks of the tenant of the
search-matched DDI/DID number, in ascending order (Low ® High).
Mode 3: Searches SIP accounts, then DDI/DID numbers. Searches the SIP trunks of the tenant of the
search-matched DDI/DID number, in descending order (High ® Low).
Value Range
Disable, Enable
100rel Ability
Specifies whether to add the option tag 100rel to the header field of the INVITE message.
Value Range
Disable: This feature is not activated.
Enable (Active): Activates this feature only if the other device supports the feature.
Enable (Passive): Activates this feature only when requested by the other device.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
ToS, DSCP, HEX
Value Range
0–7
Value Range
Normal, Monetary Cost, Reliability, Throughput, Delay
Timer
SIP T1
Specifies the retransmission interval time for INVITE requests and responses.
Value Range
5–255 ´ 100 ms
SIP T2
Specifies the retransmission interval time for INVITE responses and non-INVITE requests.
Value Range
40–255 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Icon Description
In this section, the following icons show the different parameter type.
Automatic Programming
Some of the parameters on this screen can be automatically programmed by selecting the desired SIP provider
for each virtual SIP gateway port. A maximum of 32 SIP providers can be programmed, and a different SIP
provider can be assigned to each virtual SIP gateway port.
Follow the steps below to configure a SIP provider.
1. Click Select Provider.
A dialogue box will appear. Available virtual SIP gateway port numbers are displayed in the list.
2. From the Provider menu, select the desired SIP provider.
3. Highlight the desired port numbers or click Select All to select all the virtual SIP gateway port numbers to
be assigned to the SIP provider selected in step 2.
4. Click Execute.
5. Click OK.
6. Click Apply.
Appropriate setting values designated by the SIP provider will be set in the parameters for the virtual SIP
gateway ports.
Manual Programming
Follow the steps below to programme the parameters which are not automatically programmed by selecting a
provider.
1. Click a desired tab.
2. Enter information or select from the list for each parameter.
Adding Settings to Provider Profiles
Follow the steps below to add the settings to provider profiles.
1. Click Add Provider.
A dialogue box will appear. Available virtual SIP gateway port numbers are displayed in the list.
2. Highlight the desired port numbers or click Select All to select all the virtual SIP gateway port numbers to
add the settings to provider profiles.
3. Click Execute.
Trunk Adaptor
To connect to a Trunk Adaptor, follow the steps below.
1. Ensure that the Trunk Adaptor is connected to the network and a power supply, and that all ports to be set
are OUS.
2. Click Trunk Adaptor. The Trunk Adaptor List screen is displayed.
3. Enter a name (20 characters or less) for the Trunk Adaptor in Trunk Adaptor Name.
4. Enter the Trunk Adaptor’s IP address in Trunk Adaptor IP Address.
5. To confirm that the setting is correct, click CONNECT. If the setting is correct, the Trunk Adaptor’s Web
Maintenance Console will open in a new browser window.
For details about the Trunk Adaptor’s Web Maintenance Console, refer to the documentation of the Trunk
Adaptor.
6. Click Next. The Set Trunk Adaptor window will open.
7. In Virtual SIP Gateway - Port Property - No. Range, specify From and To to select a range of SIP
connections to be used with the Trunk Adaptor. These numbers correspond to the No. column of the main
Port Property screen.
8. In Name : IP Address, select a name and IP address previously entered on the Trunk Adaptor List
screen.
9. In SIP Server Port Number, enter the SIP server’s port number.
10. In SIP Account / User Name, enter a 3- to 5-digit number in From.
11. Click Finish, and the following settings are implemented:
• Provider Name and SIP Server IP Address in the Main tab will be set to match the selected
Trunk Adaptor.
• The User Name and Authentication ID in the Account tab will be set to the value specified in
SIP Account / User Name, increased by 1 for each connection (i.e. if "401" was specified, User
Name and Authentication ID for No. 1 will be set to "401", and then for No. 2 they will be set to
"402", etc.).
12. In the Calling Party tab of the V-SIPGW—Port Property screen, set From Header—User Part to
PBX-CLIP for each port that was set to be used with the Trunk Adaptor.
Main
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Connection Attribute
Specifies whether to connect a port to a Trunk Adaptor or use it as a SIP gateway.
Value Range
SIP Provider, Trunk Adaptor
Trunk Property
Specifies the networking type of each SIP trunk.
Note
If Connection Attribute is set to "Trunk Adaptor" for the port, only "Public" will be available for this setting.
Value Range
Public, VPN
Channel Attribute
Specifies the channel property of each port to enable several sessions to be performed for one subscription
with the SIP provider.
Value Range
Basic channel: The subscriber channel that is assigned the SIP registration information.
Additional channel for SlotN (N=1–4) ChN (N=1–16): The subordinate channel that uses the same registration
information as a Basic channel for SIP sessions. Select the Slot number and the Basic channel number to
which the Additional channel belongs.
Not Used: The channel is not in use.
Note
• The Basic channel and Additional channel can belong to different V-SIPGW16 cards.
• When you save the data on the Main screen, for each virtual SIP gateway port that has Channel
Attribute set to Basic channel, the following items are checked for duplication: SIP Server Name,
SIP Server IP Address, and SIP Service Domain.
A maximum of 32 different SIP providers can be programmed.
Provider Name
Specifies the name of the SIP provider.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Note
Specify the domain name of the outbound proxy server, if provided by the SIP provider.
Value Range
Max. 100 characters
Note
Specify the IP address of the outbound proxy server, if provided by the SIP provider.
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Note
Specify the IP address of the outbound proxy server for failover, if provided by the SIP provider.
This setting cannot be changed while the V-SIPGW16 card is set to INS.
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
Max. 100 characters
Subscriber Number
Specifies the number used as the CLIP number.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, , and #)
Backup
Specifies if the port will be used in Master Backup mode to perform the functions of a port on the Master unit
PBX when the Master unit PBX fails.
Value Range
Normal, Backup
Note
The "Backup" setting is only effective when the site the card is installed in is designated as the Master
Backup unit.
P2P Group
Specifies the peer-to-peer group of the IP-Trunk.
Value Range
1–256
Value Range
P2P Group Name
Account
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
User Name
Specifies the user name (SIP Account) provided by the SIP provider.
Value Range
Max. 64 characters
Authentication ID
Specifies the authentication ID required for registration with the SIP server.
Value Range
Max. 64 characters
Authentication Password
Specifies the authentication password used for registration with the SIP provider.
Value Range
Max. 32 characters
Register
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Register Ability
Specifies whether to send the REGISTER message to the SIP server.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
10–86400 s
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Max. 100 characters
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Note
Specify the IP address of the outbound registrar server for failover, if provided by the SIP provider.
This setting cannot be changed while the V-SIPGW16 card is set to INS.
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
0-65535 s
NAT
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
STUN Server—Name
Specifies the domain name of a STUN server.
Value Range
Max. 100 characters
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Value Range
1–65535
Option
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Value Range
Disable: This feature is not activated.
Enable (Active): Activates this feature only if the other device supports the feature.
Enable (Passive): Activates this feature only when requested by the other device.
Value Range
90–3600 s
Value Range
UPDATE, re-INVITE
Value Range
UAC, UAS
Value Range
0–18000 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–255 s
Proxy-Require Option
Specifies option tags in a Proxy-Require header field so that the SIP server is notified that the client is behind
a router with NAT enabled and firewall.
Value Range
Max. 100 characters
Failover Timer(INVITE)
Specifies the amount of time to wait for a response for an INVITE request.
Value Range
0–30 s
Failover Timer(REGISTER)
Specifies the amount of time to wait for a response for a REGISTER request.
Note
• If 0 is specified, failover operation follows the T1/T2 timer.
• While monitoring failover with OPTIONS, the applicable timer setting is applied to OPTIONS as well.
• This setting cannot be changed while the V-SIPGW16 card is set to INS.
• This setting cannot be changed when an additional channel is active.
Value Range
0–30 s
Calling Party
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Header Type
Specifies the header of the SIP message in which the caller information is stored.
Value Range
From Header, P-Preferred-Identity Header
Value Range
User Name, Authentication ID, PBX-CLIP
From Header—SIP-URI
Specifies the complete SIP-URI address of the From header. The configuration in From Header—User Part
will be invalid if this parameter is set.
Value Range
Max. 100 characters
Value Range
User Name, Authentication ID, PBX-CLIP
P-Preferred-Identity Header—SIP-URI
Specifies the complete SIP-URI address of the P-Preferred-Identity header. The configuration in
P-Preferred-Identity Header—User Part will be invalid if this parameter is set.
Value Range
Max. 100 characters
Number Format
Selects the format of the CLIP number to be sent to the called party.
Value Range
International, +International, National
Remove Digit
Specifies the number of leading digits of the CLIP number to be removed. This setting is compulsory when
PBX-CLIP is selected in From Header—User Part or P-Preferred-Identity Header—User Part.
Value Range
0–32
Additional Dial
Specifies the number to be added to the CLIP number in the place of the removed digits. This setting is
compulsory when PBX-CLIP is selected in From Header—User Part or P-Preferred-Identity Header—User
Part.
Value Range
Max. 20 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Display name and SIP-URI, Display name only
Note
If "Display name and SIP-URI" is selected, the display name part and the SIP-URI of the "From" header
will be displayed as "Anonymous".
[Example]
From: Anonymous <sip:[email protected]>
If "Display name only" is selected, only the display name part of the "From" header will be displayed as
"Anonymous".
[Example]
From: Anonymous <sip:[email protected]>
P-Asserted-Identity header
Select whether to include a P-Asserted-Identity header with caller information. This header will be sent
independent of the selection for Header Type (From Header/P-Preferred-Identity Header).
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Note
• To copy values from one location to another, click Copy to.
• If the Channel Attribute setting of the port is "Additional", the setting cannot be changed.
Called Party
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Number Format
Specifies the format of an incoming call number.
Value Range
International, +International, National
Type
Specifies the header of the incoming SIP message in which the dialled number is stored.
Value Range
Request-URI, To header
Value Range
Max. 16 characters
Value Range
Max. 16 characters
Value Range
Max. 7 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Voice/FAX
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Value Range
G.711A, G.711Mu, G.729A, None
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Note
Annex B expansion features for the G.729 codec are not supported by the V-SIPGW16 card. However, it
is necessary to inform some carriers of this fact to avoid having calls disconnected. Carriers can be
informed by enabling this feature.
Value Range
G.711 Inband, T.38
Value Range
No Speed Limit, 2400 bps, 4800 bps, 7200 bps, 9600 bps, 12000 bps, 14400 bps
Value Range
Disable, Enable
DTMF
Specifies the method to transport DTMF tones.
Value Range
Inband, Outband (RFC2833), Outband (SIP INFO)
Payload Type
Specifies the payload type of RFC2833 for DTMF tones.
Note
Manual programming is required if DTMF is set to Outband (RFC2833).
Value Range
96–127
RTP/RTCP
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Value Range
ToS, DSCP, HEX
Value Range
0–7
Value Range
Normal, Monetary Cost, Reliability, Throughput, Delay
RTP QoS-DSCP
Specifies the value in the ToS field by a DSCP for DiffServ.
Value Range
0–63
RTP QoS-HEX
Specifies the value in the ToS field by a hexadecimal number.
Value Range
00–FF
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
5–60 s
Value Range
0 s, 10 s, 20 s, 30 s, 40 s, 50 s, 60 s
T.38
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Value Range
272–512
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
0–7
Value Range
0–3
Value Range
Transferred TCF, Local TCF
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Blank UDP
T.38 Option
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Value Range
ToS, DSCP, HEX
Value Range
0–7
Value Range
Normal, Monetary Cost, Reliability, Throughput, Delay
Value Range
0–63
Value Range
00–FF
DSP
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Value Range
OFF, 64 ms, 128 ms
Value Range
-14–6 dB
Value Range
-14–6 dB
EC Gain
Specifies the Echo Canceller Gain.
Value Range
-14–6 dB
NLP Setting
Specifies the NLP (Non-Linear Processor) setting to control echo sound quality.
Value Range
Disable, Weak, Normal, Strong
Supplementary Service
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
CLIP (Receive)
Specify where caller information about an incoming call is obtained:
• Prioritised: P-Asserted-Identity®P-Preferred-Identity®From Header
• Fixed: From Header
Value Range
P-Asserted-Identity Header, From Header
Note
• To copy values from one location to another, click Copy to.
• If the Channel Attribute setting of the port is "Additional", the setting cannot be changed.
CLIR
Specifies whether to allow restriction of the display of the CLIP number on the called party’s telephone when
making a SIP trunk call.
Value Range
Yes, No
CNIP (Send)
Specifies whether to send the caller’s name to be displayed on the called party’s telephone when making a
SIP trunk call.
Value Range
Yes, No
CNIP (Receive)
Specifies whether to receive the caller’s name to be displayed on the called party’s telephone when receiving
a SIP trunk call.
Value Range
Yes, No
Blind Transfer(REFER)
Specifies whether to allow blind transfers using REFER.
Value Range
Yes, No
Attended Transfer(REFER)
Specifies whether to allow attended transfers using REFER.
Value Range
Yes, No
Advanced
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Diversion Header
Enable this setting to allow the specified SIP trunks to detect incoming Mobile Device Access calls from
MEX-enabled mobile devices.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Main
Gatekeeper Available
Specifies whether to use a gatekeeper. This setting can only be changed when all V-IPGW cards are set to
OUS.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
5–60 s
Value Range
ToS, DSCP, HEX
Value Range
0–7
Value Range
Normal, Monetary Cost, Reliability, Throughput, Delay
RTP QoS-DSCP
Specifies the value in the ToS field by a DSCP for DiffServ.
Value Range
0–63
RTP QoS-HEX
Specifies the value in the ToS field by a hexadecimal number.
Value Range
00–FF
Value Range
ToS, DSCP, HEX
Value Range
0–7
Value Range
Normal, Monetary Cost, Reliability, Throughput, Delay
Value Range
0–63
Value Range
00–FF
Value Range
OFF, 64 ms, 128 ms
Value Range
-14–6 dB
Value Range
-14–6 dB
EC Gain
Specifies the Echo Canceller Gain.
Value Range
-14–6 dB
NLP Setting
Specifies the NLP (Non-Linear Processor) setting to control echo sound quality.
Value Range
Disable, Weak, Normal, Strong
QSIG-CT
Enables a call to be transferred to a destination extension at another PBX in a QSIG network.
Value Range
No, Yes
QSIG-CF
Enables a call to be forwarded to a destination extension at another PBX in a QSIG network.
Value Range
No, Yes
Trunk Property
Indicates the networking type of each trunk.
Value Range
Public, Private, VPN
Outgoing Call
First-digit Timer (T302-1)
Specifies the length of time within which the first digit of a dial number must be dialled after seizing a virtual IP
trunk.
Value Range
5–30 s
Value Range
1–10 s
Value Range
0–9, #, *
Incoming Call
Voice Activity Detection for G.711
Enables the use of the Voice Activity Detection feature for the G.711 codec. This feature conserves bandwidth
by detecting silent periods during a call and suppressing the packets of silence from being sent to the network.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
G.711A, G.711Mu, G.729A
Value Range
None, G.711A, G.711Mu, G.729A
Value Range
None, G.711A, G.711Mu, G.729A
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
G.711 Inband, T.38
Value Range
No Speed Limit, 2400 bps, 4800 bps, 7200 bps, 9600 bps, 12000 bps, 14400 bps
DTMF
Specifies the type of DTMF tone to be sent out.
Value Range
Inband, Outband (RFC2833), Outband (H.245)
Payload Type
Specifies the payload type for DTMF tones using RFC2833. Programming this parameter is only necessary if
DTMF is set to Outband (RFC2833).
Value Range
96–127
Value Range
272–512
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
0–7
Value Range
0–3
Value Range
Transferred TCF, Local TCF
Timer
T301
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after making a call.
Value Range
0–18000 ´ 100 ms
T302
Specifies the maximum time allowed between each digit on an incoming call. Applies to overlap receiving.
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
T303
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the SETUP (call setting) message.
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
T304
Specifies the maximum time allowed between each digit on an outgoing call. Applies to overlap sending.
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
T305
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the DISC (disconnection) message.
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
T308
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after receiving the Release message.
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
T309
Specifies the length of time after which the PBX tries to disconnect the data link, before disconnecting the call.
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
T310
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a continuance message after receiving the Incoming Call
Proceeding message.
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
T313
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Connect message.
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
T316
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Restart message.
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
T318
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Resume message.
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
T319
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Suspend message.
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
T322
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Status enquiry message.
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
T3D3
Specifies the length of time after which the PBX tries to establish L2 in "Permanent" mode.
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
T3D9
Specifies the length of time after which the PBX tries to disconnect L2 in "Call by Call" mode.
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
Destination Number
Specifies a telephone number to register with a gatekeeper.
Value Range
Max. 30 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Device Name
Specifies the name of the device for programming reference.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 30 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
For 1st:
CDPG1–CDPG48
For 2nd–16th:
None, CDPG1–CDPG48
Trunk Adaptor
To connect to a Trunk Adaptor, follow the steps below.
1. Ensure that the Trunk Adaptor is connected to the network and a power supply, and that all ports to be set
are OUS.
2. Click Trunk Adaptor. The Trunk Adaptor List screen is displayed.
3. Enter a name (20 characters or less) for the Trunk Adaptor in Trunk Adaptor Name.
4. Enter the Trunk Adaptor’s IP address in Trunk Adaptor IP Address.
5. To confirm that the setting is correct, click CONNECT. If the setting is correct, the Trunk Adaptor’s Web
Maintenance Console will open in a new browser window.
For details about the Trunk Adaptor’s Web Maintenance Console, refer to the documentation of the Trunk
Adaptor.
6. Click OK.
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Connection Attribute
Specifies whether to connect a port to a Trunk Adaptor or use it as an IP gateway.
Value Range
Gateway, Trunk Adaptor
Value Range
1–48
Value Range
1024–65535
Value Range
1024–65535
Value Range
2427
Value Range
Disable, 10–120 s
Value Range
500 ´ n (n=1–16) ms
Value Range
150–240 s
Value Range
500 ´ n (n=1–8) ms
Value Range
75–120 s
Note
For KX-NT500 series phones, in place of this setting, the setting for Echo Cancellation Ability in
9.20 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—V-UTEXT32—Card Property—Main is applied.
Value Range
OFF, 64 ms, 128 ms
Note
For KX-NT500 series phones, in place of this setting, the setting for DSP Digital Gain (Down) in
9.20 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—V-UTEXT32—Card Property—Main is applied.
Value Range
-14–6 dB
Note
For KX-NT500 series phones, in place of this setting, the setting for DSP Digital Gain (Up) in 9.20 PBX
Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—V-UTEXT32—Card Property—Main is applied.
Value Range
-14–6 dB
EC Gain
Specifies the Echo Canceller Gain.
Note
For KX-NT500 series phones, in place of this setting, the setting for EC Gain in 9.20 PBX
Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—V-UTEXT32—Card Property—Main is applied.
Value Range
-14–6 dB
NLP Setting
Specifies the NLP (Non-Linear Processor) setting to control echo sound quality.
Note
For KX-NT500 series phones, in place of this setting, the setting for NLP Setting in 9.20 PBX
Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—V-UTEXT32—Card Property—Main is applied.
Value Range
Disable, Weak, Normal, Strong
Note
Registration, De-registration, and Forced De-registration cannot be performed for ports set as secondary
extensions. For details, see Secondary Setting below.
Preparation
Open 28.1 Network Service—[1] IP Address/Ports—Basic Settings, and confirm that the IP addresses of
the mother board and DSP card, subnet mask address, and default gateway address are set.
Registration
Follow the steps below to register the IP-PT.
1. Connect the IP-PT to be registered to the network and, if necessary, the power supply.
2. Click Registration.
A dialogue box will appear. Non-registered (available) extension numbers and names are displayed on the
left.
3. Highlight numbers and names and click the right arrow to select them for registration. Click Next.
4. Click Next.
5. If the registration is still in progress, the dialogue box will show "Registration Executing".
If the registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "Registration Completed". Click Close.
Once the IP-PT is successfully registered, the status of the IP-PT will update to show "Registered".
De-registration
Follow the steps below to de-register the IP-PT.
1. Click De-registration.
A dialogue box will appear. Registered extension numbers and names are displayed on the left.
2. Highlight numbers and names and click the right arrow to select them for de-registration. Click Next.
A dialogue box will appear.
3. Click Confirm.
If the de-registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "De-registration Succeed".
4. Click Close.
Once the IP-PT is successfully de-registered, the status of the IP-PT will update to show "None".
Forced De-registration
Follow the steps below to forcibly de-register the IP-PT when normal de-registration has been unsuccessful
or IP address settings have been changed or deleted only on the IP-PT.
Main
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Note
Settings for ports that have been set as secondary ports for IP extensions in the Secondary Setting tab
cannot be changed on this screen.
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the port.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the extension name of the port.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Status
Indicates whether a certain IP-PT is registered (reference only).
Value Range
None, Registered
Value Range
00:00:00:00:00:00–FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF
Current IP Address
Indicates the current IP address of the IP-PT (reference only).
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Program Ver.
Indicates the programme software file version of the IP-PT (reference only).
Value Range
Version number
P2P Group
Specifies the peer-to-peer group of the IP-PT.
Value Range
1–256
Value Range
P2P Group Name
Option
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the port.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the extension name of the port.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Headset OFF/ON
Turns on or off the use of a headset with the IP-PT.
Value Range
Headset OFF, Headset ON
Value Range
PT-Tone, Headset
Ringing Tone
Selects the dual-tone switching pattern of the ring tone for incoming calls.
Value Range
A: 64 ms (697 Hz), 64 ms (852 Hz)
B: 32 ms (697 Hz), 32 ms (852 Hz)
C: 128 ms (697 Hz), 128 ms (852 Hz)
D: 32 ms (697 Hz), 96 ms (852 Hz)
IP Codec Priority
Specifies the codec used for compression and decompression of transmitted data.
Some codecs may become unavailable depending on the value set here, as follows:
– When G.722 is selected, the priority is G.722 ® G.711 ® G.729A.
– When G.711 is selected, the priority is G.711 ® G.729A (G.722 is unavailable).
– When G.729A is selected, both G.711 and G.722 are unavailable.
Value Range
G.711, G.729A, G.722
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 60 ms
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 60 ms
Announce Mode
Specifies if the extension’s built-in ANNOUNCE feature is enabled. A KX-NT265, KX-NT300 series, or
KX-NT500 series phone in a remote location with ANNOUNCE enabled can provide the PBX’s IP Address
information to other terminals in the remote location in place of manually programming the PBX’s IP address
at each terminal.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Voice
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the port.
Note
This setting cannot be changed on this screen until the port has been assigned as a secondary port using
the Set Secondary command. See Setting Secondary Ports below for details.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the extension name of the port.
Note
This setting cannot be changed on this screen until the port has been assigned as a secondary port using
the Set Secondary command. See Setting Secondary Ports below for details.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
DTMF
Specifies the type of DTMF tone to be sent out.
Value Range
Inband, Outband (RFC2833)
Payload Type
Specifies the payload type for DTMF tones using RFC2833. Programming this parameter is only necessary if
DTMF is set to Outband (RFC2833).
Value Range
96–127
Secondary Setting
The settings on this screen are for programming the Automatic Rerouting to Secondary PBX feature for use
among IP extensions in a networked environment. For details and conditions regarding the use of this feature,
refer to "4.2.3.2 Automatic Rerouting to Secondary PBX" in the Feature Guide.
Note
Ports that are already assigned as secondary ports will not be displayed in this list.
6. Click Execute. A message confirming the registration will be displayed.
7. Repeat steps 2–6 for each site where you want to designate secondary ports.
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the port.
Note
This setting cannot be changed on this screen until the port has been assigned as a secondary port using
the Set Secondary command. See Setting Secondary Ports above for details.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the extension name of the port.
Note
This setting cannot be changed on this screen until the port has been assigned as a secondary port using
the Set Secondary command. See Setting Secondary Ports above for details.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Primary/Secondary
Specifies the designation of the port as a primary port or secondary port.
Note
If an extension has been registered to the port, this setting cannot be changed from "Primary" to
"Secondary". De-register the port to change this setting.
Value Range
Primary, Secondary
Pair Site
Indicates the site where the assigned secondary port is located (reference only).
Note
A value will be displayed here only after the Set Secondary command has been executed (see above).
Value Range
Site number and name
Pair Slot
Indicates the number of the virtual card slot in the site where the assigned secondary port is located (reference
only).
Note
A value will be displayed here only after the Set Secondary command has been executed (see above).
Value Range
Virtual slot number
Pair Port
Indicates the port number of the assigned secondary port (reference only).
Note
A value will be displayed here only after the Set Secondary command has been executed (see above).
Value Range
Port number
Remote Place
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the port.
Note
This setting cannot be changed on this screen until the port has been assigned as a secondary port using
the Set Secondary command. See Setting Secondary Ports above for details.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the extension name of the port.
Note
This setting cannot be changed on this screen until the port has been assigned as a secondary port using
the Set Secondary command. See Setting Secondary Ports above for details.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port. This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Phone Location
Specifies the type of extension connected to the port.
Value Range
Local: The extension is located on the same network as the PBX (standard configuration).
Remote (MRG): The extension is accessing the PBX remotely (use Media Relay Gateway).
Value Range
OFF, 64 ms, 128 ms
Value Range
-14–6 dB
Value Range
-14–6 dB
EC Gain
Specifies the Echo Canceller Gain.
Value Range
-14–6 dB
NLP Setting
Specifies the NLP (Non-Linear Processor) setting to control echo sound quality.
Value Range
Disable, Weak, Normal, Strong
Main
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the port.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Password
Specifies the password used for registering a SIP Extension to the PBX. While it is possible to enter a password
manually for each SIP Extension, you can copy Extension Number to Password by clicking the Copy
to button. This parameter can only be modified when the virtual SIP extension port is set to OUS, and the
programmer must be in On-line mode.
Value Range
4–16 characters (consisting of 0–9, a–z, A–Z)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Current IP Address
Indicates the current IP address of the SIP Extension (reference only).
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
P2P Group
Specifies the peer-to-peer group.
Value Range
1–256
Value Range
P2P Group Name
MWI Method
Selects the method of receiving Message Waiting Indications for SIP extensions.
Value Range
Standard, Unsolicited
Note
If "Standard" is selected, a maximum of 64 SIP extensions can be used.
Option
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the port.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Password
Specifies the password used for registering a SIP Extension to the PBX. While it is possible to enter a password
manually for each SIP Extension, you can copy the value for Extension Number to Password by clicking
the Copy to button. This parameter can only be modified when the virtual SIP extension port is set to OUS,
and the programmer must be in On-line mode.
Value Range
4–16 characters (consisting of 0–9, a–z, A–Z)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port. This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service
OUS: The port is out of service
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Bearer
Selects the bearer mode. When Automatic is selected, the bearer mode is set to Speech automatically.
Value Range
Automatic, Speech, Audio
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms
Remote Place
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the port.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Password
Specifies the password used for registering a SIP Extension to the PBX. While it is possible to enter a password
manually for each SIP Extension, you can copy the value for Extension Number to Password by clicking
the Copy to button. This parameter can only be modified when the virtual SIP extension port is set to OUS,
and the programmer must be in On-line mode.
Value Range
4–16 characters (consisting of 0–9, a–z, A–Z)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port. This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service
OUS: The port is out of service
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Phone Location
Specifies the type of extension connected to the port.
Value Range
Local: The extension is located on the same network as the PBX (standard configuration).
Remote (MRG): The extension is accessing the PBX remotely (Media Relay Gateway).
FAX/T.38
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the port.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Password
Specifies the password used for registering a SIP Extension to the PBX. While it is possible to enter a password
manually for each SIP Extension, you can copy the value for Extension Number to Password by clicking
the Copy to button. This parameter can only be modified when the virtual SIP extension port is set to OUS,
and the programmer must be in On-line mode.
Value Range
4–16 characters (consisting of 0–9, a–z, A–Z)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port. This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service
OUS: The port is out of service
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
G.711 Inband, T.38
Value Range
No Speed Limit, 2400 bps, 4800 bps, 7200 bps, 9600 bps, 12000 bps, 14400 bps
Value Range
272–512
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
0–7
Value Range
0–3
Value Range
Transferred TCF, Local TCF
Value Range
1024–65535
Value Range
1024–65535
Value Range
2427
Value Range
1024–65024
Value Range
Disable, 10–120 s
Value Range
500 ´ n (n=1–16) ms
Value Range
150–240 s
Value Range
500 ´ n (n=1–8) ms
Value Range
75–120 s
CS Repeater Mode
Specifies the CS Repeater Mode setting. If Normal is selected, DECT communication will not be encrypted.
To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value.
Value Range
Normal, Optional
Note
Registration, De-registration, and Forced De-registration cannot be performed for ports set as secondary
IP-CSs. For details, see Secondary Setting below.
Preparation
Open 28.1 Network Service—[1] IP Address/Ports—Basic Settings, and confirm that the IP addresses of
the mother board and DSP card, subnet mask address, and default gateway address are set.
Registration
Follow the steps below to register the IP-CS.
1. Connect the IP-CS to be registered to the network and, if necessary, the power supply.
2. Click Registration.
A dialogue box will appear. Non-registered (available) IP-CSs are displayed on the left.
3. Highlight IP-CSs and click the right arrow to select them for registration. Click Next.
4. If the registration is still in progress, the dialogue box will show "Registration Executing".
If the registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "Registration Completed". Click Close.
Once the IP-CS is successfully registered, the status of the IP-CS will update to show "Registered".
De-registration
Follow the steps below to de-register the IP-CS.
1. Click De-registration.
A dialogue box will appear. Registered IP-CSs are displayed on the left.
2. Highlight IP-CSs and click the right arrow to select them for de-registration. Click Next.
A dialogue box will appear.
3. Click Confirm.
If the de-registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "De-registration Succeed".
4. Click Close.
Once the IP-CS is successfully de-registered, the status of the IP-CS will update to show "None".
Forced De-registration
Follow the steps below to forcibly de-register the IP-CS when normal de-registration has been unsuccessful
or IP address settings have been changed or deleted only on the IP-CS.
1. Click Forced De-registration.
A dialogue box will appear. Registered IP-CSs are displayed on the left.
2. Highlight IP-CSs and click the right arrow to select them for forced de-registration. Click Next.
A dialogue box will appear.
3. Click OK.
A dialogue box will appear.
4. Click Confirm.
If the de-registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "Forced De-registration Succeed".
5. Click Close.
Once the IP-CS is successfully de-registered, the status of the IP-CS will update to show "None".
Main
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
CS Name
Specifies the CS name of the port.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Status
Indicates whether a certain IP-CS is registered (reference only).
Value Range
None, Registered
Channel expansion
Specifies whether to expand the number of channels for the IP-CS. This setting is available only for
KX-NS0154 IP-CSs. This setting will be greyed out if the IP-CS’s port is not set to OUS, or a non-supported
type of IP-CS (e.g., KX-NCP0158) is connected to the port.
Value Range
For KX-NS0154: Yes, No
For other IP-CSs: - (hyphen)
MAC Address
Indicates the MAC address of the IP-CS (reference only).
Value Range
00:00:00:00:00:00–FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF
Current IP Address
Indicates the current IP address of the IP-CS (reference only).
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Program Ver.
Indicates the programme software file version of the IP-CS (reference only).
Value Range
Version number
Value Range
None, 1–16
Value Range
None, 1–16
Option
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
CS Name
Specifies the CS name of the port.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
IP Codec Priority
Specifies the codec used for compression and decompression of transmitted data.
Value Range
G.711, G.729A
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Announce Mode
Specifies if the IP-CS’s (KX-NS0154 only) built-in ANNOUNCE feature is enabled. An IP-CS (KX-NS0154 only)
in a remote location with ANNOUNCE enabled can provide the PBX’s IP Address information to other terminals
in the remote location in place of manually programming the PBX’s IP address at each terminal.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Secondary Setting
The settings on this screen are for programming the Automatic Rerouting to Secondary PBX feature for use
among IP-CSs (KX-NS0154 only) in a networked environment. For details and conditions regarding the use
of this feature, refer to "4.2.3.2 Automatic Rerouting to Secondary PBX" in the Feature Guide.
Note
Ports that are already assigned as secondary ports will not be displayed in this list.
6. Click Execute. A message confirming the registration will be displayed.
7. Repeat steps 2–6 for each site where you want to designate secondary ports.
Removing Secondary Port Settings
Follow the steps below to remove secondary port settings for IP-CSs.
1. Click Remove Secondary. A dialogue box will appear.
2. Primary ports of extensions that have secondary ports assigned are displayed on the left. Select the IP-CSs
whose secondary setting you want to remove, and then click the right arrow.
3. Click Execute. A message confirming the setting removal will be displayed.
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
CS Name
Specifies the IP-CS (KX-NS0154 only) name of the port.
Note
This setting cannot be changed on this screen until the port has been assigned as a secondary port using
the Set Secondary command. See Setting Secondary Ports above for details.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Primary/Secondary
Specifies the designation of the port as a primary port or secondary port.
Note
If an extension has been registered to the port, this setting cannot be changed from "Primary" to
"Secondary". De-register the port to change this setting.
Value Range
Primary, Secondary
Pair Site
Indicates the site where the assigned secondary port is located (reference only).
Note
A value will be displayed here only after the Set Secondary command has been executed (see above).
Value Range
Site number and name
Pair Slot
Indicates the slot number of the assigned secondary port (reference only).
Note
A value will be displayed here only after the Set Secondary command has been executed (see above).
Value Range
Slot number
Pair Port
Indicates the port number of the assigned secondary port (reference only).
Note
A value will be displayed here only after the Set Secondary command has been executed (see above).
Value Range
Port number
Remote Place
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
CS Name
Specifies the IP-CS (KX-NS0154 only) name of the port.
Note
This setting cannot be changed on this screen until the port has been assigned as a secondary port using
the Set Secondary command. See Setting Secondary Ports above for details.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Phone Location
Specifies the location of IP-CS (KX-NS0154 only) connected to the port.
Value Range
Local: The IP-CS is located on the same network as the PBX (standard configuration).
Remote (MRG): The IP-CS is accessing the PBX remotely (use Media Relay Gateway).
Main
Echo Cancellation Ability
Specifies the echo canceller ability time.
Value Range
OFF, 64 ms, 128 ms
Value Range
-14–6 dB
Value Range
-14–6 dB
EC Gain
Specifies the Echo Canceller Gain.
Value Range
-14–6 dB
NLP Setting
Specifies the NLP (Non-Linear Processor) setting to control echo sound quality.
Value Range
Disable, Weak, Normal, Strong
PERIODIC Inform
Specifies whether alive monitoring is performed for connected extensions.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
30–3600 s
Value Range
2–10 times
Value Range
1–24 hours
Note
For SIP-CSs, primary PBX and secondary PBX settings must be made through the Web programming
interface of the Master SIP-CS or through configuration file programming. For details, refer to the
documentation of the SIP-CS.
Value Range
0–64 s
KX-UT Series SIP Phone, S-PS, and SIP-CS Registration and De-registration
A KX-UT series SIP phone, S-PS, or SIP-CS must be registered to the PBX by programming the PBX and SIP
phone, S-PS, or SIP-CS before it can be used.
Programming instructions for the PBX are given below.
It is possible to de-register the SIP phone, S-PS, or SIP-CS later.
Registration, De-registration, and Forced De-registration can be performed only in On-line mode.
Note
Registration, De-registration, and Forced De-registration cannot be performed for ports set as secondary
extensions. For details, see Secondary Setting below.
Preparation
Open 28.1 Network Service—[1] IP Address/Ports—Basic Settings, and confirm that the IP addresses of
the mother board and DSP card, subnet mask address, and default gateway address are set.
Registration
Follow the steps below to register a SIP phone.
1. Connect the device to be registered to the network and, if necessary, the power supply.
2. Click Registration.
A dialogue box will appear. Non-registered (available) extension numbers and names are displayed on the
left.
3. Highlight numbers and names and click the right arrow to select them for registration. Click Next.
4. Click Next.
5. If the registration is still in progress, the dialogue box will show "Registration Executing".
If the registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "Registration Completed". Click Close.
Once the device is successfully registered, the status of the device will update to show "Registered".
Note
S-PSs and SIP-CSs will be automatically registered to the PBX after settings have been made via CS web
programming for the Super Master CS. For details, refer to the documentation for the SIP-CS.
De-registration
Follow the steps below to de-register a SIP phone, S-PS, or SIP-CS.
1. Click De-registration.
A dialogue box will appear. Registered extension numbers and names are displayed on the left.
2. Highlight numbers and names and click the right arrow to select them for de-registration. Click Next.
A dialogue box will appear.
3. Click Confirm.
If the de-registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "De-registration Succeed".
4. Click Close.
Once the device is successfully de-registered, the status of the device will update to show "None".
Forced De-registration
Follow the steps below to forcibly de-register a SIP phone, S-PS, or SIP-CS when normal de-registration has
been unsuccessful or IP address settings have been changed or deleted only on the target device.
1. Click Forced De-registration.
A dialogue box will appear. Registered extension numbers and names are displayed on the left.
2. Highlight numbers and names and click the right arrow to select them for forced de-registration. Click
Next.
A dialogue box will appear.
3. Click OK.
A dialogue box will appear.
4. Click Confirm.
If the de-registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "Forced De-registration Succeed".
5. Click Close.
Once the device is successfully de-registered, the status of the device will update to show "None".
SIP-CS Web
To access the system’s Super Master CS for related programming, click SIP-CS Web. The CS Web login
screen will open in your web browser.
Note
For this button to be enabled, you must specify the URL of the Super Master CS on the Utility—CS-Web
Connection screen. See 7.12 Utility—CS-Web Connection.
Main
The Site, Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Note
Settings for ports that have been set as secondary ports for IP extensions in the Secondary Setting tab
cannot be changed on this screen.
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the port.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the extension name of the port.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Telephone Type
Specifies the connected device type.
Note
• This setting cannot be changed if a device has already been registered for the port. De-register the
device set for the port before changing the setting.
• To change this setting when programming in Off-line mode, and a device is already registered to the
port, change the setting of IP Phone Registration ID (MAC Address) for the port to
"00:00:00:00:00:00", and then click Apply. The setting can then be changed.
Value Range
UT: A KX-UT series SIP phone is connected.
S-PS: A SIP Portable Station phone is connected.
SIP-CS: A SIP Cell Station is connected.
Master-CS: A SIP Master Cell Station is connected.
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Password
Specifies the password used for registering a SIP phone, S-PS, or SIP-CS to the PBX. This parameter can
only be modified when the virtual SIP extension port is set to OUS.
Value Range
4–16 characters (consisting of 0–9, a–z, A–Z)
Status
Indicates whether a certain SIP phone, S-PS, or SIP-CS is registered (reference only).
Value Range
None, Registered
Value Range
00:00:00:00:00:00–FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF
Note
For S-PSs and SIP-CSs, this value will be "FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF".
Current IP Address
Indicates the current IP address of the SIP phone, S-PS, or SIP-CS (reference only).
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Program Ver.
Indicates the programme software file version of the SIP phone (reference only).
Note
Software file version numbers are not displayed for S-PSs or SIP-CSs.
Value Range
Version number
P2P Group
Specifies the peer-to-peer group.
Value Range
1–256
Value Range
P2P Group Name
Option
The Site, Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the port.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the extension name of the port.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
SIP QoS-DSCP
Specifies the value in the ToS field by a DSCP for DiffServ.
Value Range
0–63
RTP QoS-DSCP
Specifies the value in the ToS field by a DSCP for DiffServ.
Value Range
0–63
Value Range
G.722, G711A, G.729A, G711Mu, None
Value Range
20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms
Value Range
3–50 ms
Value Range
1–2 ms
Value Range
1–7 ms
Gain Type
Specifies the type of gain file to distribute to connected SIP devices.
Value Range
Default, Type1, Type2, Type3
Secondary Setting
The settings on this screen are for programming the Automatic Rerouting to Secondary PBX feature for use
among IP extensions in a networked environment. For details and conditions regarding the use of this feature,
refer to "4.2.3.2 Automatic Rerouting to Secondary PBX" in the Feature Guide.
Note
Ports that are already assigned as secondary ports will not be displayed in this list.
6. Click Execute. A message confirming the registration will be displayed.
7. Repeat steps 2–6 for each site where you want to designate secondary ports.
Removing Secondary Port Settings
Follow the steps below to remove secondary port settings for IP extensions.
1. Click Remove Secondary. A dialogue box will appear.
2. Primary ports of extensions that have secondary ports assigned are displayed on the left. Select the
extensions whose secondary setting you want to remove, and then click the right arrow.
3. Click Execute. A message confirming the setting removal will be displayed.
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the port.
Note
This setting cannot be changed on this screen until the port has been assigned as a secondary port using
the Set Secondary command. See Setting Secondary Ports above for details.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the extension name of the port.
Note
This setting cannot be changed on this screen until the port has been assigned as a secondary port using
the Set Secondary command. See Setting Secondary Ports above for details.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Primary/Secondary
Specifies the designation of the port as a primary port or secondary port.
Note
If an extension has been registered to the port, this setting cannot be changed from "Primary" to
"Secondary". De-register the port to change this setting.
Value Range
Primary, Secondary
Pair Site
Indicates the site where the assigned secondary port is located (reference only).
Note
A value will be displayed here only after the Set Secondary command has been executed (see above).
Value Range
Site number and name
Pair Slot
Indicates the number of the virtual card slot in the site where the assigned secondary port is located (reference
only).
Note
A value will be displayed here only after the Set Secondary command has been executed (see above).
Value Range
Virtual slot number
Pair Port
Indicates the port number of the assigned secondary port (reference only).
Note
A value will be displayed here only after the Set Secondary command has been executed (see above).
Value Range
Port number
Remote Place
The settings on this screen are for programming the Simple Remote Connection feature for connecting SIP
phones in remote locations to the PBX. For details and conditions regarding the use of this feature, refer to
"5.2.2.3 Simple Remote Connection" in the Feature Guide.
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the port.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the extension name of the port.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Phone Location
Specifies the type of extension connected to the port.
Value Range
Local: The extension is located on the same network as the PBX (standard configuration).
Remote (SBC): The extension is accessing the PBX remotely (Simple Remote Connection).
Remote (MRG): The extension is accessing the PBX remotely (use Media Relay Gateway).
Web-MC Ability
Specifies whether the Web programming is allowed on the KX-UT series SIP phone connected to the port by
enabling the Web port setting on the phone’s menu. For details about Web programming for KX-UT series SIP
phones, refer to the documentation of the phone.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
HTTPS, HTTP
Note
A total of 20 HTTPS connections can be set per PBX site. If "HTTPS" is selected but the total number of
HTTPS connections available at the site will be exceeded by changing this setting, a warning message will
be displayed and the setting change will be cancelled.
Value Range
Normal, Sweden, New Zealand
Value Range
8 ´ n (n=3–255) ms
Value Range
8 ´ n (n=12–63) ms
Value Range
8 ´ n (n=9–20) ms
Value Range
8 ´ n (n=1–5) ms
Value Range
Disable: The PBX disconnects the line to prevent placing the call on hold.
Enable: The PBX places the call on consultation hold.
Value Range
8 ´ n (n=3–63) ms
Value Range
8 ´ n (n=3–191) ms
Value Range
2 ´ n (n=1–31) ms
Value Range
1.5–4.0 mA
Value Range
1.5–4.0 mA
Note
Other programming items that are displayed on this screen but not listed below are used only when
programming extensions connected to a legacy gateway (KX-TDE/KX-NCP/KX-TDA PBX). For additional
information about programming items not described here, refer to the PC Programming Manual of the
legacy gateway PBX.
For information about legacy gateways, see 9.29 PBX Configuration—[1-1]
Configuration—Slot—Legacy-GW1/Legacy-GW2.
Port Type
Indicates the port type (reference only).
Value Range
SLT: SLT port (SLC)
Telephone Type
Indicates the connected telephone type (reference only).
Value Range
SLT: SLT is connected (or no telephone is connected to the SLT port).
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the PBX.
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the port.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the extension name of the port.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
3–6 s
Value Range
0.5 ´ n (n=1–16) s
Value Range
No, Yes
Value Range
24 ´ n (n=1–50) ms
Value Range
1.0 s–15.0 s
Value Range
64 + 16 ´ n (n=0–11) ms
Value Range
630 ms, 830 ms, 1030 ms
Value Range
Other, 60%, 67%
Value Range
20 + (4 ´ n) (n=1–15) ms
Value Range
4 ´ n (n=3–15) ms
Value Range
Other, 60 %, 67 %
Value Range
12+ (4 ´ n) (n=1–15) ms
Value Range
4 ´ n (n=3–15) ms
Pulse Type
Selects the type of pulse dial transmission appropriate to your area.
Value Range
Normal, Sweden, New Zealand
Value Range
None, Caller ID Card, Pay Tone Card
Value Range
FSK, FSK (with Visual Caller ID), DTMF
Value Range
0 (no limit), 1, 2, 3
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Length + Timer, Timer
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
None, 80 ´ n (n=1–15) ms
Value Range
1040 + (80 ´ n) (n=0–37) ms
Value Range
None, *, #, A, B, C, D
Value Range
None, *, #, A, B, C, D
Value Range
None, *, #, A, B, C, D
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
DDN, Caller ID
Value Range
12 KHz, 16KHz
Value Range
0–31 dB
Value Range
8 ´ n (n=1–250) ms
Value Range
None, 8 ´ n (n=1–250) ms
Value Range
8 ´ n (n=1–250) ms
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Value Range
Normal, Busy Out
Dialling Mode
Selects the type of signal used to dial out to the analogue trunk.
Value Range
DTMF, Pulse
Value Range
None, 6.5 ms, 8 ´ n (n=1–112) ms
DTMF Width
Selects the length of the DTMF tone sent to the analogue trunk.
Value Range
80 ms, 160 ms
Pulse Speed
Selects the speed at which pulse dials are sent to the analogue trunk.
Value Range
Low, High
Reverse Detection
Selects the type of trunk call for which the reverse signal from the telephone company is detected.
Value Range
Disable: For no trunk call
Outgoing: For outgoing trunk calls only
Both Call: For both outgoing and incoming trunk calls
Caller ID Detection
Enables the PBX to detect a Caller ID signal from the analogue trunk.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Paytone Detection
Enables the PBX to receive a pay tone signal from the telephone company.
Note
This feature is available for extensions connected to legacy gateway PBXs only.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Pause Time
Specifies the length of a pause.
Value Range
1.5 s, 2.5 s, 3.5 s, 4.5 s
Flash Time
Specifies the length of a flash signal.
Value Range
None, 16 ´ n (n=1–255) ms
Disconnect Time
Specifies the length of time after a trunk is disconnected, during which the PBX cannot seize the line.
Value Range
0.5 s, 1.5 s, 2.0 s, 4.0 s, 12.0 s
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–18000 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T200
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the L2 command to ISDN.
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T201
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after resending the TEI check request to ISDN.
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T203
Specifies the length of time to detect no communication status of L2.
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T301
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after making a call to ISDN.
Value Range
0–18000 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T302
Specifies the maximum time allowed between each digit on an incoming call. Applies to overlap receiving.
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T303
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the SETUP (call setting) message to
ISDN.
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T304
Specifies the maximum time allowed between each digit on an outgoing call. Applies to overlap sending.
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T305
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the DISC (disconnection) message
to ISDN.
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T306
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the DISC (disconnection) message
to ISDN. This setting is used when inband tones are supplied.
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T307
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX maintains a suspended call, before restarting.
Value Range
0–6000 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T308
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after receiving the Release message from ISDN.
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T309
Specifies the length of time that the PBX tries to disconnect the data link, before disconnecting the call.
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T310
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after receiving the Incoming Call Proceeding
message.
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T312
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the SETUP (call setting) message to
ISDN.
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T316
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Restart message.
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T320
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for packet protocol.
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T322
Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Status enquiry message.
Value Range
0–600 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T3D3
Specifies the length of time that the PBX tries to establish L2 in "Permanent" mode.
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
ISDN Extension—T3D9
Specifies the length of time that the PBX tries to disconnect L2 in "Call by Call" mode.
Value Range
0–3000 ´ 100 ms
Main
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Port Type
Selects the port type.
Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another
PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In
this case, an MSN can be assigned.
Value Range
CO: For connecting to public network
Extension: For connecting to extension
QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port)
QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
LLC Information
Enables the PBX to send LLC (Low Level Compatibility) information to the network when an outgoing call is
made when the ISDN bearer mode is speech.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Status Message
Specifies whether the Status Message is sent to the network.
Value Range
No Transmission: Status Message is not sent.
When Mandatory error detection: Send the Status Message when an error (Mandatory) is detected.
When Option / Mandatory error detection: Send the Status Message when an error (Option or Mandatory) is
detected.
Status Receive
Selects what happens to a call when the Status Message from the network does not match the actual status
of the call.
Value Range
Ignore: Ignore the Status Message from the network.
Disconnect: Disconnect the call.
ISDN CO
Parameters for ISDN CO are not applicable for the BRI extension port.
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Port Type
Selects the port type.
Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another
PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In
this case, an MSN can be assigned.
Value Range
CO: For connecting to public network
Extension: For connecting to extension
QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Subscriber Number
Specifies the number used as the CLIP number.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
En-bloc: The PBX sends all of the dialled digits at once after the extension user completes dialling. The PBX
recognises the end of dialling when (1) # is dialled, if programmed, (2) a pre-programmed telephone number
is dialled, or (3) the inter-digit timer expires.
Overlap: The PBX sends dialled digits one at a time.
ISDN Centrex
Enables the use of the telephone company’s ISDN Centrex Service features.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
1-link: One TEI is assigned to the BRI CO port.
2-link: Two TEIs are assigned to the BRI CO port. (Available when Access Mode on the Network tab is set
to P-MP.)
Value Range
Off, On
ISDN Extension
Parameters for ISDN Extension are not applicable for BRI ports assigned as CO ports.
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Port Type
Selects the port type.
Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another
PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In
this case, an MSN can be assigned.
Value Range
CO: For connecting to public network
Extension: For connecting to extension
QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port)
QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Value Range
Ring All Extension for MSN: Ring all ISDN extensions that are addressed with MSN.
Ring an Extension for MSN: Ring only one of the ISDN extensions that are addressed with MSN.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Network
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Port Type
Selects the port type.
Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another
PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In
this case, an MSN can be assigned.
Value Range
CO: For connecting to public network
Extension: For connecting to extension
QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port)
QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Network Type
Selects the network type of the port.
Value Range
0–56
(2 UK (Domestic), 5 Netherlands, 6 SwissNET2, 7 SwissNET3, 8 Euro ISDN (Standard), 14 France
(Domestic), 19 Finland, 20 Norway, 27 Australia, 51 US National ISDN 2)
L1 Mode
Selects the active mode of L1 (Layer 1) on the BRI port.
Value Range
Call, Permanent
L2 Mode
Selects the active mode of L2 (Layer 2) on the BRI port.
Value Range
Call, Permanent
Access Mode
Selects the configuration of the BRI port.
Value Range
P-P: Point-to-Point
P-MP: Point-to-multipoint
TEI Mode
Specifies the TEI mode assigned to the BRI port.
Value Range
Automatic, Fix 0–Fix 63
Port Type
Selects the port type.
Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another
PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In
this case, an MSN can be assigned.
Value Range
CO: For connecting to public network
Extension: For connecting to extension
QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port)
QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Trunk Property
Selects the trunk property of the port.
Value Range
Public: Public network
Private: Private Network
VPN: Virtual Private Network
Value Range
Unknown, ISDN-Telephony, National Standard, Private
Value Range
Unknown, International, National, Network, Subscriber
Value Range
Unknown, ISDN-Telephony, National Standard, Private
Value Range
Unknown, International, National, Network, Subscriber
Supplementary Service
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Port Type
Selects the port type.
Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another
PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In
this case, an MSN can be assigned.
Value Range
CO: For connecting to public network
Extension: For connecting to extension
QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port)
QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS,
AOC-D, AOC-E, 3PTY
Specifies whether each ISDN or QSIG supplementary service is used.
Value Range
For COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E:
No, Yes
For 3PTY:
No, Yes-3Pty
CCBS Option
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Port Type
Selects the port type.
Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another
PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In
this case, an MSN can be assigned.
Value Range
CO: For connecting to public network
Extension: For connecting to extension
QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port)
QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
CCBS Type
Selects the type of the call from the network initiated by the CCBS (Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber)
feature, from which the specified number of digits are deleted.
CCBS Delete Digits on this screen specifies the number of digits to delete from the received number.
Value Range
ALL, Unknown, International, National, Network specific, Subscriber, Abbreviated
Value Range
0–15
Main
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Port Type
Selects the port type.
Note
• Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on
another PBX.
• ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In
this case, an MSN can be assigned.
Value Range
CO: For connecting to public network
Extension: For connecting to extension
QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port)
QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Status Message
Specifies whether the Status Message is sent to the network.
Value Range
No Transmission: Status Message is not sent.
When error detection (Mandatory): Send the Status Message when an error (Mandatory) is detected.
When error detection (Option / Mandatory): Send the Status Message when an error (Option or Mandatory) is
detected.
Status Receive
Selects what happens to a call when the Status Message from the network does not match the actual status
of the call.
Value Range
Ignore: Ignore the Status Message from the network.
Disconnect: Disconnect the call.
CRC4 Mode
Enables the use of CRC4 for error checking. CRC (Cyclic Redundancy Check) is an error checking control
technique that uses a specific binary prime divisor that results in a unique remainder. It is usually a 16- to
32-bit character. (Assignable only when using the PRI30 card.)
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Line Coding
Selects the line coding type of the PRI PCM (Pulse Code Modulation) for the port. This setting is only available
when using the PRI23 card.
Value Range
B8ZS, AMI
Frame Sequence
Selects the type of frame sequence for the port. This setting is only available when using the PRI23 card.
Value Range
Extended Multi frame (ESF), 4-Frame Multi frame (F4), 12-Frame Multi frame (F12)
CO Setting
CO Setting parameters are not applicable to ports assigned as Extension in Port Type.
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Port Type
Selects the port type.
Note
• Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on
another PBX.
• ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In
this case, an MSN can be assigned.
Value Range
CO: For connecting to public network
Extension: For connecting to extension
QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port)
QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Subscriber Number
Specifies the number used as the CLIP number.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
En-bloc: The PBX sends all of the dialled digits at once after the extension user completes dialling. The PBX
recognises the end of dialling when (1) # is dialled, if programmed, (2) a pre-programmed telephone number
is dialled, or (3) the inter-digit timer expires.
Overlap: The PBX sends dialled digits one at a time.
ISDN Centrex
Enables the use of the telephone company’s ISDN Centrex Service features.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Off, On
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Extension Setting
Extension Setting parameters are applicable only for the PRI extension port.
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Port Type
Selects the type of the port.
Note
• Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on
another PBX.
• ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In
this case, an MSN can be assigned.
Value Range
CO: For connecting to public network
Extension: For connecting to extension
QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port)
QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Value Range
Ring All Extension for MSN: Ring all ISDN extensions that are addressed with MSN.
Ring AN Extension for MSN: Ring only one of the ISDN extensions that are addressed with MSN.
Network Configuration
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Port Type
Selects the port type.
Note
• Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on
another PBX.
• ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In
this case, an MSN can be assigned.
Value Range
CO: For connecting to public network
Extension: For connecting to extension
QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port)
QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Network Type
Selects the network type of the port.
Value Range
0–56
(2 UK (Domestic), 5 Netherlands, 6 SwissNET2, 7 SwissNET3, 8 Euro ISDN (Standard), 14 France
(Domestic), 19 Finland, 20 Norway, 27 Australia, 51 US National ISDN 2)
Port Type
Selects the port type.
Note
• Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on
another PBX.
• ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In
this case, an MSN can be assigned.
Value Range
CO: For connecting to public network
Extension: For connecting to extension
QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port)
QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Trunk Property
Selects the trunk property of the port.
Value Range
Public: Public network
Private: Private Network
VPN: Virtual Private Network
Value Range
Unknown, ISDN-Telephony, National Standard, Private
Value Range
Unknown, International, National, Network, Subscriber
Value Range
Unknown, ISDN-Telephony, National Standard, Private
Value Range
Unknown, International, National, Network, Subscriber
Supplementary Service
The Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Port Type
Selects the port type.
Note
• Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on
another PBX.
• ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In
this case, an MSN can be assigned.
Value Range
CO: For connecting to public network
Extension: For connecting to extension
QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port)
QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port)
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS,
AOC-D, AOC-E, E911, 3PTY
Specifies whether each ISDN or QSIG supplementary service is used.
The available services depend on the setting of Port Type on this screen.
Value Range
For COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, E911:
No, Yes
For 3PTY:
No, Yes-3Pty
CCBS Type
Selects the type of call from the network initiated by the CCBS (Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber) feature,
from which the specified number of digits are deleted.
CCBS Delete Digits on this screen specifies the number of digits to delete from the received number.
Value Range
ALL, Unknown, International, National, Network specific, Subscriber, Abbreviated
Value Range
0–15
Note
• Legacy gateways must first be pre-installed before they can be programmed. For details, see To
pre-install PBXs connected to the STACK-M card in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1]
Configuration—Slot.
• For information about hardware configuration restrictions and conditions for legacy gateways, refer to
Conditions for Connecting Legacy Gateways in 4.6 Stacking Cards in the KX-NS1000 Installation
Manual.
Note
The legacy gateway must be set to OUS before it can be deleted.
Note
Unless noted otherwise, programming items and specifications for PBXs connected as legacy gateways
correspond to the following PBX software versions. When referencing the manuals of other PBXs, refer to
manuals matching these software versions.
• KX-TDE: PMMPR/PGMPR Software File Version 4.1xxx or later
• KX-NCP: PBMPR Software File Version 4.1xxx or later
• KX-TDA: PMPR/PLMPR Software File Version 5.0000 or later
Shelf
Indicates the shelf position of the KX-NS1000 for the legacy gateway in which the OPB3 card is installed
(reference only).
Value Range
2: Legacy-GW1
3: Legacy-GW2
Port Status
Indicates the port status for installed option cards. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the
column, and then select INS or OUS for the port.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: There is a communication error.
Port Status
Specifies the port’s status.
This option is only available in On-line mode.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: There is a communication error.
Value Range
Ringer, Relay, Door Opener
Value Range
32 ´ n (n=2–255) ms
Value Range
10 ´ n (n=1–255) s
Registration
Follow the steps below to register the PS.
1. Click Registration.
A dialogue box will appear. Non-registered (available) extension numbers and names are displayed on the
left.
2. Highlight numbers and names and click the right arrow to select them for registration. Click Next.
3. Highlight PBX sites and click the right arrow to select them for registration. Click Next.
4. If the registration is still in progress, the dialogue box will show "Registration Executing".
If the registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "Registration Completed". Click Close.
Once a PS is successfully registered, the status of the PS will update to show "Registered".
De-registration
Follow the steps below to de-register the PS.
1. Click De-registration.
A dialogue box will appear. Registered extension numbers and names are displayed on the left.
2. Highlight numbers and names and click the right arrow to select them for de-registration. Click Next.
A dialogue box will appear.
3. Click Confirm.
If the de-registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "De-registration Succeed".
4. Click Close.
Once the PS is successfully de-registered, the status of the PS will update to show "None".
Forced De-registration
Follow the steps below to forcibly de-register the PS when normal de-registration has been unsuccessful or
de-registration has been performed only on the PS.
1. Click Forced De-registration.
A dialogue box will appear. Registered extension numbers and names are displayed on the left.
2. Highlight numbers and names and click the right arrow to select them for forced de-registration. Click
Next.
A dialogue box will appear.
3. Click OK.
A dialogue box will appear.
4. Click Confirm.
If the de-registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "Forced De-registration Succeed".
5. Click Close.
Once the PS is successfully de-registered, the status of the PS will update to show "None".
Value Range
4 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Index
Indicates the PS number (reference only).
Value Range
1–512
Extension No.
Specifies the extension number of the PS.
In Wireless XDP Parallel Mode, the PS can be used as a sub telephone with a wired main telephone (PT/SLT),
and two of them will share one extension number of the main telephone. However, note that the PS extension
number specified here will not be altered by the extension number of the main telephone even if the PS is in
Wireless XDP Parallel Mode.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the PS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Status
Indicates whether a certain PS is registered (reference only).
Value Range
None, Registered
System Wireless—System ID
Indicates the radio system ID used to register a PS (reference only).
Value Range
Not applicable.
Note
• For users in Canada, this setting is also available for the KX-WT126.
• The KX-WT125 is available only in Canada.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
In Service, Out of Service
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
ISDN Standard Mode: The CCBS, CF, CT, and Unified Messaging features are supported. DIL and DID call
distribution are available for the D channel.
T1-LCOT mode: DIL and DID call distribution are available for all 23B channels. The CCBS, CF, CT, and
Unified Messaging features are not available in this mode.
Value Range
None, Shelf and Slot number
Shelf and slot numbers are listed using the pattern "X-Y":
• X: Shelf number (1–3 [2 and 3 correspond to Legacy Gateway 1 or 2])
• Y: Slot number (1–11)
Value Range
Resource amount (3 digits)
Value Range
DSP S, DSP M, DSP L
Services—VoIP (G.711)
Specifies the number of simultaneous VoIP calls to reserve DSP resources for.
Value Range
0–506 VoIP calls
Services—Unified message
Specifies the number of UM ports (including a fax port) to reserve DSP resources for.
Value Range
0–25 ports (UM: 24 ports, Fax: 1 port)
Services—Two-way Recording
Specifies the number of UM ports reserved in Services—Unified message to use for Two-way Recording.
Value Range
0–24 ports (cannot exceed the value set in Services—Unified message)
Services—OGM
Specifies the number of OGM ports to reserve DSP resources for.
Value Range
0–64 ports
Services—Conference trunk
Specifies the number of conference rooms to reserve DSP resources for.
Value Range
0–24 conference rooms
Value Range
0–506 DSP resources
Note
Any calls being made that use DSP resources will be disconnected when setting values are changed and
applied.
Value Range
• Set: Specify a date and time to apply the changes, and click OK. The changes will be applied at the specified
date and time.
• Apply now: The changes are applied immediately. Click OK to apply the settings immediately.
Note
Click Clear to reset the input values and start again.
5. When all items are allocated, confirm that the amount of resources input does not exceed the value
indicated in Total Power.
• Click Apply to insert the specified allocation settings into the DSP Resource—Setting screen.
• Click Cancel to return to the DSP Resource—Setting screen without making any changes.
For details, refer to "5.5.4.2 DSP Resource Advisor" in the Feature Guide.
Note
• When this setting is changed and applied, it may take between 1 minute and several hours (depending
on the configuration of the PBX network) for all connected IP-PTs to reflect this change on their displays.
• At default settings, KX-UT series SIP phones synchronise to the PBX’s date and time once every hour.
Value Range
Year: 2000–2035
Month: 01–12
Day: 01–31
Hour: 00–23
Minute: 00–59
Second: 00–59
Note
The NTP server function of the PBX must be enabled for connected KX-UT series SIP phones to receive
automatic time adjustment information from the PBX. See 28.2.4 Network Service—[2-5] Server
Feature—NTP.
Value Range
Disable: Synchronisation is not enabled (for the Master unit and Stand-alone units)
Enable: Synchronisation is enabled (for Slave units)
Value Range
Disable, ISDN & Caller ID (FSK), SNTP
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 (IP address), Max. 253 characters (host name)
Value Range
1–65535
Note
If KX-UT series SIP phones are connected to the PBX, and this setting is changed, they must be restarted
for the new time zone setting to take effect.
Value Range
-14:00–+14:00
Value Range
-14:00–+14:00
Setting
Enables Summer time.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Year: 2000–2035
Month: 1–12
Day: 1–31
Value Range
Year: 2000–2035
Month: 1–12
Day: 1–31
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
External BGM, Internal BGM
Value Range
Tone, BGM1, BGM2, BGM3, BGM4, BGM5, BGM6, BGM7, BGM8
Value Range
Same as Music on Hold, Ringback Tone
Value Range
0–10
Value Range
10 ´ n (n=1–120) s
Value Range
10 ´ n (n=1–30) s
Value Range
0–15 s
Value Range
0–180 s
Value Range
1–250 s
Dial—Extension Inter-digit
Specifies the length of time within which subsequent digits must be dialled before the PBX sends a reorder
tone.
Value Range
1–250 s
Value Range
1–15 s
Dial—Analogue CO Inter-digit
Specifies the length of time within which subsequent digits of a telephone number must be sent to an analogue
trunk. If no digit is sent before this time expires, the PBX recognises end of dialling and stops muting the
caller’s voice over the analogue trunk.
Value Range
1–15 s
Value Range
0–60 s
Value Range
1–240 s
Recall—Hold Recall
Specifies the length of time until the holding extension receives a Hold Recall ring or alarm tone when a held
call remains unretrieved.
Value Range
0 (disable the Hold Recall)–240 s
Recall—Transfer Recall
Specifies the length of time that a transferred call waits to be answered, before being redirected to the Transfer
Recall destination assigned to the original transferring extension.
Value Range
1–240 s
Value Range
1–240 s
Value Range
60 ´ n (n = 1–30) s
Value Range
1–15 s
Value Range
1–15 s
Value Range
1–15 s
Value Range
0–30 s
Value Range
0.0–12.0 s
Value Range
0–120 s
Value Range
0–5 s
Value Range
0–60 s
Value Range
0–60 s
Value Range
0–15
Value Range
60 ´ n (n = 0–7) s
Value Range
0–60 s
Value Range
0–15 s
Value Range
10 ´ n (n=1–15) s
Doorphone—Call Duration
Specifies the length of time until an answered doorphone call is disconnected.
Value Range
10 ´ n (n=0–30) s
Doorphone—Open Duration
Specifies the length of time that a door stays unlocked after being opened from an extension.
Value Range
2–7 s
Value Range
1–15
Value Range
10 ´ n (n=1–120) s
Value Range
10 ´ n (n=1–30) s
Value Range
60 ´ n (n = 0–60) s
Value Range
0–240 s
Value Range
0–240 s
Miscellaneous
Caller ID—Waiting to receive
Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits to receive Caller ID from an analogue trunk. If the Caller ID is
received through an analogue trunk card on which no Caller ID card is mounted or through a port to which
Caller ID Detection is disabled, this timer is not applicable.
Value Range
0–15 s
Value Range
0–250 s
Value Range
None, 1–15
Value Range
10 ´ n (n=1–15) s
Value Range
0–30 s
Value Range
3–30 s
Value Range
1–15 s
Value Range
60 ´ n (n=0–300) s
Value Range
1–30 s
Value Range
80 ms, 160 ms, 240 ms, 320 ms
Value Range
64 + 16 ´ n (n=0–15) ms
Value Range
1.5 s, 2.5 s, 3.5 s, 4.5 s
Value Range
0–30 s
Value Range
0–120 s
Value Range
5, 10, 15 s
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
00:00–23:59
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
00:00–23:59
Value Range
00:00–23:59
Holiday Table—Setting
Enables the setting of the holiday.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
1–12
Value Range
1–31
Value Range
1–12
Value Range
1–31
Note
• Numbering does not necessarily have to be uniform; varying numbers of digits can be used for each
setting.
• To programme these settings, all installed V-SIPEXT32 and V-UTEXT32 cards must first be set to
OUS. For details, see 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Extension
The leading numbers and the number of additional digits of the extension numbers for a maximum of 64
different extension numbering schemes can be programmed.
Leading Number
Specifies the leading number of extension numbers and floating extension numbers.
Note
Changing this value will also affect the following settings.
• Extension Number as set in User Profiles and UM Configuration
• Mailbox Number when set to synchronise with Extension Number settings
(However, Mailbox Number synchronisation depends on the setting 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9]
System—System Options—Option 9— Extension / Mailbox Setting—Mailbox Number
Synchronization with Extension Number.)
Value Range
Max. 3 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
None: 0 digit
X: 1 digit
XX: 2 digits
Features
Feature numbers to access various PBX features can be programmed. The following features are available
while hearing a dial tone.
Operator Call
Specifies the feature number used to call the operator.
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Redial
Specifies the feature number used to redial the last number dialled.
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
DOORPHONE Call
Specifies the feature number used to make a call to a doorphone.
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Group Paging
Specifies the feature number used to page a certain paging group.
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Note
This feature is restricted to extensions connected to legacy gateway PBXs. For information about
connecting SLTs and DPTs in parallel, refer to the documentation of the connected legacy gateway PBX.
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
TAFAS Answer
Specifies the feature number used to answer a trunk call notified through an external pager.
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Door Open
Specifies the feature number used to open a door.
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
SIP Refer(Blind)
Specifies the feature number used to perform a blind transfer from a SIP extension.
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
ISDN Hold
Specifies the feature number used to hold a call using the ISDN service of the telephone company, instead of
the PBX feature.
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
MCID
Specifies the feature number used to ask the telephone company to trace a malicious call. This feature can
be used during a call or while hearing a reorder tone after the caller hangs up.
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Walking Extension
Specifies the feature number used to use the same extension settings at a new extension.
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Log-in / Log-out
Specifies the feature number used to join or leave an incoming call distribution group.
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Printing Message
Specifies the feature number used to select a Printing Message to be output on SMDR.
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Dial
Specifies the leading extension number of the other PBX.
Value Range
Max. 3 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
KX-T7710
The settings of the MESSAGE key and One-touch keys on the KX-T7710 can be programmed.
Note
• This tab is for programming extensions connected to legacy gateway PBXs. For information about
setting up a legacy gateway PBX, see 9.29 PBX Configuration—[1-1]
Configuration—Slot—Legacy-GW1/Legacy-GW2.
• For further information about programming for KX-T7710 phones, refer to the documentation of the
connected legacy gateway PBX.
Dial
Indicates the DTMF tone dial required by the PBX to recognise it and dial the pre-programmed number for
each key (reference only).
Value Range
B: For MESSAGE Key
A1: For One-touch Dial 01 Key
A2: For One-touch Dial 02 Key
A3: For One-touch Dial 03 Key
A4: For One-touch Dial 04 Key
A5: For One-touch Dial 05 Key
A6: For One-touch Dial 06 Key
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash])
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash])
Dial
Specifies the Quick Dialling number.
Value Range
1–4000: Max. 8 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Phone Number
Specifies the number to be dialled when the corresponding Quick Dialling number is used.
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash])
Value Range
1 digit (0–9, *, or #)
Value Range
1 digit (0–9, *, or #)
Value Range
1 digit (0–9, *, or #)
Value Range
1 digit (0–9, *, or #)
Call Monitor
Specifies the feature number used to listen to a busy extension’s conversation.
Value Range
1 digit (0–9, *, or #)
Value Range
1 digit (0–9, *, or #)
Value Range
1 digit (0–9, *, or #)
TRS
Restrictions to features related to making trunk calls can be programmed for each COS.
COS Name
Specifies the name of the COS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
1: Allows all trunk calls
2–6: Restricts trunk calls according to the combination of the Denied and Exception Code Tables
7: Restricts all trunk calls
Value Range
1: Allows all trunk calls
2–6: Restricts trunk calls according to the combination of the Denied and Exception Code Tables
7: Restricts all trunk calls
Value Range
1: Allows all trunk calls
2–6: Restricts trunk calls according to the combination of the Denied and Exception Code Tables
7: Restricts all trunk calls
CO & SMDR
COS Name
Specifies the name of the COS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Transfer to CO
Enables the transferring of calls to trunks.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Call Forward to CO
Enables the forwarding of calls to trunks.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Option, Forced
CF (MSN)
Enables forwarding of ISDN calls to an outside party using the ISDN service of the telephone company, instead
of the PBX, on an MSN basis.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Assistant
COS Name
Specifies the name of the COS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Disable, Enable
DND Override
Enables making a call to an extension in DND mode by entering the feature number.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable: The call is not transferred. (If the transfer destination has enabled the call waiting notification feature,
it is possible to inform the destination about the call transfer.)
Enable: The transferred call is queued for the time period specified in Recall—Transfer Recall in 10.3 PBX
Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters.
Value Range
Disable: Even if the destination has set Hands-free Answerback, the call will not be automatically answered.
Executive
COS Name
Specifies the name of the COS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Call Monitor
Enables listening to a busy extension’s conversation.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Manager
COS Name
Specifies the name of the COS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Disable: An extension cannot set call forwarding for any group.
Enable-All: An extension can set call forwarding for all groups.
Enable-Group: An extension can only set call forwarding for the group to which the extension belongs.
PT Programming Mode
Specifies the level of authorisation for performing PT programming.
Value Range
Disable: A PT user cannot perform any programming.
Enable: A PT user can perform only personal programming.
Manager
Specifies the authorisation to use manager features.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
PDN/SDN
An SDN button allows a PT user to see the current status of the corresponding PDN extension, and to pick up
or transfer calls to that extension easily. The settings here control how SDN buttons operate for extensions at
each COS level.
COS Name
Specifies the name of the COS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Enhanced DSS: The registered (owner) extension is called.
Standard SDN: A dial tone is heard.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Door Unlock
Enables using the door opener feature.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Allow, Deny
Value Range
Allow, Deny
CA
COS Name
Specifies the name of the COS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
CA Chat
Enables the chat feature when using Communication Assistant (CA) Client.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Miscellaneous
COS Name
Specifies the name of the COS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Block (blue), Non Block
COS Number of the Extension Which Receive the Call from Other Extension 1–
512
Specifies the combinations of COS levels for which intercom calls are blocked.
Value Range
Block (blue), Non Block
Value Range
Single, Double, Triple, Option1, Option2
Value Range
Single, Double, Triple, S-Double, Option 1, Option 2
Value Range
Single, Double, Triple, Option 1, Option 2
Value Range
Single, Double, Triple, Option 1, Option 2
Value Range
Single, Double, Triple, S-Double, Option 1, Option 2
Value Range
Single, Double, Triple, Option 1, Option 2
Value Range
Single, Double, Triple, Option 1, Option 2
Option 1
PT LCD—Date Display
Selects the order that the month and date are shown on the displays of extensions.
Value Range
Date-Month, Month-Date
PT LCD—Time Display
Selects the time format shown on the displays of extensions. The time display format assigned here applies
when setting the Timed Reminder feature.
Value Range
12H, 24H
Value Range
Hide, Display
Value Range
On (Solid): Red on
Flash: Slow red flashing
Value Range
On (Solid): Red on
Flash: Slow red flashing
Value Range
FWD/DND Setting Mode: Enter programming mode for the FWD/DND setting.
FWD/DND Cycle Switch: Switch the FWD on/DND on/Off mode instead of entering the programming mode
for the FWD/DND setting. (When there are separate FWD/DND settings for calls from trunks and calls from
extensions, mode switching cannot be performed.)
Value Range
Do Not Page, Page
Value Range
Idle, Busy
Value Range
Disable: The PT user’s voice is sent through the handsfree microphone. The other party’s voice is heard
through the hands-free speaker.
Enable: The PT user’s voice is sent through the handset microphone. The other party’s voice is heard through
both the hands-free speaker and the handset.
Value Range
Enable: Pressing the S-CO button activates the Privacy Release feature
Disable: Pressing the S-CO button switches the information shown on the PT display.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Normal, High Speed
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
No Ring, 1 Ring, 2 Rings, 3 Rings
Value Range
Disable (Disconnect), Enable
Value Range
Hold: Any extension can retrieve a held call.
Exclusive Hold: Only the holding extension can retrieve a held call.
Option 2
Extension Clear—Call Waiting
Specifies whether the Call Waiting setting is cleared when Extension Feature Clear is performed.
Value Range
Clear, Do not clear
Extension Clear—Fwd/DND
Specifies whether the FWD/DND setting is cleared when Extension Feature Clear is performed.
Value Range
Clear, Do not clear
Value Range
Clear, Do not clear
CODEC—System CODEC
Selects the codec type for PSs.
Value Range
A-Law, Mu-Law
CODEC—Network CODEC
Selects the codec type for ISDN lines.
Value Range
A-Law, Mu-Law
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Enable: The call will be disconnected.
Disable: The call will continue.
Option 3
Confirmation Tone—Tone 1 : Called by Voice
Enables the PBX to send Confirmation Tone 1. Confirmation Tone 1 is heard from a PT when it receives a call
in voice-calling mode.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Confirmation Tone—Tone 3-1 : Start Talking after Making Call / Call from
DOORPHONE
Enables the PBX to send Confirmation Tone 3-1. Confirmation Tone 3-1 is heard from an extension when, for
example, it pages another extension, or from a doorphone when the doorphone button is pressed.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Type A, Type B
Value Range
Type A, Type B
Echo Cancel—Conference
Enables the use of echo cancelling for conference calls.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Echo Cancel—CO-to-CO
Enables the use of echo cancelling for trunk-to-trunk calls.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Option 4
DSS Key—DSS key mode for Incoming Call
Enables the use of a DSS button to pick up an incoming call to another extension or an ICD group.
Value Range
On or Flash, Off
Value Range
Disable: The DSS button will light up when a call arrives, but pressing it will not pick up the call.
Enable: The DSS button will flash when a call arrives, and pressing it will pick up the call.
To enable this setting, DSS Key—DSS key mode for Incoming Call on this screen must be set to "ON or
Flash".
Value Range
Disable: The DSS button will light up when a call arrives, but pressing it will not pick up the call.
Enable: The DSS button will flash when a call arrives, and pressing it will pick up the call.
Value Range
Disable: The PBX disconnects the current call, and calls the extension assigned to the DSS or SDN button.
Enable: The PBX places the current call on consultation hold.
Value Range
Enable: Pressing the DSS button displays the caller’s information.
Disable: Pressing the DSS button answers the call.
Value Range
0–15
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable: The CLIP number assigned to the forwarding extension or virtual PS is sent.
Enable: The CLIP number of the calling party is sent.
Value Range
Disable: The CLIP number assigned to the forwarding extension or virtual PS is sent.
Enable: The CLIP number of the calling extension is sent.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Option 5
SLT—SLT Hold Mode
Selects how to hold a line and transfer a call with an SLT. For details of each mode, see "2.13.1 Call Hold" in
the Feature Guide.
Value Range
Mode 1, Mode 2, Mode 3, Mode 4
Value Range
1–12
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
None, Call Back Cancel, Call Pickup Direct, Call Pickup Group, DOORPHONE Call, Door Open, Relay On,
External BGM, Paging
Value Range
Mode1: Disable
Mode2: Enable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Display, Facility
Option 6 (CTI)
Built-in Communication Assistant—System status retry interval timer
Specifies the length of time until the alive check is retried when no response is received, for First Party Call
Control CTI such as Communication Assistant (CA).
Value Range
0–60 s
Value Range
0–10
Value Range
0–60 s
Value Range
0–10
Value Range
0–60 s
Value Range
0–10
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Option 7
Incoming Call Log—Busy/Intercept (when Called Party is Busy)
Specifies whether the following types of calls are recorded in the incoming call log of the original destination.
• Calls received when the extension is busy.
• Calls rerouted via the Intercept Routing—Busy feature.
If this setting is enabled, calls are recorded as "Not Answered".
Value Range
Enable (Not Answered), Disable
Value Range
Enable (Not Answered), Disable
Value Range
Answered, Not Answered
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Option 8
P2P Group—Priority Voice 1/Priority Voice 2/Priority Voice 3
Specifies the order of priority of the codecs to use for P2P groups.
Value Range
Priority Voice 1: G.729, G.711, G.722
Priority Voice 2/Priority Voice 3: G.729, G.711, G.722, None
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
8 Party, 32 Party
Option 9
Extension / Mailbox Setting—Mailbox Number Synchronization with Extension
Number
Enables the synchronisation of Mailbox Number and Extension Number settings.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
V.23(ETSI), Bell202(Bellcore)
Value Range
10 ´ n (n=3–40) bits
Value Range
10 ´ n (n=3–40) bits
Value Range
64 ´ n (n=5–35) ms
Value Range
FSK
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
-14 dB, -12 dB, -10 dB, -8 dB, -6 dB, -4 dB, -2 dB, 0 dB
Value Range
-14 dB, -12 dB, -10 dB, -8 dB, -6 dB, -4 dB, -2 dB, 0 dB
Value Range
-15.5–15.5 dB
Value Range
-15 dB, -12 dB, -9 dB, -6 dB, -3 dB, 0 dB, 3 dB, 6 dB
Value Range
-31.5–31.5 dB
Value Range
-31.5–31.5 dB
Value Range
-31.5–31.5 dB
Value Range
-15.5–15.5 dB
Main
Group Name
Specifies the name of the trunk group for programming reference.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
COS
Specifies the COS of the trunk group, applied when making a call from a trunk to another trunk with TIE Line
Service.
If you wish to prevent such calls from being made, ensure that the COS specified here has a TRS level of
"7" assigned for all relevant time modes in 10.7.1 PBX Configuration—[2-7-1] System—Class of
Service—COS Settings.
Value Range
1–512
Value Range
High -> Low, Low -> High, Rotation
Value Range
None, 1–60 (´ 60 s)
Value Range
None, 1–60 (´ 60 s)
Value Range
1–4
Value Range
1–4
Tone Detection
Group Name
Specifies the name of the trunk group for programming reference.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 10 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
500 ms, 1000 ms, 1500 ms, 2000 ms
Value Range
1000 ms, 1500 ms, 2000 ms, 2500 ms
Value Range
Trunk Group No. 1–96
Leading Digits
After the caller’s number is modified by the Length of Digits Modification Tables or CLIP Modification Tables,
the PBX checks the leading digits of the modified number for an area code programmed in the Caller ID
Modification Table assigned to that trunk group. If it finds such a code, it removes digits and adds a number
to the modified number. If this number is stored as a System Speed Dialling number, the caller’s name can be
shown on a PT display and the call can be routed to a certain extension (CLI destination). A maximum of 4
Caller ID Modification Tables, each containing 10 local/international call data and 1 long distance code, can
be programmed. Each trunk group can select a table for use. Select the desired table from the Modification
Table list.
If the modified number does not contain an area code programmed here, the PBX applies the Long Distance
Code settings to the modified number.
Value Range
Max. 6 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
0–9
Added Number
Specifies the number to be added to the incoming caller’s number in the place of the removed digits.
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Length of Digits
The PBX adds a certain number of digits to the caller’s number depending on the length of digits, as
programmed in the Length of Digits Modification Tables assigned to the trunk group. This modification is applied
to incoming trunk calls routed through public networks when the type of network numbering plan is Unknown
or not specified.
A maximum of 4 Length of Digits Modification Tables can be programmed. Select the desired table from the
Modification Table list.
If the length of digits of an incoming trunk call is less than the Minimum Caller ID Digits (for National), the
caller’s number is not modified.
Value Range
1–31
Value Range
0–30
Value Range
Max. 8 digits (0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 8 digits (0–9, *, and #)
CLIP
When incoming caller information is sent through an ISDN line and the type of the network numbering plan is
International, National, or Subscriber, the caller’s number can be modified as programmed in the Modification
Tables assigned to the trunk group. The modified number will then be recorded, and it is used for sending to
the network as a CLIP number.
A maximum of 4 CLIP Modification Tables can be programmed. Select the desired table from the Modification
Table list.
Value Range
0–9
Added Number
Specifies the number to be added to the incoming caller’s number in the place of the removed digits for each
type of network numbering plan.
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Leading Number
Specifies the leading number to be regarded as the beginning of dialling.
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, N [2,3,4,5,6,7,8,9], P [0, 1], and X [0–9, *, and #])
Value Range
0–15
Added Number
Specifies the number to be added to the number dialled by en-bloc dialling in the place of the removed digits.
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Type A:
• 1: N11
• 2: NXX XXXX
• 3: 1NXX NXX XXXX
• 4–50: Not stored
Type B:
• 1: N11
• 2: NNX XXXX
• 3: 1NPX NXX XXXX
• 4–50: Not stored
Type C:
• 1: N11
• 2: NXX XXXX
• 3: 1NNX XXXX
• 4: 1NPX NXX XXXX
• 5–50: Not stored
Type D:
• 1–47: Not stored
• 48: N11
• 49: NXX XXXX
• 50: 1NXX NXX XXXX
Type E:
• 1: N11
• 2: NXX NXX XXXX
• 3: 1NXX NXX XXXX
• 4–50: Not stored
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Rate
Specifies the call charge rate.
The number of decimal places that can be specified here depends on the value set in Charge
Options—Digits After Decimal Point in 14.2 PBX Configuration—[6-2] Feature—Hotel & Charge.
Value Range
0–9999999
Note
The maximum number of tenants depends on the System Capacity Selection setting made when the
Easy Setup Wizard was run for the PBX. If the System Resource Type was selected, the maximum
number of tenants is 128. If the Standard Type or IP-Extension Type was selected, the maximum number
of tenants is 32. For details, see "5.4.1 Easy Setup Wizard" in the Installation Manual.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Tenant Number
Specifies the tenant to which the extension user group belongs.
Value Range
1–32 or 1–128
Note
The maximum number of tenants depends on the System Capacity Selection setting made when the
Easy Setup Wizard was run for the PBX. If the System Resource Type was selected, the maximum
number of tenants is 128. If the Standard Type or IP-Extension Type was selected, the maximum number
of tenants is 32. For details, refer to "5.4.1 Easy Setup Wizard" in the Installation Manual.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Pickup Group—1st–8th
Selects the call pickup groups that the extension user group belongs to. One extension user group can be
assigned to a maximum of 8 call pickup groups on this screen. To assign an extension user group to more
than 8 call pickup groups, click All Setting.
Value Range
None, 01:–256:
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
ON (blue), OFF
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Paging Group—1st–8th
Selects the paging groups that the extension user group belongs to. One extension user group can be assigned
to a maximum of 8 paging groups on this screen. To assign an extension user group to more than 8 paging
groups, click All Setting.
Value Range
None, 01–256
5.1.2 Group
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
ON (blue), OFF (white)
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
ON (blue), OFF
Main
Floating Extension Number
Specifies the floating extension number of the incoming call distribution group.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Group Name
Specifies the name of the incoming call distribution group.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Distribution Method
Selects the method for distributing calls to idle extensions of the incoming call distribution group.
Value Range
Ring, UCD, Priority Hunting
Value Range
All, Distribution
FWD Mode
Specifies whether extensions in FWD mode ring when a call is received at the incoming call distribution group.
Value Range
No Ring, Ring
DND Mode
Specifies whether extensions in DND mode ring when a call is received at the incoming call distribution group.
Value Range
No Ring, Ring
Tenant Number
Specifies the tenant to which the incoming call distribution group belongs, to determine the Time Table and
the audio source for the group. (The tenant number corresponds to the Time Table number.)
Value Range
1–32 or 1–128
Note
The maximum number of tenants depends on the System Capacity Selection setting made when the
Easy Setup Wizard was run for the PBX. If the System Resource Type was selected, the maximum
number of tenants is 128. If the Standard Type or IP-Extension Type was selected, the maximum number
of tenants is 32. For details, refer to "5.4.1 Easy Setup Wizard" in the Installation Manual.
COS
Specifies the COS of the incoming call distribution group. Depending on the COS, calls from certain extensions
are restricted as determined by the Internal Call Block feature. Also, when calls are forwarded or overflowed
to a trunk, the TRS/Barring assigned for the COS of the incoming call distribution group applies.
Value Range
1–512
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Group Name
Specifies the name of the incoming call distribution group.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause])
Value Range
None, 1–100
Overflow No Answer
Floating Extension Number
Specifies the floating extension number of the incoming call distribution group.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Group Name
Specifies the name of the incoming call distribution group.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause])
Value Range
None, 10 ´ n (n=1–125) s
Hurry-up Level
Specifies the number of calls to hold in the queue before prompting Manual Queue Redirection by flashing the
Hurry-up button.
Value Range
None, 1–30
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Group Name
Specifies the name of the incoming call distribution group.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
None, Table 1–Table 128
Value Range
Disable (Ringback Tone), Enable
Miscellaneous
Floating Extension Number
Specifies the floating extension number of the incoming call distribution group.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Group Name
Specifies the name of the incoming call distribution group.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
None, 10 ´ n (n=1–15) s
Value Range
None, 1–15
Value Range
Max.: Call arrives at an idle extension.
1–32: Call will not arrive at an idle extension when the number of busy extensions exceeds the assigned
number.
Value Range
Idle, Busy
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Group Name
Specifies the name of the incoming call distribution group.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
0–100
Value Range
Off, On
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause])
Value Range
Off, On
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret] and P [Pause])
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of each member. In addition to the extension numbers of PT, SLT, and PS
extensions, floating extension numbers of PS Ring groups can also be specified.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Indicates the name of the extension (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Delayed Ring
Specifies the delayed ringing setting of each member. (Applicable when the call distribution method of the
incoming call distribution group is set to Ring.)
Value Range
Immediate, 1–6 Rings, No Ring
Wrap-up Timer
Specifies the length of time that must pass after completing a call before the member extension can accept
another call.
This timer is used when " Options—Wrap-up Timer based on" is set to "ICD Group Member" in
11.5.3 PBX Configuration—[3-5-3] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous.
Value Range
10 ´ n (n=0–300) s
Value Range
None: Redirects the call to the next sequence.
Overflow: Redirects the call to the overflow destination when there is no answer.
Disconnect: Disconnects the line.
Sequence 01–16: Redirects the call to a different sequence.
Wait 5 ´ n (n=1–16) s: If preceded by an OGM, plays the Music on Hold for the specified period of time; if not
preceded by an OGM, sends a ringback tone for the specified period of time.
OGM 01–64: Sends a certain OGM.
Queue No.: Announces how many calls precede the caller in the waiting queue.
Queue No. and Time: Announces how many calls precede the caller in the waiting queue and the estimated
wait time.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Group DN, Enhanced Phantom
Value Range
Disable (UCD), Enable (ACD)
Value Range
Extension: The timer is activated after all calls to or from the extension, including a retrieved call on hold.
ICD Group Member: The timer is only activated after calls to the extension through an ICD Group.
Value Range
Enable (Queuing Busy Destination), Disable (Keep Queuing)
Note
When this setting is enabled, certain hospitality features cannot be used. For details, refer to the relevant
chapter in the Feature Guide.
Value Range
Enable (Logging), Disable
Value Range
5–60
Value Range
Average waiting time: The average wait time is used for calculating the announced amount of wait time.
Predefined time: A set amount of time (10–3600 s) is used for calculating the announced amount of wait time.
Value Range
10–60 min
Value Range
Guidance No.1–8
Description
After specifying an ICD Group to be monitored, specify a User (User) or User (Administrator) as an ACD
supervisor to begin monitoring. The ACD supervisor can monitor an ICD Group, manage and analyse statistical
information, and create an ACD report.
For details about ICD Group management by the ACD supervisor, see 8.4 Users—ICDG Management.
First Name
The first name of the ACD supervisor (reference only).
Last Name
The last name of the ACD supervisor (reference only).
Ext. No.
The extension number of the ACD supervisor (reference only).
To assign the ICD Groups that are monitored by the ACD Supervisor.
1. In the ICD Group column, click the Edit button for the ACD supervisor. The Set ACD Supervisor ICD
Group screen is displayed.
2. From the ICD Groups listed in the Available ICD Group window, click an ICD Group to select it for
assignment to the ACD supervisor, and then click the right arrow button to move the selected ICD Group
to the Selected ICD Group list. To remove a selected ICD Group, click an ICD Group on the Selected
ICD Group list to select it, and then click the left arrow button.
3. Click OK.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Hunting Type
Specifies the hunting type for the hunting group.
Value Range
Circular: Circulates until the call is answered or overflowed
Terminated: Terminates at the last extension
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash])
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the hunting group member.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Indicates the name of the extension, when an extension number is specified in Extension Number above
(reference only).
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Group Name
Specifies the name of the UM group, which will be shown on the display of extensions that call the UM group.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Site name
Indicates the Site Name of the PBX that UM group belongs to (reference only).
Value Range
Site Name
Value Range
Unassigned, Site number and Site name
No.
Indicates the UM port number (reference only).
Value Range
1–24
Extension No.
Indicates the extension number assigned to the UM port (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
UM Group No.
Indicates the UM group number and name (reference only).
Value Range
UM Group number and name
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Group Name
Specifies the name of the PS ring group, which will be shown on the display of extensions that call the PS ring
group when Incoming Trunk Call Information Display on this screen is set to Called Number.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Caller ID, Called Number
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the PS assigned to the PS Ring Group.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits
Extension Name
Indicates the name of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Broadcast Mode
Specifies whether only the original caller can speak or up to 8 people can speak at the start of a conference
group call.
Value Range
Disable: The original caller and up to 7 participants can speak at the start of a conference group call.
Enable: Only the original caller can speak at the start of a conference group call.
Ability to Talk
Enables PT, SLT and PS users to use the push-to-talk feature during a conference group call, when
Broadcast Mode is set to "Enable". The push-to-talk feature allows PT, SLT and PS users to speak during
the call by pressing any of their dial keys.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Dial Number
Specifies the destination number of each member of the conference group.
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause])
Extension Name
Indicates the name of the extension, when an extension number is specified in Dial Number above
(reference only).
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Bandwidth Control
Specifies whether to use the bandwidth precedence setting of the P2P group for calling among different P2P
groups.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Notice
This screen is for programming legacy gateway PBXs. For information about setting up a legacy gateway
PBX, see 9.29 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Legacy-GW1/Legacy-GW2.
Unless noted otherwise, the programming information is the same as described in the PC Programming
Manual of the legacy gateway PBX. Refer to the corresponding Group—VM(DPT) Group—System
Settings section in the PC Programming Manual of the legacy gateway PBX for more information.
Notice
This screen is for programming legacy gateway PBXs. For information about setting up a legacy gateway
PBX, see 9.29 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Legacy-GW1/Legacy-GW2.
Unless noted otherwise, the programming information is the same as described in the PC Programming
Manual of the legacy gateway PBX. Refer to the corresponding Group—VM(DPT) Group—Unit
Settings section in the PC Programming Manual of the legacy gateway PBX for more information.
Notice
This screen is for programming legacy gateway PBXs. For information about setting up a legacy gateway
PBX, see 9.29 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Legacy-GW1/Legacy-GW2.
Unless noted otherwise, the programming information is the same as described in the PC Programming
Manual of the legacy gateway PBX. Refer to the corresponding Group—VM(DPT) Group—Unit
Settings—Member List section in the PC Programming Manual of the legacy gateway PBX for more
information.
The Site, Shelf, and Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Notice
This screen is for programming legacy gateway PBXs. For information about setting up a legacy gateway
PBX, see 9.29 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Legacy-GW1/Legacy-GW2.
Unless noted otherwise, the programming information is the same as described in the PC Programming
Manual of the legacy gateway PBX. Refer to the corresponding Group—VM(DTMF) Group—System
Settings section in the PC Programming Manual of the legacy gateway PBX for more information.
Notice
This screen is for programming legacy gateway PBXs. For information about setting up a legacy gateway
PBX, see 9.29 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Legacy-GW1/Legacy-GW2.
Unless noted otherwise, the programming information is the same as described in the PC Programming
Manual of the legacy gateway PBX. Refer to the corresponding Group—VM(DTMF) Group—Group
Settings section in the PC Programming Manual of the legacy gateway PBX for more information.
Notice
This screen is for programming legacy gateway PBXs. For information about setting up a legacy gateway
PBX, see 9.29 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Legacy-GW1/Legacy-GW2.
Unless noted otherwise, the programming information is the same as described in the PC Programming
Manual of the legacy gateway PBX. Refer to the corresponding Group—VM(DTMF) Group—Group
Settings—Member List section in the PC Programming Manual of the legacy gateway PBX for more
information.
Only ports set to VM(DPT) for DPT Type—Type in the extension’s Port Property screen will be displayed. For
details, see To access port properties in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
The Site, Shelf, and Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Main
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Port Type
Indicates the extension port type (reference only).
Value Range
DPT: DPT port (DLC)
SLT: SLT port (SLC/MSLC/CSLC/MCSLC/EMSLC)
S-Hybrid: Super Hybrid port (DHLC)
S-Hybrid(SLT): XDP port of Super Hybrid port (DHLC)
S-Hybrid(S-DPT): Digital XDP port of Super Hybrid port (DHLC)
Telephone Type
Indicates the type of telephone connected to the extension port (reference only).
Value Range
DPT (15V)/DPT (40V): DPT is connected.
APT (15V): APT is connected.
DSS: DSS Console is connected.
VM: VPS is connected.
ISDN-Extension: ISDN telephone is connected.
OPX: T1-OPX port (T1)
CS: CS is connected.
IP-PT: IP-PT belonging to the V-IPEXT card is connected.
UT: KX-UT series SIP phone is connected.
SIP: General SIP Extension is connected.
S-PS: SIP Portable Station is connected.
SIP-CS: SIP Cell Station is connected.
CS-M: High-density CS is connected with its master port.
CS-S1–3: High-density CS is connected with its slave port.
FAX: Fax Extension
No Connection: No telephone is connected.
UNKNOWN: SLT is connected (or no telephone is connected to the Super Hybrid or SLT port).
User Group
Specifies the extension user group to which the extension belongs. Extension user groups are used to compose
tenants, call pickup groups and paging groups.
Value Range
1–256
COS
Specifies the COS of the extension.
Value Range
1–512
Extension PIN
Specifies the PIN of the extension.
CAUTION
There is a risk that fraudulent telephone calls will be made if a third party discovers a personal identification
number (PIN) (verification code PIN or extension PIN) of the PBX.
The cost of such calls will be billed to the owner/renter of the PBX.
To protect the PBX from this kind of fraudulent use, we strongly recommend:
a. Keeping PINs secret.
b. Selecting complex, random PINs that cannot be easily guessed.
c. Changing PINs frequently.
To change an Extension PIN:
1. Click Edit under Extension PIN for the extension to change.
2. In the window that appears, enter the new extension PIN and then enter it again to confirm it.
3. Click OK.
Value Range
Max. 10 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Intercept Destination
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause])
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause])
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
0–240 s
CLIP
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
CLIP ID
Specifies the CLIP number sent to the public network to show on the called party’s telephone display when
making a trunk call.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
CLIP on Extension/CO
Selects the CLIP number to show on the called party’s telephone.
Value Range
Extension: Show the CLIP number specified in CLIP ID.
CO: Show the CLIP number specified in Subscriber Number in 9.27 PBX Configuration—[1-1]
Configuration—Slot—Port Property - BRI Port or 9.28 PBX Configuration—[1-1]
Configuration—Slot—Port Property - PRI Port.
CLIR
Specifies whether to restrict the display of the CLIP number on the called party’s telephone when making a
public network trunk call.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
COLR
Specifies whether to restrict the display of the CLIP number of the extension on the caller’s telephone display
when answering a call.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
UM
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Two-way Recording
Specifies whether to enable the two-way recording feature for the extension using the Unified Messaging
system.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Option 1
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Note
When Wireless XDP, S-PSs cannot be used with this setting.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
1–8
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 10 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Option 2
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Off: No notification
BSS: Tone from the handset or built-in speaker
OHCA: Voice from the built-in speaker
W-OHCA: Voice from the handset
Automatic C. Waiting
Specifies whether to receive call waiting notifications for calls from a trunk, doorphone calls, and calls via an
incoming call distribution group.
Value Range
Off, On
Value Range
Off, On
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash])
Data Mode
Sets or cancels the protection against tones or interruptions from other extensions during communication.
Value Range
Off, On
Option 3
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Disable: Allows other extension users to pick up calls to your extension
Enable: Prevents other extension users from picking up calls to your extension
Value Range
Display & Tone1, Display & Tone2, Display & Tone3, Display only, Disable
Note
• Supported terminals are: DPT, DPT (S-DPT), S-Hybrid, S-Hybrid (S-DPT), IP-EXT
• Depending on system programming, the number of terminals may be limited to 256. For more
information, consult your dealer.
Value Range
Disable: Allows other extension users to interrupt an existing call
Enable: Prevents other extension users from interrupting an existing call
Absent Message
Specifies the Personal Absent Message which, unlike the System Absent Message, can be customised for
each extension.
Value Range
Max. 16 characters
Charge Limit
Specifies the maximum limit of call charges allowed for the extension. When this limit is reached, the extension
cannot be used to make further trunk calls.
The number of decimal places that can be specified here depends on the value set in Charge
Options—Digits After Decimal Point in 14.2 PBX Configuration—[6-2] Feature—Hotel & Charge.
Value Range
0–9999999
Value Range
Tone Call, Voice Call, Deny Voice Call
Option 4
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
No Line: No line is seized.
Idle: An idle trunk is seized automatically from the programmed trunk groups.
ICM/PDN: An extension line is seized, or, for a PDN extension, an idle PDN button is selected.
F-1–F-84: A trunk programmed for a flexible button (F-1–F-84) is seized. A flexible button customised as a
Single-CO, Group-CO, Loop-CO, or ICD Group button must be selected.
Value Range
No Line: No line is selected. Select a line by pressing the desired Line Access button to answer a call.
Ringing Line: The longest ringing call is selected.
PDN: The call arriving at any PDN button is selected.
F-1–F-84: The call arriving at a flexible button (F-1–F-84) is selected. A flexible button customised as a
Single-CO, Group-CO, Loop-CO, or ICD Group button must be selected.
Value Range
CW Tone 1, CW Tone 2
Value Range
Stop Record, Keep Record
Value Range
Hands free: Monitor through the built-in speaker
Private: Monitor through the handset or the built-in speaker after hearing a warning tone
Option 5
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Display Language
Selects the display language of the extension telephone.
Value Range
Language1–Language5
Value Range
Caller ID Name, CO Line Name, DDI/DID Name
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Off, On
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Option 6
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Off, On
Value Range
No Limitation, One-touch Dial
ICM Tone
Selects the ring tone for incoming calls arriving at the INTERCOM button or PDN buttons. Note that the ring
tone specified here is applied to all PDN buttons on an extension.
Value Range
IP-PT (except KX-NT265/KX-NT321): 1–30
KX-NT265/KX-NT321: 1–8 (Even if ring tone 9–30 is selected, ring tone 1 is heard.)
Other telephones: 1–8 (Even if ring tone 9–30 is selected, ring tone 2 is heard.)
Display Lock
Locks or unlocks the Incoming Call Log display (i.e., specifies whether other extension users can see the
Incoming Call Log information at the extension).
Value Range
Unlock, Lock
Paging Deny
Specifies whether paging of the extension from other extensions is enabled.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Option 7
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Table 1: Standard mode
Table 2: Option mode
Value Range
EFA, Terminate, Flash Recall
Value Range
0–100
Value Range
1–100
ISDN Bearer
Selects the ISDN bearer mode. When Automatic is selected, the bearer mode is set automatically depending
on the extension’s telephone type as follows:
PT: Speech
SLT: Audio
Value Range
Automatic, Speech, Audio
Option 8
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
0–15 s
SLT MW Mode
Enables the use of the Message Waiting Lamp on an SLT extension connected to the extension port.
Value Range
Disable, MW-Lamp
Wrap-up Timer
Specifies the length of time that must pass after completing a call before an extension will accept another call
when logged in as a member of an Incoming Call Distribution Group.
This timer is used when " Options—Wrap-up Timer based on" is set to "Extension" in 11.5.3 PBX
Configuration—[3-5-3] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous.
Value Range
0–3000 s
Option 9
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Immediate, 1 Ring, 2 Rings, 3 Rings, 4 Rings, 5 Rings, 6 Rings
Value Range
Disable, Basic Only, Enable
Mobile Extension
Specifies whether to enable or disable mobile extension features (with a cellular phone or other outside
destination) for the extension.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
FWD / DND
Call Forwarding (FWD) and Do Not Disturb (DND) settings for each extension can be referred. FWD and DND
settings can be programmed separately for each extension in 12.1.2 PBX Configuration—[4-1-2]
Extension—Wired Extension—FWD/DND.
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the extension.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
None, FWD All, FWD Busy, FWD N/A, FWD Busy N/A
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause])
Value Range
None, FWD All, FWD Busy, FWD N/A, FWD Busy N/A
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause])
Value Range
0–120 s
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, 1–512
Value Range
Wired extension number
Value Range
1–total number of connected wired extensions
Parameter—Deleting Digits
Specifies the number of digits to be deleted from the start of an extension number when using it as part of the
CLIP number.
Value Range
0–5
Parameter—Head of ID
Specifies a prefix number to be applied to all generated CLIP numbers.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Parameter—Tail of ID
Specifies a suffix number to be applied to all generated CLIP numbers.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Always (All), Busy, No Answer, Busy / No Answer, Do Not Disturb, Off
Value Range
Always (All), Busy, No Answer, Busy / No Answer, Do Not Disturb, Off
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash])
Note
Up to 64 KX-NT505 units can be connected to the PBX system.
Note
The Copy to button can be used with KX-NT505 units, even if the number of connected KX-NT505 units
differs between extensions. Settings for NT505 Location No. will be copied to the same number of the
copy target extension. However, if a matching NT505 Location No. does not exist at the target destination,
those settings will not be copied.
For more information on flexible buttons, see "2.21.2 Flexible Buttons" in the Feature Guide.
Once flexible buttons have been programmed, the Terminal Label Print utility can be used to print label sheets,
which can be attached to extension telephones for quick reference. For details, see 1.2.2.1 Editing and
Printing Terminal Labels in Off-line Mode.
To access the Super Master CS for related programming, click SIP-CS Web. The CS Web login screen will
open in your web browser.
Note
For this button to be enabled, you must specify the URL of the Super Master CS in the Utility—CS-Web
Connection screen. See 7.12 Utility—CS-Web Connection.
Type
Specifies the feature to be assigned to the flexible button.
Value Range
Not Stored, Loop CO, Single CO, Group CO, DSS, One-touch, ICD Group, Message Waiting, FWD/DND
(Both), FWD/DND (External), FWD/DND (Internal), Group Fwd (Both), Group Fwd (External), Group Fwd
(Internal), Account, Conference, Terminate, EFA, Charge, Call Park, Call Log, Log-in/Log-out, Hurry-up,
Wrap-up, System Alarm, Time Service, Answer, Release, TRS Level Change, ISDN Service, CLIR, COLR,
ISDN Hold, Headset, Time Service - Automatic/Manual, Check In, Check Out, Cleaned Up, Two-way
Record, Two-way Transfer, LCS, Voice Mail Transfer, NDSS, CTI, PDN, SDN, DN
Notice
For each KX-UT series SIP phone that is connected to the PBX, at least one DN button must be assigned
to the extension. Without a DN button assigned, the extension will not be able to make or receive calls.
Value Range
1–600
Value Range
1–96
Value Range
Automatic, Specific
Value Range
None: The incoming call distribution group is selected manually.
All: All incoming call distribution groups that the extension belongs to.
Incoming Group: A pre-specified incoming call distribution group
Value Range
All (Day/Night/Lunch/Break), Day/Night/Break, Day/Night/Lunch, Day/Night
Value Range
Level 1–Level 7
Value Range
Table 1–Table 32 or Table 1–Table 128
Note
The maximum number of time tables (1 per tenant) depends on the System Capacity Selection setting
made when the Easy Setup Wizard was run for the PBX. If the System Resource Type was selected, the
maximum number of tenants (and therefore, time tables) is 128. If the Standard Type or IP-Extension
Type was selected, the maximum number of tenants is 32. For details, refer to "5.4.1 Easy Setup
Wizard" in the Installation Manual.
Value Range
Immediate, 1 Ring, 2 Rings, 3 Rings, 4 Rings, 5 Rings, 6 Rings, No Ring
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 8 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Indicates the name of the extension, when an extension number is specified (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash])
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash])
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Label Name
Specifies the name of each flexible button for KX-NT366 and KX-NT553/KX-NT556/KX-NT560 IP-PTs, and
KX-UT248 and KX-UT670 SIP-MLTs. The name specified here is displayed on the LCD for each button.
Value Range
Max. 12 characters
Note
The maximum length for KX-UT248 and KX-UT670 labels is 10 characters.
Value Range
Table 1–Table 32 or Table 1–Table 128
Note
The maximum number of time tables (1 per tenant) depends on the System Capacity Selection setting
made when the Easy Setup Wizard was run for the PBX. If the System Resource Type was selected, the
maximum number of tenants (and therefore, time tables) is 128. If the Standard Type or IP-Extension
Type was selected, the maximum number of tenants is 32. For details, refer to "5.4.1 Easy Setup
Wizard" in the Installation Manual.
Optional Parameter (Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Loop CO, Single CO,
Group CO, ICD Group, SDN)
Specifies the ring tone type.
Value Range
IP-PT (except KX-NT265/KX-NT321): 1–30
KX-NT265/KX-NT321: 1–8 (Even if ring tone 9–30 is selected, ring tone 1 is heard.)
S-PS: Not available.
Other telephones: 1–8 (Even if ring tone 9–30 is selected, ring tone 2 is heard.)
Value Range
Park 00–Park 99
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Type
Specifies whether to store a dialling number for the one-touch access.
Value Range
Not Stored, One Touch
Dial
Specifies the number to be dialled.
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash])
Network BLF Data to NDSS Key of Other PBX - Other PBX (Network PBX ID=1)
Selects whether extension status data is transmitted over the network for the selected extension. This setting
is automatically set to ON when the feature is used, and can only be manually changed from ON to OFF, to
cancel data transmission.
Value Range
OFF, ON
Extension Number
Indicates the extension number of the extension (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Indicates the name of the extension (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
CLIP 1–8
Specifies up to 8 CLIP IDs for the extension.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Main
Extension Number
Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the PS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Property
Indicates the property (reference only).
Value Range
Portable Station
User Group
Specifies the extension user group to which the PS belongs. The extension user group is used to compose
tenants, call pickup groups and paging groups.
Value Range
1–256
COS
Specifies the COS of the PS.
Value Range
1–512
Extension PIN
Specifies the PIN of the PS.
CAUTION
There is a risk that fraudulent telephone calls will be made if a third party discovers a personal identification
number (PIN) (verification code PIN or extension PIN) of the PBX.
The cost of such calls will be billed to the owner/renter of the PBX.
To protect the PBX from this kind of fraudulent use, we strongly recommend:
a. Keeping PINs secret.
b. Selecting complex, random PINs that cannot be easily guessed.
c. Changing PINs frequently.
To change an extension PIN:
1. Click Edit under Extension PIN for the extension to change.
2. In the window that appears, enter the new extension PIN and then enter it again to confirm it.
3. Click OK.
Value Range
Max. 10 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Intercept Destination
Extension Number
Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the PS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause])
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause])
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the PS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
0–240 s
CLIP
Extension Number
Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the PS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
CLIP ID
Specifies the CLIP number sent to the public network to show on the called party’s telephone display when
making a trunk call.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
CLIP on Extension/CO
Selects the CLIP number to show on the called party’s telephone.
Value Range
Extension: Show the CLIP number specified in CLIP ID.
CO: Show the CLIP number specified in Subscriber Number in 9.27 PBX Configuration—[1-1]
Configuration—Slot—Port Property - BRI Port or 9.28 PBX Configuration—[1-1]
Configuration—Slot—Port Property - PRI Port.
CLIR
Specifies whether to restrict the display of the CLIP number on the called party’s telephone when making a
public network trunk call.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
COLR
Specifies whether to restrict the display of the CLIP number of the PS on the caller’s telephone display when
answering a call.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
UM
Extension Number
Specifies the extension number of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the PS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Two-way Recording
Specifies whether to enable the two-way recording feature for the PS using the Unified Messaging system.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Option 1
Extension Number
Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the PS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
1–8
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 10 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Option 2
Extension Number
Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the PS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Off: No notification
BSS: Tone from the handset or built-in speaker
OHCA: If selected, a BSS notification will be received.
W-OHCA: If selected, a BSS notification will be received.
Automatic C. Waiting
Specifies whether to receive call waiting notification for a call from trunk, a doorphone call or a call via an
incoming call distribution group.
Value Range
Off, On
Value Range
Off, On
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash])
Option 3
Extension Number
Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the PS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Disable: Allows other extension users to pick up calls to your PS
Enable: Prevents other extension users from picking up calls to your PS
Value Range
Disable: Allows other extension users to interrupt an existing call
Enable: Prevents other extension users from interrupting an existing call
Absent Message
Specifies the Personal Absent Message which, unlike the System Absent Message, can be customised for
each PS.
Value Range
Max. 16 characters
Charge Limit
Specifies the maximum limit of call charges allowed for the PS. When this limit is reached, the PS cannot be
used to make further trunk calls.
The number of decimal places that can be specified here depends on the value set in Charge
Options—Digits After Decimal Point in 14.2 PBX Configuration—[6-2] Feature—Hotel & Charge.
Value Range
0–9999999
Option 4
Extension Number
Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the PS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
No Line: No line is seized.
Idle: An idle trunk is seized automatically from the programmed trunk groups.
ICM/PDN: An extension line is seized, or, for a PDN extension, an idle PDN button is selected.
F-1–F-12: A trunk programmed for a flexible button (F-1–F-12) is seized. A flexible button customised as a
Single-CO, Group-CO, Loop-CO, or ICD Group button must be selected.
Value Range
No Line: No line is selected. Select a line by pressing the desired Line Access button to answer a call.
Ringing Line: The longest ringing call is selected.
PDN: The call arriving at any PDN button is selected.
F-1–F-12: The call arriving at a flexible button (F-1–F-12) is selected. A flexible button customised as a
Single-CO, Group-CO, Loop-CO, or ICD Group button must be selected.
Value Range
CW Tone 1, CW Tone 2
Value Range
Stop Record, Keep Record
Option 5
Extension Number
Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the PS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Display Language
Selects the display language of the PS.
Value Range
Language1–Language5
Value Range
Caller ID Name, CO Line Name, DDI/DID Name
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Option 6
Extension Number
Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the PS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
No Limitation, One-touch Dial
Option 7
Extension Number
Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the PS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Table 1: Standard mode
Table 2: Option mode
Value Range
EFA, Terminate, Flash Recall
Value Range
0–100
Value Range
1–100
ISDN Bearer
Selects the ISDN bearer mode. When Automatic is selected, the bearer mode is set automatically depending
on the type of the PS.
Value Range
Automatic, Speech, Audio
Option 8
Extension Number
Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the PS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Wrap-up Timer
Specifies the length of time that must pass after completing a call before a PS will accept another call when
logged in as a member of an Incoming Call Distribution Group.
This timer is used when " Options—Wrap-up Timer based on" is set to "Extension" in 11.5.3 PBX
Configuration—[3-5-3] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous.
Value Range
0–3000 s
Option 9
Extension Number
Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the PS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Immediate, 1 Ring, 2 Rings, 3 Rings, 4 Rings, 5 Rings, 6 Rings
Value Range
Disable, Basic Only, Enable
Mobile Extension
Specifies whether to enable or disable mobile extension features (with a cellular phone or other outside
destination) for the extension.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
FWD / DND
Call Forwarding (FWD) and Do Not Disturb (DND) settings for each PS can be referred. FWD and DND settings
can be programmed separately for each PS in 12.2.2 PBX Configuration—[4-2-2] Extension—Portable
Station—FWD/DND.
Extension Number
Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Specifies the name of the PS.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
None, FWD All, FWD Busy, FWD N/A, FWD Busy N/A
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause])
Value Range
None, FWD All, FWD Busy, FWD N/A, FWD Busy N/A
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause])
Value Range
0–120 s
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, 1–512
Value Range
PS extension number
Value Range
1–total number of connected PS extensions
Parameter—Deleting Digits
Specifies the number of digits to be deleted from the start of an extension number when using it as part of the
CLIP number.
Value Range
0–4
Parameter—Head of ID
Specifies a prefix number to be applied to all generated CLIP numbers.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Parameter—Tail of ID
Specifies a suffix number to be applied to all generated CLIP numbers.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Always (All), Busy, No Answer, Busy / No Answer, Do Not Disturb, Off
Value Range
Always (All), Busy, No Answer, Busy / No Answer, Do Not Disturb, Off
Type
Specifies the feature to be assigned to the flexible button.
Value Range
Not Stored, Loop CO, Single CO, Group CO, DSS, One-touch, ICD Group, Message Waiting, FWD/DND
(Both), FWD/DND (External), FWD/DND (Internal), Group Fwd (Both), Group Fwd (External), Group Fwd
(Internal), Account, Conference, Terminate, EFA, Charge, Call Park, Log-in/Log-out, Hurry-up, Wrap-up, Time
Service, TRS Level Change, ISDN Service, CLIR, COLR, ISDN Hold, Time Service - Automatic/Manual,
Two-way Record, Two-way Transfer, LCS, Voice Mail Transfer, NDSS, CTI, PDN, SDN
Value Range
1–600
Value Range
1–96
Value Range
Automatic, Specific
Value Range
None: The incoming call distribution group is selected manually.
All: All incoming call distribution groups that the PS belongs to.
Incoming Group: A pre-specified incoming call distribution group
Value Range
All (Day/Night/Lunch/Break), Day/Night/Break, Day/Night/Lunch, Day/Night
Value Range
Level 1–Level 7
Value Range
Table 1–Table 32
Value Range
Immediate, 1 Ring, 2 Rings, 3 Rings, 4 Rings, 5 Rings, 6 Rings, No Ring
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 8 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Indicates the name of the extension, when an extension number is specified (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash])
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash])
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Optional Parameter (or Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Time Service)
Specifies the Time Table to be used for changing time modes in the Automatic Switching mode.
Value Range
Table 1–Table 32
Optional Parameter (or Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Call Park)
Specifies the number of the parking zone a call is to be parked in when a Call Park button with Parameter
Selection (for Call Park) on this screen set to Specific is pressed.
Value Range
Park 00–Park 99
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Network BLF Data to NDSS Key of Other PBX - Other PBX (Network PBX ID=1)
Selects whether extension status data is transmitted over the network for the selected extension. This setting
is automatically set to ON when the feature is used, and can only be manually changed from ON to OFF, to
cancel data transmission.
Value Range
OFF, ON
Extension Number
Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Extension Name
Indicates the name of the PS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
CLIP 1–8
Specifies up to 8 CLIP IDs for the PS.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Notice
This screen is for programming legacy gateway PBXs. For information about setting up a legacy gateway
PBX, see 9.29 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Legacy-GW1/Legacy-GW2.
Unless noted otherwise, the programming information is the same as described in the PC Programming
Manual of the legacy gateway PBX. Refer to the corresponding Extension—DSS Console section in the
PC Programming Manual of the legacy gateway PBX for more information.
To copy DSS Console setting values from one location to another, click the Copy to button.
Once DSS console buttons have been programmed, the Terminal Label Print utility can be used to print label
sheets, which can be attached to DSS consoles for quick reference. For details, see 1.2.2.1 Editing and
Printing Terminal Labels in Off-line Mode.
DOORPHONE Number
Indicates the number of the doorphone (reference only).
Value Range
Doorphone number
Name
Specifies the doorphone name.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause])
Tenant Number
Specifies the tenant number for the doorphone port in order to apply the Time Table (day/lunch/break/night).
Value Range
1–32 or 1–128
Note
The maximum number of time tables (1 per tenant) depends on the System Capacity Selection setting
made when the Easy Setup Wizard was run for the PBX. If the System Resource Type was selected, the
maximum number of tenants (and therefore, time tables) is 128. If the Standard Type or IP-Extension
Type was selected, the maximum number of tenants is 32. For details, refer to "5.4.1 Easy Setup
Wizard" in the Installation Manual.
COS
Specifies the Class of Service (COS) number. COS programming determines the doorphone ports that are
able to make trunk calls, and sets restrictions on intercom calls from certain extensions (Internal Call Block).
Value Range
1–512
Value Range
None, 1–64
Value Range
1–48
ID
Indicates the Site ID corresponding to the site numbers of PBXs in the One-look network (reference only).
Value Range
1–16
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Name
Specifies the name of the external pager.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Option 1
DISA Security—DISA Security Mode
Selects the DISA security mode to prevent unauthorised access to the PBX. In Trunk or All Security mode, the
caller is required to override security by Walking COS or Verification Code Entry in order to enable the restricted
feature temporarily.
Value Range
None: Intercom calls, TIE line calls, and trunk calls can be made.
Trunk: Intercom calls and TIE line calls without PBX code can be made. TIE line calls with PBX code and trunk
calls are restricted.
All: All calls are restricted.
DISA Security—Remote Walking COS through DISA without PIN (Activation Key
Required)
Enables registered caller ID numbers to be automatically recognised as PBX extensions when calling through
DISA, and to use the Walking COS features without entering a PIN.
Value Range
Disable, Enable (Get DISA)
Value Range
Busy Tone, Enable, Busy Message
Value Range
to Operator, to AA-0, to AA-9, Disable (Busy Tone)
Value Range
to Operator, to AA-0, to AA-9, Disable (Reorder Tone)
Value Range
Disable (Release DISA): The DISA port is released when a trunk-to-public trunk call using DISA is established.
Enable: DISA stays connected for the duration of the call, to allow detection of the end of the call.
Value Range
Disable (Release DISA): The DISA port is released when a trunk-to-private trunk call using DISA is established.
Enable: DISA stays connected for the duration of the call, to allow detection of the end of the call.
Value Range
Disable: Trunk-to-public trunk calls are established without using DISA.
Enable (Get DISA): Trunk-to-public trunk calls are established using DISA, and DISA can be used to detect
the end of the call.
Value Range
Disable: Trunk-to-private trunk calls are established without using DISA.
Enable (Get DISA): Trunk-to-private trunk calls are established using DISA, and DISA can be used to detect
the end of the call.
Value Range
Disable: "#" is ignored if dialled.
Enable (as "Flash"): The current trunk call will be placed on hold, then transferred to the extension whose
number is entered.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Option 2
Timed Reminder Message—Day, Lunch, Break, Night
Specifies the pre-recorded message to play when a Timed Reminder call is answered in each time mode.
Value Range
None, 1–64
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Name
Specifies the name of the OGM.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
None, 1–64
Fax Extension
Specifies the extension number to which to transfer a call when a fax signal is detected.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
1–80
Name
Specifies the relay name.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
1–7 s
COS Number
Specifies the Class of Service (COS) number. COS programming determines the extensions that are able to
activate relays.
Value Range
1–512
Value Range
1–80
Name
Specifies the sensor name.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause])
Tenant No.
Specifies the tenant to which the sensor belongs, to determine the Time Table for the sensor. (The tenant
number corresponds to the Time Table number.)
Value Range
1–32 or 1–128
Note
The maximum number of tenants depends on the System Capacity Selection setting made when the
Easy Setup Wizard was run for the PBX. If the System Resource Type was selected, the maximum
number of tenants is 128. If the Standard Type or IP-Extension Type was selected, the maximum number
of tenants is 32. For details, refer to "5.4.1 Easy Setup Wizard" in the Installation Manual.
Memory
Selects the System Speed Dialling Table to be programmed. Whether a tenant uses the basic System Speed
Dialling Table or the additional table depends on the setting of System Speed Dial in 14.6 PBX
Configuration—[6-6] Feature—Tenant.
Value Range
Basic Memory: the standard table
Expansion for Tenant 1–32 or 1–128: additional tables
Note
• If "Expansion for Tenant" is selected, and the PBX has been setup using the System Resource
Type configuration, a maximum of 300 System Speed Dialling numbers can be saved for each tenant.
For details, refer to "5.4.1 Easy Setup Wizard" in the Installation Manual.
• The maximum number of time tables (1 per tenant) depends on the System Capacity Selection setting
made when the Easy Setup Wizard was run for the PBX. If the System Resource Type was selected,
the maximum number of tenants (and therefore, time tables) is 128. If the Standard Type or
IP-Extension Type was selected, the maximum number of tenants is 32. For details, refer to
"5.4.1 Easy Setup Wizard" in the Installation Manual.
Name
Specifies a name for the System Speed Dialling number.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash])
CLI Destination
Specifies the CLI destination (extension) to which incoming calls from the programmed telephone number are
routed. If a Caller ID Modification Table is being used, the modified number must match the telephone number
above (CO Line Access Number + Telephone Number) in order for the call to be routed correctly.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Main
Hotel Operator—Extension 1–4
Specifies the numbers of the extensions designated as hotel operators.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
No Print, Print
Value Range
No Print, Print
Value Range
Max. 16 characters
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Bill
Checkout Billing—Billing for Guest
Activates call billing features for the PBX.
Value Range
OFF, ON
Value Range
Max. 12 characters
Value Range
Max. 12 characters
Value Range
Max. 12 characters
Value Range
Max. 12 characters
Value Range
Max. 12 characters
Value Range
Max. 12 characters
Value Range
Language 1–Language 5
Value Range
Max. 80 characters
Value Range
Max. 80 characters
Charge
Margin & Tax—Margin Rate for "Telephone" (%)
Specifies the percentage margin to be added to telephone charges displayed on the guest bill.
Value Range
0.00–99.99 %
Value Range
0.00–99.99 %
Value Range
0.00–99.99 %
Value Range
0.00–99.99 %
Value Range
0–6
Charge Options—Currency
Specifies the currency characters shown on the display of the extension and the SMDR.
Value Range
Max. 3 characters
Value Range
Head, Tail
Value Range
Alarm: Only a warning tone is heard.
Alarm + Disconnect: A warning tone is heard, and then the call is disconnected.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Verification Code
Specifies the verification code.
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
User Name
Specifies the user name assigned to the verification code.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
CAUTION
There is a risk that fraudulent telephone calls will be made if a third party discovers a personal identification
number (PIN) (verification code PIN or extension PIN) of the PBX.
The cost of such calls will be billed to the owner/renter of the PBX.
To protect the PBX from this kind of fraudulent use, we strongly recommend:
a. Keeping PINs secret.
b. Selecting complex, random PINs that cannot be easily guessed.
c. Changing PINs frequently.
Value Range
Max. 10 digits (consisting of 0–9)
COS Number
Specifies the COS that applies when making a trunk call with the verification code.
Value Range
1–512
Value Range
Max. 10 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Budget Management
Specifies the limit of the call charge that will be counted on the verification code.
The number of decimal places that can be specified here depends on the value set in Charge
Options—Digits After Decimal Point in 14.2 PBX Configuration—[6-2] Feature—Hotel & Charge.
Value Range
0–9999999
Value Range
Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
0–20
Note
When using this feature in conjunction with the Unified Messaging (UM) system, changing a message here
will create a difference between the displayed message and the UM’s pre-recorded greeting that
corresponds to the absent message. To use both features in synchronisation, you must record a
corresponding greeting for each absent message changed. For details about changing UM system
prompts, see 7.9 Utility—UM – System Prompts Customisation.
Absent Message
Specifies the message for display.
Value Range
Max. 16 characters
Music On Hold
Specifies the audio source to be used for Music on Hold.
Value Range
Same as System Setting, BGM1, BGM2, BGM3, BGM4, BGM5, BGM6, BGM7, BGM8, Tone
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
ARS Mode
Specifies the ARS mode used when making a trunk call.
Value Range
Off: ARS is disabled.
On for Local Access Operation: ARS operates when an extension user makes a call using any Idle Line Access
method.
On for Any CO Access Operation: ARS operates when an extension user makes a call using any Trunk Access
method.
Same as System Setting: The setting specified in ARS Mode in 16.1 PBX Configuration—[8-1]
ARS—System Setting is applied.
Value Range
Same as System Setting: PBX common system speed dialling numbers are used.
Tenant Exclusive: Individual tenant system speed dialling numbers are used.
Value Range
Normal: Use the clock of the PBX to which the device or trunk for a service (e.g., incoming call features) is
connected.
1–16: Use the clock of the PBX in the One-look network with the selected Site ID.
Extension Directory
Specifies whether the display for the Speed Dialling numbers is for the entire system, or only for the extensions
of the tenant group that the extension belongs to.
Value Range
System: All system Speed Dialling numbers are displayed.
Tenant: Only the extensions of the tenant group that the extension belongs to are displayed.
Level 2–Level 6
Specifies the leading digits of toll restricted numbers for each level.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and X)
Level 2–Level 6
Specifies the leading digits of the numbers to be exempted from toll restriction/call barring for each level.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and X)
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Emergency Number
Specifies the numbers used for making emergency calls. It is not necessary to start the emergency number
with a Trunk Access number.
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], P [Pause], and F [Flash])
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
No Check, Check
Value Range
Disconnect: The trunk is disconnected as soon as the timer expires.
Keep: The TRS/Barring check is performed when the timer expires.
Value Range
None, 1–7
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Deny Table 2_N + Except Table N_6: The Denied Code Tables for the higher levels are applied to all levels
below it, and the Exception Code Tables for the lower levels are applied to all levels above it.
Deny Table N + Except Table N: Each level has its own separate set of denied codes and exception codes,
which are only applied to that level.
ARS Mode
Selects the condition to determine when to operate ARS.
Value Range
Off: ARS is disabled.
On for Local Access Operation: ARS operates when an extension user makes a call using Idle Line Access
method.
On for Any CO Access Operation: ARS operates when an extension user makes a call using Idle Line Access,
Trunk Access, or S-CO Line Access method.
Value Range
Disconnect: the line will be disconnected.
Local Access: the dialled number will be handled by Idle Line Access method.
Leading Number
Specifies the leading number.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and X)
Value Range
0–15
Value Range
1–48
Time-A–D—Setting
Enables the setting of the start time for each time block.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Time-A–D—Hour, Minute
Specifies the start time for each time block.
Note
Time-A must be the earliest block in the day, and the following blocks must be set in chronological order.
Value Range
00:00–23:59
Time-A–Time-D
Specifies the carrier to be given priority for each time zone.
Value Range
None, 1–128
Carrier Name
Specifies the carrier name.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
0–15
Modify Command
Specifies the commands to modify the user-dialled number to access the carrier. For details of each command,
see the Feature Guide.
Value Range
Max. 16 characters (consisting of 0–9, *, #, C, P, A, G, I and H)
Value Range
1–8
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and P [Pause])
TRG Priority
Selects the order in which trunk groups are seized when making calls via each carrier.
Value Range
None, 1–96
TRG 01–TRG 96
Selects the trunk groups that connect to the carrier.
TRG 01–TRG 96
Enables each trunk group for each carrier. If a cell is highlighted in blue, that trunk group is enabled for use
with that carrier.
Value Range
OFF (white), ON (blue)
Note
The maximum number of tenants depends on the System Capacity Selection setting made when the
Easy Setup Wizard was run for the PBX. If the System Resource Type was selected, the maximum
number of tenants is 128. If the Standard Type or IP-Extension Type was selected, the maximum number
of tenants is 32. For details, refer to "5.4.1 Easy Setup Wizard" in the Installation Manual.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and X)
TRG—TRG 01–TRG 96
Specifies the Authorisation code of each carrier for each trunk group.
Value Range
Max. 10 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 7 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Priority 1–Priority 8
Leading Number
Specifies the leading number for other PBX extension numbers or the PBX code of others in the TIE line
network.
Value Range
Max. 3 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
0–15
Added Number
Specifies the number to be added to the dialled number in place of the removed digits for each priority.
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and P [Pause])
Trunk Group
Specifies the trunk group to be used for TIE line calls for each priority.
Value Range
None, 1–96
Enhanced QSIG
Leading Number
Specifies the leading number for other PBX extension numbers or the PBX code of other PBXs in the TIE line
network.
Value Range
Max. 3 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
0: The PBX retransmits BLF data sent by other PBXs.
1: The PBX receives BLF data sent by other PBXs.
2–8: The PBX transmits BLF data over the network.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
1–63
Value Range
100 ´ n (n=0–30) ms
Value Range
0–10
Value Range
10–240 s
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Site
Specifies the PBX in the One-look network where the V-IPGW16 card is installed for sending extension status
data.
Value Range
Site name in the One-look network
Value Range
Undefined, 2, 31–46
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
None, 1–8
Unit No.
Indicates the unit number of the UM system or VM unit, as assigned by the PBX (reference only).
Value Range
Unit No.
Value Range
Max. 8 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Max. 20 Characters
Card Type
Indicates the type of card to which the trunk is connected (reference only).
Value Range
Card type
CO Name
Specifies the trunk name which is shown on the extension’s display when receiving a call from the trunk.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
1–96
DIL
For each trunk to which DIL distribution is set, different DIL destinations can be programmed depending on
the time mode (day/lunch/break/night). Generally, DIL distribution is used for trunk calls from analogue trunks.
Tenant number and service group number can also be programmed for each trunk.
To assign DIL destination numbers, enter directly or click Destination Setting (see 2.1.7 Extension Number
Setting).
The Site, Shelf, Slot, and Port for each item are displayed for your reference. For details, see Common
Programming Reference Items in 9.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot.
Card Type
Indicates the trunk card type (reference only).
Value Range
Card type
Trunk Property
Indicates the networking type of each trunk (reference only).
Value Range
Public, Private(TIE), VPN
Distribution Method
Selects the distribution method for incoming trunk calls. The value range of this setting depends on the card
type and Trunk Property assigned for each trunk.
Value Range
DIL: Distribution depends on the trunk through which the calls arrive
DDI/DID: Distribution depends on the DDI/DID number of the calls
MSN: Distribution depends on the MSN of the calls
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Tenant Number
Specifies the tenant number, to determine the Time Table by which calls are distributed depending on the time
of day.
Value Range
1–32 or 1–128
Note
The maximum number of tenants depends on the System Capacity Selection setting made when the
Easy Setup Wizard was run for the PBX. If the System Resource Type was selected, the maximum
number of tenants is 128. If the Standard Type or IP-Extension Type was selected, the maximum number
of tenants is 32. For details, refer to "5.4.1 Easy Setup Wizard" in the Installation Manual.
Value Range
None, 1–64
Value Range
1–48
Card Type
Indicates the trunk card type (reference only).
Value Range
Card type
Trunk Property
Indicates the networking type of each trunk (reference only).
Value Range
Public, Private(TIE), VPN
Distribution Method
Selects the distribution method for incoming trunk calls. The value range of this setting depends on the card
type and Trunk Property assigned for each trunk.
Value Range
DIL: Distribution depends on the trunk through which the calls arrive
DDI/DID: Distribution depends on the DDI/DID number of the calls
MSN: Distribution depends on the MSN of the calls
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Card Type
Indicates the trunk card type (reference only).
Value Range
Card type
Trunk Property
Indicates the networking type of each trunk (reference only).
Value Range
Public, Private(TIE), VPN
Distribution Method
Selects the distribution method for incoming trunk calls. The value range of this setting depends on the card
type and Trunk Property assigned for each trunk.
Value Range
DIL: Distribution depends on the trunk through which the calls arrive
DDI/DID: Distribution depends on the DDI/DID number of the calls
MSN: Distribution depends on the MSN of the calls
DDI/DID/TIE/MSN—Remove Digit
Specifies the number of leading digits to be removed from the incoming called number for DDI/DID distribution
or for TIE line service.
Value Range
0–15
DDI/DID/TIE/MSN—Additional Dial
Specifies the number to be added to the incoming called number in the place of the removed digits for DDI/
DID distribution or for TIE line service.
Value Range
Max. 8 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Tenant Number
Specifies the tenant number, to determine the Time Table by which calls are distributed depending on the time
of day.
Value Range
1–32 or 1–128
Note
The maximum number of tenants depends on the System Capacity Selection setting made when the
Easy Setup Wizard was run for the PBX. If the System Resource Type was selected, the maximum
number of tenants is 128. If the Standard Type or IP-Extension Type was selected, the maximum number
of tenants is 32. For details, refer to "5.4.1 Easy Setup Wizard" in the Installation Manual.
Value Range
None, 1–64
Value Range
1–48
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
1–1000
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Number of Registration
Specifies the number of locations to be programmed.
Value Range
1–1000
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
1–1000
Number to Generate
Specifies the number of locations to be programmed.
Value Range
1–1000
Value Range
0–32
Name Prefix
Specifies the text to be included at the start of each DDI/DID name.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Name Suffix
Specifies the text to be included at the end of each DDI/DID name.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
MSN
To assign MSN destination numbers, enter directly or click Destination Setting (see 2.1.7 Extension Number
Setting).
Site
Indicates the site number of the PBX in the One-look network (reference only).
Value Range
1– 16
Shelf
Indicates the shelf type and/or position (reference only).
Value Range
1 (Physical), Virtual
Slot
Indicates the slot position of the BRI card that is set to MSN distribution (reference only).
Value Range
Slot number
Port
Indicates the port number of the BRI card that is set to MSN distribution (reference only).
Value Range
Port number
MSN Number
Specifies the MSN.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
MSN Name
Specifies the name for the MSN which is shown on the extension’s display when receiving a call with the MSN.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Tenant Number
Specifies the tenant number, to determine the Time Table by which calls are distributed depending on the time
of day.
Value Range
1–32 or 1–128
Note
The maximum number of tenants depends on the System Capacity Selection setting made when the
Easy Setup Wizard was run for the PBX. If the System Resource Type was selected, the maximum
number of tenants is 128. If the Standard Type or IP-Extension Type was selected, the maximum number
of tenants is 32. For details, refer to "5.4.1 Easy Setup Wizard" in the Installation Manual.
Value Range
None, 1–64
Value Range
1–48
Site
Indicates the site number of the PBX in the One-look network (reference only).
Value Range
1– 16
Shelf
Indicates the shelf type and/or position (reference only).
Value Range
1 (Physical), Virtual
Slot
Indicates the slot position of the BRI card that is set to MSN distribution (reference only).
Value Range
Slot number
Port
Indicates the port number of the BRI card that is set to MSN distribution (reference only).
Value Range
Port number
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable (Busy Tone): Sends a busy tone to the caller. (However, a call through an LCOT card will ring at the
original destination while the caller hears a ringback tone.)
Enable: Redirects the call to the intercept destination
Value Range
Disable (Reorder Tone): Sends a reorder tone to the caller. (However, a call through an LCOT card will ring
at the original destination while the caller hears a ringback tone.)
Enable: Redirects the call to an operator
Value Range
Disable, Enable
SMDR Format—Type
Selects the format of SMDR output.
Value Range
Type A: 80 digits without call charge information
Type B: 80 digits with call charge information
Type C: 120 digits
SMDR Format—Port
Selects the Serial Interface port that is used to output the SMDR data.
Value Range
None, LAN(TELNET), RS-232C
Value Range
No Print, 4–99
Value Range
0–95
Value Range
MM-DD-YY, DD-MM-YY, YY-MM-DD, YY-DD-MM
Value Range
12H, 24H
Value Range
No Print, Print
Value Range
No Print, Print
Value Range
No Print, Print
Value Range
No Print, Print
Value Range
No Print, Print
Value Range
No Print, Print
Value Range
No Print, Print
SMDR Options
Option—ARS Dial
Selects the type of the dialled number to be printed for a call with the ARS feature.
Value Range
Dial before ARS Modification: The user-dialled number
Dial after ARS Modification: The ARS modified number
Value Range
None, Number, Name, Name + Number
Value Range
None, Number, Name, Name + Number
Option—Secret Dial
Selects the printing format of calls with a secret dial. The secret dial conceals all or part of the dialled number.
Note that selecting Dial before ARS Modification in Option—ARS Dial on this screen indicates the dialled
numbers as dots regardless of this setting.
Value Range
Print "...." (Secret), Print Dialled Number
Option—Privacy Mode
Selects whether private dialling is enabled or disabled, and how many digits to hide when enabled.
To enable this setting, Print Information—Outgoing Call on the SMDR tab should be set to Print.
Value Range
Print Dialled Number: Disables private dialling; all dialled numbers are shown on SMDR.
No Print: No dialled number will be shown on SMDR.
Print "X", Print "XX", Print "XXX", Print "XXXX": The selected number of digits at the end of dialled telephone
numbers, and any additional digits dialled after connection, are shown on SMDR as "X".
Value Range
No Print, Print
Value Range
No Print, Print
Option—Caller ID Modification
Specifies whether Caller ID numbers are recorded on SMDR as received (before being modified by the PBX)
or after being modified.
Value Range
Before Modification, After Modification
Value Range
End of Call, Start and End of Call
Value Range
1–65535
LAN—SMDR Password
Specifies the password used to output the SMDR data via the LAN.
Value Range
Max. 10 characters
Value Range
CR + LF, CR
RS-232C
Communication—Baud Rate
Specifies the data transmission speed from the PBX to the printer or personal computer.
To ensure stable transmission, when changing this setting to 57600 or 115200 bps, set
Communication—Flow on this screen to Hardware.
Value Range
2400 bps, 4800 bps, 9600 bps, 19200 bps, 38400 bps, 57600 bps, 115200 bps
Communication—Parity Bit
Selects a parity bit code that indicates what type of parity is used to detect an error in the string of bits composing
a character.
Make an appropriate selection depending on the requirements of the printer or personal computer.
Value Range
None, Mark, Space, Even, Odd
Communication—Flow
Enables the hardware flow control.
Value Range
None, Hardware
Communication—NL Code
Specifies the NL (New Line) code for the printer or personal computer.
If the printer or personal computer automatically feeds lines with a carriage return, select CR (Carriage Return).
If not, select CR + LF (Line Feed).
Value Range
CR + LF, CR
Communication—Word Length
Specifies the number of bits in each byte of a character.
When connecting the Maintenance Console to the PBX using an RS-232C cable, assign the following values
to the Serial Interface (RS-232C) port of the PBX:
Word Length: 8 bit, Parity Bit: None, Stop Bit: 1 bit
Notice
Do not use the following combinations:
• Word Length: 8 bit, Parity Bit: Space, Stop Bit: 1 bit
• Word Length: 8 bit, Parity Bit: Mark, Stop Bit: 2 bit
• Word Length: 8 bit, Parity Bit: Space, Stop Bit: 2 bit
Value Range
7 bit, 8 bit
Communication—Stop Bit
Selects a stop bit code that indicates the end of a bit string which composes a character.
Select an appropriate value depending on the requirements of the printer or personal computer.
Value Range
1 bit, 2 bit
Value Range
Max. 30 characters
Maintenance
Local Alarm Display—Extension 1, Extension 2
Specifies the extension numbers of PTs that will be notified by the PBX about local alarms. When the PBX
detects a PBX error, the System Alarm button on the PT turns on red. When this button is pressed, the display
will show the error number, and the button light will turn off automatically.
Value Range
Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9)
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
0–23
Value Range
0–59
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
3-300 (sec)
Value Range
Disable, Enable
17.2 PBX Configuration—[9-2] Private Network—Network Data Transmission— Network MSW Data
Transmission for Centralised VM Feature—Data Re-transmission : Repeat Counter
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Password
Passwords authorise the user to programme the extension and the PBX by a PT or a personal computer.
Value Range
4–10 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #)
Note
CSs connected to legacy gateways can be used together with IP-CSs connected to the KX-NS1000 system.
CSs connected to legacy gateways must be registered to Air Synchronisation Group Number 1. Do not
register CSs connected to legacy gateways to any other Air Synchronisation Group Number.
Adding CSs
Follow the steps below to add CSs to the air synchronisation group.
1. Connect the CS to be registered to the network and, if necessary, the power supply.
2. Click Add.
A dialogue box will appear. Non-registered (available) CSs are displayed on the left.
3. Highlight CSs and click the right arrow to select them for addition.
4. Click OK.
Deleting CSs
Follow the steps below to delete CSs from the air synchronisation group.
1. Click Delete.
A dialogue box will appear. Registered CSs are displayed on the left.
2. Highlight CSs and click the right arrow to select them for deletion.
3. Click OK.
Value Range
1–16
Index
Indicates the CS number (reference only).
Value Range
1–16
CS Name
Indicates the name of the CS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Status
Indicates whether a certain CS is registered (reference only).
Value Range
-, Registered
CS Class
Specifies the classification of each CS. This parameter can only be modified when Connection on this screen
is set to OUS.
Value Range
Sync Master CS1, Sync Master CS2, Sync Slave CS
Primary CS—Index
Specifies the number of the primary CS.
Value Range
1–16
Primary CS—Slot
Indicates the slot position of the primary CS (reference only).
Value Range
Slot number
Primary CS—Port
Indicates the port number of the primary CS (reference only).
Value Range
Port number
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Secondary CS—Index
Specifies the number of the secondary CS.
Value Range
1–16
Secondary CS—Slot
Indicates the slot position of the secondary CS (reference only).
Value Range
Slot number
Secondary CS—Port
Indicates the port number of the secondary CS (reference only).
Value Range
Port number
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Note
Only KX-NS0154 IP-CSs can be added to a LAN synchronisation group.
Adding CSs
Follow the steps below to add CSs to the LAN synchronisation group.
1. Connect the CS to be registered to the network and, if necessary, the power supply.
2. Click Add.
A dialogue box will appear. Non-registered (available) CSs are displayed on the left.
3. Highlight CSs and click the right arrow to select them for addition.
4. Click OK.
Deleting CSs
Follow the steps below to delete CSs from the LAN synchronisation group.
1. Click Delete.
A dialogue box will appear. Registered CSs are displayed on the left.
2. Highlight CSs and click the right arrow to select them for deletion.
3. Click OK.
Note
You must specify a LAN synchronisation group number or an air synchronisation group number for each
IP-CS. Do not leave both of these settings unspecified.
Value Range
1–16
Value Range
239.0.0.0–239.255.255.255
Index
Indicates the CS number (reference only).
Value Range
1–64
CS Name
Indicates the name of the CS (reference only).
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Connection
Indicates the port status. To change the status of the port, click the desired cell in the column, and then select
INS or OUS for the port.
Value Range
INS: The port is in service.
OUS: The port is out of service.
Fault: The port is not communicating with the network.
Status
Indicates whether a certain CS is registered (reference only).
Value Range
-, Registered
CS Class
Specifies the classification of each CS. This parameter can only be modified when Connection on this screen
is set to OUS.
Value Range
Sync Master CS1, Sync Master CS2-1, Sync Master CS2-2, Sync Slave
Note
Sync Master CS1, Sync Master CS2-1, and Sync Master CS2-2 can each be assigned to only 1 IP-CS
in the same LAN synchronisation group.
MAC Address
Indicates the MAC address of the IP-CS (reference only).
Value Range
00:00:00:00:00:00–FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF
Current IP Address
Indicates the current IP address of the IP-CS (reference only).
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Value Range
1–16
Value Range
Multicast, Broadcast
Value Range
239.0.0.0–239.255.255.255
Value Range
0–8192 ns
Value Range
0–8192 ns
Value Range
0–256 s
Value Range
0–32768 ns
Value Range
0–4096 s
Value Range
2–168 hours
Shelf
Specifies the legacy gateway PBX shelf (reference only).
Value Range
2: Legacy-GW1
3: Legacy-GW2
Note
The number of available PFT cards and PFT ports depends on the model of the legacy gateway PBX. For
details, refer to the documentation for the legacy gateway PBX.
Value Range
Pair - 1–Pair - 12
Adding Mailboxes
1. Click the icon.
2. Edit each parameter in the "Mailbox" dialogue box.
3. Click OK.
A range of mailboxes can be added that use the default mailbox settings.
1. Click the icon.
2. Specify the range of mailboxes to add in From and To. Check Use the same number for Mailbox and
Extension to assign each mailbox to the same number extension.
3. Enter the number of mailboxes to create in Number Of Mailboxes:. To edit the default settings to be used
for each new mailbox, click Edit Default Mailboxes and make changes as necessary.
4. When all settings have been made, click OK to create the range of mailboxes.
Editing Mailboxes
To edit a specific mailbox, select the desired mailbox, then click the icon. You can also edit specific
parameters directly from the Mailbox Settings screen.
Deleting Mailboxes
1. Select a mailbox.
2. Click the icon.
3. Click OK.
Mailbox Number
Specifies the subscriber’s mailbox number. The maximum number of digits that can be used for mailbox
numbers is set in 24.4 UM Configuration—[5-4] System Parameters—Parameters—Mailbox— Mailbox
No. Max. Length (3-8), or when you initialise the system.
Note
The mailbox number can only be set when adding a mailbox; when editing a mailbox, you cannot change
the assigned mailbox number.
Value Range
2–[the value set in Mailbox No. Max. Length (3-8)] digits
Extension
Specifies the extension number of the mailbox’s subscriber. Any valid extension number including an Extension
Group number can be assigned.
Note
If an Extension Group number is assigned to a mailbox, all group members are able to access the
messages stored in the mailbox.
Value Range
2–8 digits
First Name
Specifies the first name of the subscriber. If there are non-alphabetical characters in the first 4 letters of the
first name, the mailbox is not included in the directory.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Last Name
Specifies the last name of the subscriber. If there are non-alphabetical characters in the first 4 letters of the
first name, the mailbox is not included in the directory.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Note
The mailbox number can only be set when adding a mailbox; when editing a mailbox, you cannot change
the assigned mailbox number.
Value Range
2–[the value set in Mailbox No. Max. Length (3-8)] digits
Extension
Specifies the extension number of the mailbox’s subscriber. Any valid extension number including an Extension
Group number can be assigned.
Note
If an Extension Group number is assigned to a mailbox, all group members are able to access the
messages stored in the mailbox.
Value Range
2–8 digits
3.2.2.20 Mailbox
First Name
Specifies the first name of the subscriber. If there are non-alphabetical characters in the first 4 letters of the
first name, the mailbox is not included in the directory.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Last Name
Specifies the last name of the subscriber. If there are non-alphabetical characters in the first 4 letters of the
first name, the mailbox is not included in the directory.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Mailbox Password
Specifies the password needed to access the mailbox. If a default password is programmed by an
administrator, that password will be assigned automatically when creating all mailboxes. Administrators can
change and delete the password.
To change a password for a mailbox:
1. On the Mailbox Parameters Screen, click Edit under Mailbox Password for the mailbox extension to
change.
2. In the window that appears, enter the new password and then enter it again to confirm it.
3. Click OK.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits
Note
This setting requires the installation of an Activation Key for Unified Messaging E-mail Notification
(KX-NSU2xx) for the number of users that will be accessing their UM mailbox using a client software
programme.
To change a password for a mailbox:
1. On the Mailbox Parameters Screen, click Edit under Mailbox Password (Message Client) for the mailbox
extension to change.
2. In the window that appears, enter the new password and then enter it again to confirm it.
3. Click OK.
Value Range
4–16 characters (A–Z, a–z, 0–9)
Note
• We recommend that parameters for each COS number be defined before assigning a Class of Service
(COS) to each mailbox or creating new mailboxes.
• COS No. 513 and 514 are assigned by default to the Message Manager and to the System Manager,
respectively. No other mailboxes can be assigned to COS No. 513 and 514.
Value Range
COS No. 1–514
Covering Extension
Forwards calls to a second extension when the first extension’s subscriber is not available to take the call. The
Covering Extension is one of the Incomplete Call Handling options that can be enabled or disabled by the
subscriber. The caller can also be transferred the Covering Extension by pressing [0] while a Personal Greeting
is being played, or while leaving a message.
Note
Extension Groups or Logical Extensions (extensions whose calls are set to always be directed their
mailboxes) cannot be assigned as covering extensions.
Value Range
1–8 digits
Interview Mailbox
Assigns an interview mailbox to the subscriber’s mailbox. In order for it to function properly, the interview
mailbox number must not be the same number as an existing mailbox and an existing mailbox group.
Note
Each caller’s replies to an interview session are saved as one message.
Value Range
2–[the value set in Mailbox No. Max. Length (3-8)] digits
Value Range
No, Yes
Note
This sequence has higher priority than the alternate extension transfer sequence specified in 24.4 UM
Configuration—[5-4] System Parameters—Parameters—PBX Parameters— PBX
Environment—Alternate Extension Transfer Sequence (Up to 16 digits / [0-9 * # D R F T X , ;]).
Value Range
System, Other
Note
When "System" is selected, the Unified Messaging system uses the extension transfer sequence
pre-programmed in 24.4 UM Configuration—[5-4] System Parameters—Parameters—PBX
Parameters— PBX Environment—Extension Transfer Sequence (Up to 16 digits / [0-9 * # D R F T
X , ;]).
Value Range
Enter a maximum of 16 characters consisting of 0–9, , # and special codes:
D: Disconnecting
F: Flash (Recall)
R: Ringback Tone Detection
T: Dial Tone Detection
, : Dial Pause (default 1 s)
; : Dial Pause (default 3 s)
X: Extension Dialling
0–9, , #: Dial Code
Note
When "System" is selected, the Unified Messaging system uses the time pre-programmed in 24.4 UM
Configuration—[5-4] System Parameters—Parameters—Dialling Parameters/MSW Notification—
Dialling Parameters—Call Transfer No Answer Time (10-60 s).
Value Range
System, Other (If "Other" is selected, specify 10–60 s)
Note
This setting can be changed by subscribers.
Value Range
None: Rings the subscriber’s extension.
Call blocking: Handles the call according to the Incomplete Call Handling for No Answer setting for the
subscriber’s extension. The subscriber’s extension will not ring.
Call screening: The caller is prompted to record his or her name. The Unified Messaging system then calls
the subscriber and plays back the caller name. The subscriber can choose whether to answer the call.
Intercom Paging: Pages the subscriber by intercom.
Transfer to Mailbox: Transfers the caller to the mailbox.
Transfer to specified Custom Service Menu: Transfers the caller to the specified Custom Service.
Transfer to specified telephone number 1–5: Transfers the caller to one of the specified telephone numbers
in numerical order of priority.
Note
• This setting can be changed by subscribers.
• More than one option can be selected.
Value Range
Leave a Message: Allows the caller to record a message.
Transfer to a covering extension: Transfers the caller to a covering extension.
Page the mailbox owner by intercom paging: Pages the subscriber by intercom.
Transfer to operator: Transfers the caller to an operator.
Return to top menu: Lets the caller return to top menu and try another extension.
Transfer to specified Custom Service Menu: Transfers the caller to the specified Custom Service.
Note
• This setting can be changed by subscribers.
• More than one option can be selected.
Value Range
Leave a Message: Allows the caller to record a message.
Transfer to a covering extension: Transfers the caller to a covering extension.
Page the mailbox owner by intercom paging: Pages the subscriber by intercom.
Transfer to operator: Transfers the caller to an operator.
Return to top menu: Lets the caller return to top menu and try another extension.
Transfer to specified Custom Service Menu: Transfers the caller to the specified Custom Service.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Notification Parameters
The Unified Messaging system is able to notify a subscriber when a new message is recorded in his or her
mailbox. There are 3 methods the system can use for notification:
– Lighting the Message Waiting Lamp on the subscriber’s extension telephone.
– Calling a pre-programmed device (external telephone, etc.). A maximum of 3 devices (Device 1, 2, 3) can
be programmed per mailbox.
– Sending an e-mail to a designated address.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Telephone Device
Specifies the Message Waiting Notification schedule for each device. The following parameters can be
specified for devices 1, 2, and 3. Click Edit for the extension to change, set Device Notification for
Unreceived Message to "Yes", and programme the settings, then click OK to finish.
Value Range
All Messages, Voice Messages, Fax Messages
Value Range
Yes, No
Note
When the Unified Messaging system calls a trunk via the PRI card, be sure to add "#" after the telephone
number (1112223333 in the example here): 9P1112223333#PP123PP456PPX# (P: Dial Pause)
Value Range
Max. 32 digits consisting of 0–9, , # and special codes:
, : Dial Pause (default 1 s)
; : Dial Pause (default 3 s)
T: Dial Tone Detection
X: Callback Number Entry Code
0–9, , #: Dial Code
Value Range
0–9 times
Value Range
0–120 min
Value Range
1–120 min
Value Range
0–120 min
Value Range
0–120 min
Value Range
Max. 64 characters
Note
• This setting requires the installation of an Activation Key for Unified Messaging E-mail Notification
(KX-NSU2xx) for the number of users that will be accessing their UM mailbox using a client software
programme.
• In the mailbox user’s profile (See 8.1 Users—User Profiles) if Email 1–3 is input in the Contact tab,
and Automatic copy to UM message notification is checked, the e-mail address(es) will be copied
to this setting and overwrite any previously input data here.
Value Range
Max. 128 characters
Value Range
All Messages, Voice Messages, Fax Messages
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Title-ID-Name, Title-Name-ID, ID-Title-Name, Name-Title-ID, ID-Name-Title, Name-ID-Title
Value Range
Max. 30 characters
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (0–9, , #)
Value Range
0–120 min
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Yes, No
Continuously: The device is called whenever a message is recorded in the mailbox. If Only Urgent
Messages is set to "Yes", the device is called whenever an urgent message is recorded in the mailbox.
Scheduled: The selected device is called only during the selected times.
Value Range
No, Yes
Note
If set to "Selective" and the receiver uses a rotary telephone, the no-entry selection is specified by 22.1 UM
Configuration—[3-1] UM Extension / Trunk Service—Service Group— Day, Night, Lunch, and
Break Mode - Prompt for No DTMF Input Callers.
Value Range
Primary, Selective, Guidance No. 1–8
Value Range
No, Yes
Note
A Mailbox Group number cannot be specified as a destination.
Value Range
2–[the value set in Mailbox No. Max. Length (3-8)] digits
Note
The delay time must be shorter than the New Message Retention Time, or else messages will be deleted
before being forwarded.
Value Range
00:00–99:59
Value Range
All Messages, Voice Messages, Fax Messages
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Copy, Move
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Date and time
Note
• These settings can be changed by subscribers.
• Make sure to add a trunk access number when you store an outside telephone number.
• When the Unified Messaging system calls a trunk via the PRI card, be sure to add "#" after the telephone
number (1112223333 in the example here): 9P1112223333#PP123PP456PPX# (P: Dial Pause)
Follow the steps below to edit a Personal Custom Service.
1. Click Edit.
2. For each Key, specify an Assigned Operation.
3. For each Assigned Operation that is specified, specify a Value
4. Click OK when finished.
Assigned Operation
• Transfer to specified mailbox: Allow the caller to leave messages in a specified mailbox.
• Transfer to specified extension: Transfers the caller to a specified extension.
• Transfer to Voice Mail Service: Allows the caller to access Voice Mail Service.
• Transfer to Automated Attendant Service: Allows the caller to access Automated Attendant Service.
• Transfer to specified Custom Service Menu: Transfers the caller to the Custom Service specified here.
• Transfer to operator: Connects the caller to an operator.
• Transfer to outside (specified number): Transfers the caller to a specified outside telephone number.
Enter a number from the Outside Numbers list (1–4).
• Page the party: Pages the subscriber.
• Repeat greeting: Repeats the greeting.
• None: No operation assigned.
Value Range
• Transfer to specified mailbox: 2–[the value set in Mailbox No. Max. Length (3-8)] digits
• Transfer to specified extension: 2–8 digits
• Transfer to specified Custom Service Menu: 1–200
• Transfer to outside (specified number): Outside Number 1–4
Outside Numbers
Specifies the outside telephone numbers that can be used for the "Transfer to outside (specified number)"
operation in the Custom Service settings. Click OK when finished.
Value Range
Outside Number #1–#4: Max. 32 digits consisting of 0–9, , #, and special codes
T: Dial Tone Detection
, : Dial Pause (default 1 s)
; : Dial Pause (default 3 s)
0–9, , #: Dial Code
Value Range
Recording: The caller will be guided to leave a message.
Disconnect (All Day): The line will be disconnected, regardless of the time of day.
Disconnect (Only After Hours): The line will be disconnected only after hours.
Value Range
0–10 s
Value Range
Max. 32 characters
Note
Class of Service programming determines if the subscriber is able to use this feature.
Value Range
Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9 and " ")
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Notice
If this is set to "No", ensure that unauthorised third-parties are not allowed access to that mailbox.
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Max. 20 digits
Value Range
Yes, No
Notice
If this is set to "No", ensure that unauthorised third-parties are not allowed access to that mailbox using
the number assigned to Auto Login Caller ID 1 or Auto Login Caller ID 2.
Value Range
Max. 20 digits
Value Range
1–96
Value Range
Yes, No
Notice
If this is set to "No", ensure that unauthorised third-parties are not allowed access to any extensions using
the specified trunk group number.
Value Range
Disable: Disables the Toll Saver feature.
DID: Toll Saver functions when the system receives the pre-programmed DID number from the PBX.
Caller ID: Toll Saver functions when Caller ID information is received that matches one of the pre-programmed
numbers (Caller ID 1 or 2).
Trunk: Toll Saver functions when the system receives a call on the pre-programmed trunk.
Note
Automatic Login must be enabled for extensions to use this feature.
Value Range
Record No Answer Greeting: The subscriber can record the greeting played when there is no answer.
Record Busy Greeting: The subscriber can record the greeting played when their extension is busy.
Record After Hours Greeting: The subscriber can record the greeting played when the system is in night
mode.
Record Temporary Greeting: The subscriber can record a greeting that is used exclusively until the subscriber
disables it.
Change Day Main Menu: The subscriber can change the Day Main Menu greeting. Only the Message
Manager may make this change.
Change Night Main Menu: The subscriber can change the Night Main Menu greeting. Only the Message
Manager may make this change.
Change Emergency Greeting: The subscriber can change the Emergency Greeting. Only the Message
Manager may make this change.
Fax Options
Automatic Delivery Status
Specifies whether Automatic Delivery is used to automatically forward received faxes to a specified fax
machine.
Value Range
No, Yes
Value Range
Max. 32 digits consisting of 0–9, , # and special codes:
, : Dial Pause (default 1 s)
; : Dial Pause (default 3 s)
T: Dial Tone Detection
X: Callback Number Entry Code
0–9, , #: Dial Code
Value Range
Delete Automatically, Save as Old, Save as New
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Transfer to Fax Extension: Transfers the fax to a specified fax extension.
Receive in GDM: The fax is redirected to the general delivery mailbox.
No Receiving: The fax message is not received and the system goes on hook.
Note
If no fax extension is specified but Transfer to Fax Extension is selected, the system will go on hook.
Value Range
English (US), English (UK), French, CA French, German, Swedish, Italian, Dutch, Portuguese, Spanish,
Norwegian, Danish, Polish, Hungarian, Czech, Russian, Greek, Ukrainian
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
English, French, German, Italian, Dutch, Spanish, Portuguese, Russian
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Note
In Re-create all mailboxes mode, all voice data is deleted, including data that is recorded in mailboxes.
It is strongly recommended that you backup the voice data that has been recorded in mailboxes.
Backed up voice data can be restored as sound data on a PC by using special software tools. For details,
consult your dealer.
Value Range
Create mailboxes
Re-create all mailboxes
Value Range
Create mailboxes to the UM group of the PBX where extensions belong to (default)
Create mailboxes to the specified UM group
(You can select site number from 1-16)
General
Class Of Service Name
Specifies the Class of Service’s name.
Value Range
Max. 32 characters
Prompt Mode
Specifies the language used for system prompts played for the subscriber during Subscriber Service. If set to
"Primary", the default language which is selected from all installed languages will be used.
Value Range
Primary, Guidance No. 1–8
Directory Listing
If set to "Yes", the subscriber’s name and extension number will be listed in the directory (Dialling by Name).
Note
This setting is not available for COS 514 (System Manager).
Value Range
No, Yes
Tutorial
The tutorial is a series of voice prompts for setting up the mailbox that is played to subscribers when they first
log in to their mailbox. This item specifies if subscribers in the Class of Service hear a normal tutorial, a
simplified tutorial, or no tutorial when they first log in to their mailbox.
In the tutorial, subscribers are asked to provide:
– A password
– The mailbox owner’s name
– Personal Greetings (No Answer Greeting, Busy Signal Greeting, After Hours Greeting)
Value Range
Normal: A navigation voice menu is given for each step.
Simplified: Only direct prompts are given for making each setting. For Personal Greetings, only a No Answer
Greeting can be set.
None: No tutorial is played and settings for the mailbox must be made manually.
Call-through Service
Specifies if subscribers in the Class of Service can make outside calls by accessing the subscriber service
menu (from an outside telephone) and dialling an outside destination.
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Yes, No
E-mail Option
Specifies if subscribers in the Class of Service can receive notifications by e-mail when they have a new
message waiting.
Value Range
Yes, No
Fax Option
Specifies if subscribers in the Class of Service can use the fax functions of the Unified Messaging system,
such as sending and receiving faxes.
Value Range
Yes, No
Desktop Messaging
Specifies if subscribers in the Class of Service can access the contents of their mailboxes with an e-mail
application using IMAP. This includes the Microsoft Outlook® e-mail client plug-in.
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Yes, No
Value Range
Yes, No
Mailbox
Personal Greeting Length (s)
Defines the maximum length (in seconds) of Personal Greetings for subscribers in the Class of Service.
Note
This setting is not available for COS 513 (Message Manager) and COS 514 (System Manager).
Value Range
1–360 s
Value Range
Unlimited, Limited
Value Range
1–60 min
Value Range
Unlimited, Limited
Value Range
1–600 min
Value Range
Unlimited, Limited
Value Range
1–30 days
Value Range
Unlimited, Limited
Value Range
1–30 days
Value Range
LIFO: Messages are retrieved starting with the most recent (Last In First Out).
FIFO: Messages are retrieved starting with the oldest (First In First Out).
Note
This setting is not available for COS 513 (Message Manager) and COS 514 (System Manager).
Value Range
None, Other
Value Range
1–30
Value Range
Before: The system announces the message envelope before playing the recorded message.
After: The system announces the message envelope after playing the recorded message.
Require: The system announces the message envelope when the user presses the appropriate dial key as
prompted when listening to the message.
Value Range
None, Other
Value Range
1–60 min
Note
This setting is not available for COS 513 (Message Manager) and COS 514 (System Manager).
Value Range
No, Yes
Note
This setting is not available for COS 514 (System Manager).
Value Range
No, Yes
Value Range
No, Yes
Note
This setting is not available for COS 513 (Message Manager) and COS 514 (System Manager).
Value Range
No, Yes
Caller ID Callback
If set to "Yes", subscribers in the Class of Service can call the caller back while listening to the caller’s message
(Caller ID Callback).
Value Range
No, Yes
Auto Receipt
If set to "Yes", subscribers in the Class of Service can request to receive confirmation when their message has
been listened to by the message recipient.
Value Range
No, Yes
Value Range
No, Yes
Value Range
No, Yes
Value Range
No, Yes
Value Range
No, Yes
Note
If "Caller ID Callback" is set to "Yes", Caller ID numbers will be announced regardless of this setting (see
21.1 UM Configuration—[2] Class of Service—Mailbox— Caller ID Callback).
Value Range
No, Yes
Value Range
No, Yes
Value Range
No, Yes
Value Range
Disable, Other
Value Range
5–200 days
Value Range
Save as Old, Save as New
Call Transfer
Intercom Paging Group
Specifies the Intercom Paging group number available to subscribers in the Class of Service.
Note
This setting is not available for COS 513 (Message Manager).
Value Range
1–32
Note
This setting is not available for COS 513 (Message Manager).
Value Range
No, Yes
Caller ID Screen
If set to "Yes", subscribers in the Class of Service can hear the pre-recorded names of callers when they receive
calls (Caller ID Screening).
Note
This setting is not available for COS 513 (Message Manager).
Value Range
No, Yes
Notify of Transfer
If set to "Yes", subscribers in the Class of Service will hear "You have a call." when they answer transferred
calls.
Value Range
No, Yes
Note
This setting is not available for COS 513 (Message Manager).
Value Range
No, Yes
Hospitality Mode
Hospitality Mode
Specifies whether subscribers in the Class of Service have the Hospitality Mode enabled. (For use with
extensions for hotel rooms, etc.) This setting must be set to "Yes" to enable other Hospitality Mode settings.
When this item is set to "Yes", only the following options are made available to subscribers:
• Listen to Messages
• Password
• Personal Greetings
• Owner Name
Value Range
No, Yes
Password
Specifies if subscribers in the Class of Service are given a voice prompt selection to change their password
when accessing their mailbox.
Value Range
No, Yes
Personal Greeting
Specifies if subscribers in the Class of Service are given a voice prompt selection to change their Personal
Greeting when accessing their mailbox.
Note
For the Personal Greeting of subscribers in a Class of Service with Hospitality mode enabled, only No
Answer and Busy greetings can be set.
Value Range
No, Yes
Owner Name
Specifies if subscribers in the Class of Service are given a voice prompt selection to change the mailbox
owner’s name when accessing their mailbox.
Value Range
No, Yes
Value Range
No, Yes
Value Range
No, Yes
Value Range
No, Yes
Day, Night, Lunch, and Break Mode - Company Greeting No. (Selection)
Specifies the greeting to be heard by callers, the System Greeting, another message, or no greeting. The
System Greeting is "Good morning/Good afternoon/Good evening. Welcome to the Unified Messaging
System.". Each call service can have its own setting.
Value Range
None, System, Other
Day, Night, Lunch, and Break Mode - Company Greeting No. (Other)
Specifies the number of the greeting message to use when "Other" is specified for the greeting selection.
Value Range
1–32
Value Range
Voice Mail Service, Automated Attendant, Interview Mailbox, Custom Service, Fax Service, Transfer to Mailbox
Day, Night, Lunch, and Break Mode - Incoming Call Service Parameter
Specifies the parameter for the type of Incoming Call Service specified. This is disabled if "Voice Mail
Service" or "Automated Attendant" is selected for the Incoming Call Service.
Value Range
Interview Mailbox: Mailbox number
Custom Service: Custom Service number (1–200)
Fax Service: Mailbox number
Transfer to Mailbox: Mailbox number
Note
Mailbox numbers are between 2 digits and the value set in Mailbox No. Max. Length (3-8).
Day, Night, Lunch, and Break Mode - Incoming Call Service Prompt
Specifies the language of system prompts used by this call service. If set to "Primary", the default language
which is selected from all installed languages will be used. When set to "Selective", the caller can select the
language of his or her choice, provided the System Administrator or the Message Manager has recorded the
Multilingual Selection Menu. To specify a Prompt Selection Number, see 24.4 UM Configuration—[5-4]
System Parameters—Parameters—Prompt Setting.
Note
If "Selective" is specified, you will need to select a prompt available for callers that cannot input DTMF
signals, such as rotary phone callers. See "Prompt for No DTMF Input Callers" below.
Value Range
Primary, Selective, Guidance No. 1–8
Day, Night, Lunch, and Break Mode - Prompt for No DTMF Input Callers
Specifies which language is used when a caller cannot enter any digits to select a language after the Multilingual
Selection Menu has been played. If set to "Primary", the default language which is selected from all installed
languages will be used.
Value Range
Primary, Guidance No. 1–8
Value Range
0–60 s
Note
• If Automatic Login or Holiday Service is used, these will take priority over Caller ID Call Routing settings.
Also note that Caller ID Call Routing takes priority over the Trunk Service and Port Service.
• Received Caller ID/PIN numbers are searched for in each service setting table in order from the first
registered number to last. When programming Caller ID/PIN routing, note the order of registration, and
remember that wild card entries should be entered after any specific routing entries.
Caller-ID Mode
Caller ID No. (Selection)
Specifies the Caller ID number setting so that callers are automatically forwarded to a pre-programmed
destination.
Value Range
Private, Out of Area, Long Distance, Others
Value Range
0–9, (Max. 20 digits)
Description
Specifies a name and/or description of the Caller ID number.
Note
When no data is specified in this parameter, the caller’s name will be automatically entered here if the
caller’s name is received from the telephone company.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
None: disables this feature.
Custom Service Menu: forwards callers to the specified Custom Service menu.
Extension: forwards callers to the specified extension.
Mailbox: forwards callers to the specified mailbox.
Fax Service: Forwards callers to the fax service.
PIN Mode
PIN No.
Specifies a PIN number (or range of PIN numbers using the wild card, " ") for callers from a specific number
or range of numbers that are to be automatically forwarded to a pre-programmed destination. For more
information on using " " with pin numbers, refer to Wild card input for Caller IDs/PINs.
Value Range
0–9, (Max. 20 digits)
Description
Specifies a name and/or description of the PIN number.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Value Range
None: disables this feature.
Custom Service Menu: forwards callers to the specified Custom Service menu.
Extension: forwards callers to the specified extension.
Mailbox: forwards callers to the specified mailbox.
Fax Service: Forwards callers to the fax service.
Value Range
0–20 s
Value Range
1–5 times
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Operator Service
When operator calls are made, calls are connected to the lowest-numbered operator that is available. To
enable/disable the operator setting for each time mode, check/uncheck it.
Note
• The extension assigned as Operator 1 for day mode is automatically designated as the Message
Manager. Because the extension number assigned for Operator Service No. 1 in the Day Mode is for
the Message Manager, you cannot assign this extension to any other mailbox.
• Extensions assigned as operators can be called by dialling [0], however, when setting features such
as Message Waiting Notification and Remote Call Forwarding, the extension number (not "0") must be
specified.
Value Range
Operator Service for Day, Operator Service for Night, Operator Service for Lunch, Operator Service for Break
Note
• The default extension number of Operator 1 in day mode cannot be used with the Message Waiting
Notification Lamp feature.
• Since the extension number assigned as Operator Service No. 1 for Day is automatically designated
as the Message Manager (mailbox number 998), do not assign an individual mailbox to this extension
number. Assigning an individual mailbox to this extension will result in the following operations:
– Any messages recorded for the extension will be sent to the Message Manager mailbox instead of
the extension’s assigned mailbox.
– The Message Manager COS (513) will be applied to call transfers, etc., instead of the COS of the
assigned mailbox.
– If the extension user tries to access their mailbox using the Automatic Login feature, the user will
access the Message Manager mailbox instead of the assigned mailbox.
Value Range
1–8 digits
Value Range
2–8 digits
Value Range
Hold: Automatically places the caller on hold and the operator is called again.
No Answer Coverage: Offers the option specified by the No Answer Coverage Mode to the caller.
Call Waiting: Signals the operator when another call is waiting using the Call Waiting feature of PBX.
Disconnect Message: Disconnects the caller after playing "Thank you for calling".
Value Range
Caller Select: Allows the caller to leave a message or call another extension. In the following cases, the caller
cannot call another extension:
a. No input to Automated Attendant.
b. When the No DTMF Input Operation setting of a Custom Service is set to "Operator".
Leave Message: Instructs the caller to leave a message in the operator’s mailbox.
Disconnect Message: Disconnects the caller after playing "Thank you for calling.".
Next Operator: Transfers the caller to the next operator.
Note
• This time applies to Operator 1, 2, and 3.
• If more than one operator is assigned, we recommend setting this value to 15 s.
Value Range
10–60 s
Value Range
Enable (checked), Disable (unchecked)
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
1–30 s
Alternate Extension
Specifies extensions that require a different transfer sequence than normal. Calls to these extensions will be
transferred according with the setting for 24.4 UM Configuration—[5-4] System
Parameters—Parameters— PBX Environment—Alternate Extension Transfer Sequence (Up to 16
digits / [0-9 * # D R F T X , ;]).Click Edit and follow the steps below to edit an alternate extension.
Note
Extension Groups and Logical Extensions cannot be assigned.
Value Range
Max. 32 extensions (max. 5 digits per extension)
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Transfer immediately, Do not transfer immediately
Value Range
G.D.M.: The caller is transferred to the General Delivery Mailbox.
Operator: The caller is transferred to an operator.
Mailbox: The caller is transferred to the designated mailbox extension.
Extension: The caller is transferred to the designated extension.
No DTMF Input Call Coverage for Day, Night, Lunch, and Break (Parameter)
Specifies the transfer destination if "Mailbox" or "Extension" is selected for No DTMF Input Call Coverage
for Day, Night, Lunch, and Break (Selection).
Value Range
2–8 digits (for extensions)
2–[the value set in Mailbox No. Max. Length (3-8)] digits (for mailboxes)
Name Entry
Number of Digits to Entry Name (3-4 digits)
Specifies the number of digits (letters) that must be entered when using the Dial by Name feature, which allows
callers to connect themselves with the desired party by entering the first 3 or 4 letters of the party’s name.
Value Range
3–4 digits
Value Range
1–10 s
Key Mode
Specifies the standard used for keypad text entry. If set to use the North American Standard, press [7] for
"Q" and [9] for "Z", If set to use the Australasian Standard, press [1] for "Q" and "Z".
Value Range
North American Standard, Australasian Standard
Value Range
Last, First, Both
Toll Saver
Delayed Answer Time for New Message (5-60 s)
Specifies the time period before the system answers the call when there are new messages.
Value Range
5–60 s
Value Range
5–60 s
Description
The information typed in this field is for reference only.
Value Range
Max. 32 characters
Prompt Mode
Specifies the language for prompts used by this Custom Service.
Note
• This parameter overrides a set "Incoming Call Service Prompt".
• If "Primary" is selected, the default language which is selected from all installed languages will be used.
• If "None" is selected, the prompt mode of previous process will be continued, or "Primary" language
will be selected.
Value Range
None, Primary, Guidance No. 1-8
Value Range
1–3 times
Note
If you only need to allow callers to dial single-digit Custom Service option numbers, set this parameter to
"No". When set to a value other than "No", the system always waits for the amount determined by the Wait
for Second Digit (1-5 s) setting before handling the call. This will cause a delay between the time the
caller dials a single-digit Custom Service option number and when the call is actually handled.
Value Range
Extn: enables callers to be transferred directly to their intended party by dialling the extension number.
Mbx: enables callers to leave messages in a mailbox by entering the mailbox number.
PIN: enables callers to be transferred directly to the specified party according to the setting for PIN Call Routing
Service by dialling a PIN.
No: disables extension transfer and mailbox transfer; only 1-digit entries will function (following the Custom
Service menu)
Value Range
0–10 s
Value Range
1–5 s
Value Range
Trf to Mbx: Allows the caller to leave messages in a specified mailbox.
Trf to Ext: Transfers the caller to a specified extension.
Operator: Connects the caller to an operator.
Trf to Out: Transfers the caller to a specified outside telephone number. Enter the trunk access number of the
PBX then the destination telephone number.
Exit: Plays the Custom Service exit prompt and disconnects the caller.
Prev Menu: Returns the caller to the previous menu (if there was a previous menu).
CS: Transfers the caller to the Custom Service specified here.
Fax Service: Forwards callers to the fax service.
Value Range
Trf to Mbx: Allows the caller to leave messages in a specified mailbox.
Trf to Ext: Transfers the caller to a specified extension.
Operator: Connects the caller to an operator.
Trf to Out: Transfers the caller to a specified outside telephone number. Enter the trunk access number of the
PBX then the destination telephone number.
Exit: Plays the Custom Service exit prompt and disconnects the caller.
Prev Menu: Returns the caller to the previous menu (not available if there was no previous menu).
CS: Transfers the caller to the Custom Service specified here.
VM Serv: Allows the caller to access Voice Mail Service.
Call Trf Serv: Allows the caller to access Automated Attendant Service.
Subscriber Serv: Allows the caller to access the Subscriber Service. The caller needs to press the assigned
key followed by the mailbox number that he or she wants to log in. If this option is enabled, it is strongly
recommended that each subscriber set a password for his or her mailbox; this will prevent unauthorised callers
from accidentally or intentionally accessing subscribers’ mailboxes.
Dial by Name: Requests the caller to enter the first 3 or 4 letters of a first or last name of the person the caller
wishes to reach, then transfers the caller to the corresponding extension.
Repeat Menu: Repeats the Custom Service menu.
Main Menu: Returns the caller to the Custom Service top menu.
Trf to Fax Extn: Allows the caller to send fax messages to an extension specified as the fax extension.
List All Names: The system will announce the names and extensions numbers of all subscribers (except those
whose Class of Service Directory Listing parameter is set to "No").
Fax Service: Forwards callers to the fax service.
None: No operation assigned.
Description
The information typed in this field is for reference only.
Value Range
Max. 32 characters
Outside:
Allows you to specify an operation that is enabled on all other dates not included in the set periods.
Value Range
Period 1–5:
Name: Max. 16 characters
From/To: Select the check box, and then click the input field to select a date (month and day) from the calendar.
You can specify a beginning date (From), ending date (To), or both for each period.
Assigned Operation: Trf to Mbx, Trf to Ext, Operator, Trf to Out, Exit, Prev Menu, CS, VM Serv, Call Trf Serv,
Subscriber Serv, Dial by Name, Repeat Menu, Main Menu, Trf to Fax Extn, List All Names, Fax Service,
None (see 23.3.1 UM Configuration—[4-3] Service Settings—Custom Service—Menu & Transfer—
Key – Assigned Operation: 0–9, *, #)
Outside:
Name: Max. 16 characters
Assigned Operation: Trf to Mbx, Trf to Ext, Operator, Trf to Out, Exit, Prev Menu, CS, VM Serv, Call Trf Serv,
Subscriber Serv, Dial by Name, Repeat Menu, Main Menu, Trf to Fax Extn, List All Names, Fax Service,
None (see 23.3.1 UM Configuration—[4-3] Service Settings—Custom Service—Menu & Transfer—
Key – Assigned Operation: 0–9, *, #)
Description
The information typed in this field is for reference only.
Value Range
Max. 32 characters
Note
When the start time is specified and the end time is "None", the period will end at "00:00".
Outside:
Allows you to specify an operation that is enabled for all other times not included in the set time periods.
Value Range
Period 1–5:
Name: Max. 16 characters
From/To: Select the check box, click the input field, and then specify a time (hour and minute). You can specify
a beginning time (From), ending time (To), or both for each period.
Assigned Operation: Trf to Mbx, Trf to Ext, Operator, Trf to Out, Exit, Prev Menu, CS, VM Serv, Call Trf Serv,
Subscriber Serv, Dial by Name, Repeat Menu, Main Menu, Trf to Fax Extn, List All Names, Fax Service,
None (see 23.3.1 UM Configuration—[4-3] Service Settings—Custom Service—Menu & Transfer—
Key – Assigned Operation: 0–9, *, #)
Outside:
Name: Max. 16 characters
Assigned Operation: Trf to Mbx, Trf to Ext, Operator, Trf to Out, Exit, Prev Menu, CS, VM Serv, Call Trf Serv,
Subscriber Serv, Dial by Name, Repeat Menu, Main Menu, Trf to Fax Extn, List All Names, Fax Service,
None (see 23.3.1 UM Configuration—[4-3] Service Settings—Custom Service—Menu & Transfer—
Key – Assigned Operation: 0–9, *, #)
Description
The information typed in this field is for reference only.
Value Range
Max. 32 characters
Sunday–Saturday, Holiday
Specifies a service for each day of the week and for all holidays.
Note
If an operation is assigned to "Holiday" here, either one of the following settings is required in order to
activate the operation for the "Holiday" Custom Service:
a. In the Holiday Table, select "Custom Service Menu" and specify the number of this Date
Control—"Holiday" Custom Service, or the number of its higher layered Custom Service (see 23.4 UM
Configuration—[4-4] Service Settings—Holiday Table).
b. Assign the desired Date Control—"Holiday" Custom Service or its higher layered Custom Service to
the desired Port/Trunk (see 22.1 UM Configuration—[3-1] UM Extension / Trunk Service—Service
Group).
For "Port Affected/Trunk Affected", exclude the Port/Trunk numbers that are assigned to the Date
Control—"Holiday" Custom Service or the number of its higher layered Custom Service.
Value Range
Assigned Operation: Trf to Mbx, Trf to Ext, Operator, Trf to Out, Exit, Prev Menu, CS, VM Serv, Call Trf Serv,
Subscriber Serv, Dial by Name, Repeat Menu, Main Menu, Trf to Fax Extn, List All Names, Fax Service,
None (see 23.3.1 UM Configuration—[4-3] Service Settings—Custom Service—Menu & Transfer—
Key – Assigned Operation: 0–9, *, #)
Description
The information typed in this field is for reference only.
Value Range
Max. 32 characters
Value Range
1–3 times
Value Range
1–10 s
Value Range
1–10 times
Value Range
Trf to Mbx, Trf to Ext, Operator, Trf to Out, Exit, Prev Menu, CS, Fax Service (see 23.3.1 UM
Configuration—[4-3] Service Settings—Custom Service—Menu & Transfer— No DTMF Input
Operation)
Entry Failure
Determines what operation is activated when a caller enters an invalid password X times. (X= the value set
for Maximum Number of Invalid Entry (1-10))
Value Range
Trf to Mbx, Trf to Ext, Operator, Trf to Out, Exit, Prev Menu, CS, VM Serv, Call Trf Serv, Subscriber Serv, Dial
by Name, Repeat Menu, Main Menu, Trf to Fax Extn, List All Names, Fax Service (see 23.3.1 UM
Configuration—[4-3] Service Settings—Custom Service—Menu & Transfer— Key – Assigned
Operation: 0–9, *, #)
Pass1–5, Cancel
Pass1–5:
Specifies a password and an operation for the specified password.
Cancel:
Determines the operation that is activated when a caller presses "#" to cancel password entry.
Value Range
Pass1–5:
Password: Max. 12 digits
Assigned Operation: Trf to Mbx, Trf to Ext, Operator, Trf to Out, Exit, Prev Menu, CS, VM Serv, Call Trf Serv,
Subscriber Serv, Dial by Name, Repeat Menu, Main Menu, Trf to Fax Extn, List All Names, Fax Service,
None (see 23.3.1 UM Configuration—[4-3] Service Settings—Custom Service—Menu & Transfer—
Key – Assigned Operation: 0–9, *, #)
Cancel:
Assigned Operation: Trf to Mbx, Trf to Ext, Operator, Trf to Out, Exit, Prev Menu, CS, VM Serv, Call Trf Serv,
Subscriber Serv, Dial by Name, Repeat Menu, Main Menu, Trf to Fax Extn, List All Names, Fax Service,
None (see 23.3.1 UM Configuration—[4-3] Service Settings—Custom Service—Menu & Transfer—
Key – Assigned Operation: 0–9, *, #)
Setting
Enables the setting of the holiday. This setting synchronises with the PBX’s Holiday Table.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Name of Holiday
Specifies the name of the holiday setting for later reference.
Value Range
Max. 32 Characters
Value Range
Month and Day
Start Time
Specifies the time of day on the specified date at which to begin the holiday service. Click the cell to display
an array of hours and minutes. Select an hour of the day and a minute of the hour to set the time.
Value Range
Hour and Minute
Value Range
Month and Day
End Time
Specifies the time of day on the specified date at which to end the holiday service. Click the cell to display an
array of hours and minutes. Select an hour of the day and a minute of the hour to set the time.
Value Range
Hour and Minute
Retain Holiday
If "Yes" is selected, the holiday will not end regardless of the end time setting. To end the holiday setting when
"Yes" is selected and the end time has already passed, set Setting to "Disable" or re-programme the settings
for the holiday.
Value Range
No, Yes
Value Range
None (do not playback): No greeting is heard.
No. 1–32: The selected company greeting is heard.
System Greeting: The following greeting is heard: "Good morning/Good afternoon/Good evening. Welcome
to the Unified Messaging System".
Service
One of 4 incoming call services (Voice Mail, Automated Attendant, Interview, or Custom Service) can be
assigned to each holiday. After a greeting is played (if specified), the call will be transferred to the selected
service.
Value Range
Voice Mail Service: The caller is transferred to the Voice Mail Service.
Automated Attendant Service: The caller is transferred to the Automated Attendant Service.
Interview Mailbox: The caller is transferred to an Interview Mailbox.
Custom Service Menu: The caller is transferred to a Custom Service Menu.
Value Range
Interview Mailbox number, Custom Service number
Trunk Affected
Specify which trunks will be subject to the holiday setting. Click Edit, and then select the check boxes for the
trunks to be subject to the holiday setting, or select the All check box to apply the holiday to all trunks. Click
OK to finish.
Value Range
Trunk No. 1–96, All
Port Affected
Specify which UM ports will be subject to the holiday setting. Click Edit, and then select the check boxes for
the UM ports to be subject to the holiday setting, or select the All check box to apply the holiday to all UM
ports. Click OK to finish.
Value Range
Port No. 1–24, All
Deleting Mailboxes
1. Select a mailbox group.
2. Click the icon.
3. Click Yes.
Adding Mailboxes to a Group
1. In the Group Members column, click the Edit button of the group to add mailboxes to.
2. In the Subscribers To Add column, select the check boxes for the mailbox numbers to add to the group.
3. Click Add.
4. Click OK.
5. Click OK.
Recording a Name for the Group in the Edit Mailbox Group dialogue box
1. Select the desired Mailbox Group and click the icon.
Note
Before you can record, confirm that there is at least 1 member in the group and that you have clicked
Apply since adding members to the group.
2. Select "Record from extension" or "Import from recorded file". When "Record from extension" is selected:
1. Specify the extension number of the telephone used for recording, then click Connect.
2. When the specified extension rings, go off-hook.
3. Click Record, Play, or Stop to record or play a voice label through the extension.
4. Click Disconnect.
5. Click OK.
When "Import from recorded file" is selected:
1. Click the folder icon.
The Open dialogue box appears.
2. Navigate to the folder containing the WAV files you want to open.
WAV files must meet the following specifications:
– G.711 PCM codec
– 8 kHz, 8-bit sampling rate
– Monaural
– A-law or µ-law encoding
Value Range
2–[the value set in Mailbox No. Max. Length (3-8)] digits
Group Name
Specifies the group name.
Value Range
Max. 32 characters
Note
In order to configure an Extension Group, set a group number here, then assign the group number as the
owner of a mailbox. The Extension Group number is effectively the extension number that is the owner of
the group’s mailbox.
Value Range
2–8 digits
Group Name
Specifies the group name.
Value Range
Max. 32 characters
Deleting Mailboxes
1. Select an entry.
2. Click the icon.
3. Click Yes.
Recording a Name for the extension in the Caller Information dialogue box
1. Select the desired Caller ID number and click the icon.
Note
Before you can record, confirm that you have clicked Apply since you added the Caller ID No.
2. Select "Record from extension" or "Import from recorded file".
When "Record from extension" is selected:
1. Specify the extension number of the telephone used for recording, then click Connect.
2. When the specified extension rings, go off-hook.
3. Click Record, Play, or Stop to record or play a voice label through the extension.
4. Click Disconnect.
5. Click OK.
When "Import from recorded file" is selected:
1. Click the folder icon.
The Open dialogue box appears.
2. Navigate to the folder containing the WAV files you want to open.
WAV files must meet the following specifications:
– G.711 PCM codec
– 8 kHz, 8-bit sampling rate
– Monaural
– A-law or µ-law encoding
3. Select the desired WAV file.
Caller-ID No.
Assigns the telephone number for which the system announces the pre-recorded caller name to extension
users.
Value Range
Max. 20 digits consisting of 0–9
Description
Enters a name and/or description of the Caller ID number.
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Note
The selected time format (12-hour or 24-hour) affects the time format of reports as well as the time that
appears in e-mail notifications for new messages.
Value Range
12 H, 24 H
Value Range
HH:MM (HH: Hour, MM: Minute)
Value Range
HH:MM (HH: Hour, MM: Minute)
Value Range
HH:MM (HH: Hour, MM: Minute)
Prompt Setting
These settings are required when Multilingual Service is enabled.
Primary Language
Specifies the default language to be used when another language is not selected in the Multilingual Selection
Menu.
Value Range
Guidance No. 1–8
Value Range
Language 1–5
Language 1–5—Language
Specifies the language for the current language selection number.
Value Range
None, Guidance No. 1–8
Language 1–5—DTMF
Specifies the number to be input to select the language set for the current language selection number.
Value Range
None, 1–9
Value Range
0–20 s
Value Range
1–3
Value Range
0–10 s
Value Range
0–10 s
Value Range
Guidance No. 1–8
Value Range
Before: the system announces "AM/PM" before the time, such as P.M. 3:42.
After: the system announces "AM/PM" after the time, such as 3:42 P.M.
24-h: the system announces the time in 24-h format, such as 15:42.
Value Range
When at :00: the system announces "O’clock" only on the hour, such "one o’clock".
Always: the system announces "O’clock" always.
None: No announcement
Value Range
MM:DD: Month and Day
DD:MM: Day and Month
Value Range
POUND, HASH
PBX Parameters
Specifies how the system will initiate and control call transfers, setup outgoing calls, and control message
waiting lamps on extensions.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits consisting of 0–9, , # and special codes
D: Disconnecting
F: Flash (Recall)
R: Ringback Tone Detection
T: Dial Tone Detection
, : Dial Pause (default 1 s)
; : Dial Pause (default 3 s)
X: Extension Dialling
0–9, , #: Dial Code
Value Range
Max. 16 digits consisting of 0–9, , # and special codes
D: Disconnecting
F: Flash (Recall)
R: Ringback Tone Detection
T: Dial Tone Detection
Value Range
Max. 16 digits consisting of 0–9, , # and special codes
D: Disconnecting
F: Flash (Recall)
R: Ringback Tone Detection
T: Dial Tone Detection
, : Dial Pause (default 1 s)
; : Dial Pause (default 3 s)
X: Extension Dialling
0–9, , #: Dial Code
Note
Make sure that the duration of Call Transfer No Answer Time is longer than the duration of Call Forwarding
No Answer Time at the PBX. Otherwise, the PBX may forward the call immediately to the extension’s
Intercept Routing destination according to PBX programming, rather than return the call to the system.
Value Range
10–60 s
Value Range
10–90 s
Value Range
100–9900 ms, in units of 100 ms
Value Range
100–9900 ms, in units of 100 ms
Value Range
Max. 32 digits
Value Range
0–3 times (E/NE: 0–4 times, NZ: 0–5 times, C: 0–9 times, Taiwan/Malaysia: 0–2 times)
Value Range
1–60 min (Malaysia: 2–120 min)
Value Range
60–120 min
Value Range
UM port extension number
Value Range
1–6 min
Value Range
1–100
Value Range
1–9 min
Value Range
Max. 32 digits
Value Range
1–30 s
Example:
"I have a call for (name)".
Value Range
1–3 times
Value Range
1–10 times
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Fax Management
You can programme the system to automatically detect incoming fax calls and forward those calls to a fax
extension. You can specify a maximum of 2 fax extensions as the destination for faxes; if the main fax extension
is not available to receive a fax, the system will forward the fax call to the alternate fax extension.
Note
The system can detect incoming fax signals during the first 30 seconds after it answers incoming calls.
Value Range
Disable, Transfer to Fax Extension, Receive Fax
Value Range
2–[the value set in Mailbox No. Max. Length (3-8)] digits
Value Range
1–8 digits
Value Range
1–8 digits
Value Range
5–60 s
Value Range
2–[the value set in Mailbox No. Max. Length (3-8)] digits
Value Range
No: The system will not notify the Fax Manager when fax calls were not answered.
Mbx: The system will announce the number of unanswered fax calls to the Fax Manager when the Fax Manager
logs in to his or her mailbox.
Ext: The system will announce the number of unanswered fax calls to the Fax Manager by calling the Fax
Manager’s extension.
Value Range
No: The system will not notify the Fax Manager when fax calls are answered.
Mbx: The system will announce the number of successfully received fax calls to the Fax Manager when the
Fax Manager logs in to his or her mailbox.
Ext: The system will announce the number of successfully received fax calls to the Fax Manager by calling
the Fax Manager’s extension.
Value Range
Mailbox no. (2–8 digits)
Value Range
Max. 25 characters
Value Range
Max. 20 digits
Value Range
0–99 times
Value Range
1–60 min
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
From First Page: The entire fax document is re-transmitted.
From Error Page: The fax document is re-transmitted, starting from the page that was interrupted.
Value Range
0–255 s
Value Range
0–90 s
Value Range
LOG ID: The cover page will include the time of sending, sender information, the sender’s fax number (System
Fax Number), and the number of pages.
From/To: The cover page will include the time of sending, sender information, the receiver’s name and/or fax
number, and the number of pages.
Value Range
Inside: Printed information is positioned inside the print area of the fax document.
Outside: Printed information is positioned outside of the margins of the print area of the fax document.
Value Range
Transfer to Fax Extension, No Receiving
Value Range
Transfer to Fax Extension, No Receiving
Disconnect Parameters
Maximum Silence Time (0-60 s)
Specifies the length of silence detected by the system before the system disconnects the call.
Value Range
0–60 s
Value Range
0–60 s
Value Range
0–60 s
Value Range
0–60 min
Transfer to Outside
These parameters determine how the system will transfer calls to a trunk via the following features: Call
Transfer Service, Custom Service, Personal Custom Service, Caller ID Callback, Call-through Service.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits consisting of 0–9, , # and special codes
D: Disconnecting
F: Flash (Recall)
R: Ringback Tone Detection
T: Dial Tone Detection
, : Dial Pause for 1 s (default)
; : Dial Pause for 3 s (default)
N: Telephone Number Dialling
0–9, , #: Dial Code
Value Range
Max. 16 digits consisting of 0–9, , # and special codes
D: Disconnecting
F: Flash (Recall)
Value Range
Max. 16 digits consisting of 0–9, , # and special codes
D: Disconnecting
F: Flash (Recall)
R: Ringback Tone Detection
T: Dial Tone Detection
, : Dial Pause for 1 s (default)
; : Dial Pause for 3 s (default)
N: Telephone Number Dialling
A: Feature Access Code
0–9, , #: Dial Code
Value Range
Max. 16 digits consisting of 0–9, , # and special codes
D: Disconnecting
F: Flash (Recall)
R: Ringback Tone Detection
T: Dial Tone Detection
, : Dial Pause for 1 s (default)
; : Dial Pause for 3 s (default)
N: Telephone Number Dialling
A: Feature Access Code
0–9, , #: Dial Code
Value Range
Guidance: The system plays the following guidance before connecting the line to the destination party: "You
have a call. To answer the call, press [1]. Otherwise, press [2] and hang up." If the destination party presses
"1", he or she will be able to answer the transferred trunk call. The system continues playing this guidance for
the time specified in Dialling Parameters—Outgoing Call No Answer Time (10-90 s) in Dialling
Parameters/MSW Notification. If the transferred party does not answer the call within this time, the system
considers it as a No Answer call.
Analyze: The system monitors the status of the trunk, recognises that the destination party goes off-hook, and
connects the line.
Value Range
1–96
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Trunk Group (1–96)—Outside Line Access Sequence for Caller ID Callback (Up
to 16 digits / [0-9 * # D F R T , ; ])
Specifies the sequence of trunk access numbers for Caller ID Callback. This parameter is available when the
system executes Caller ID Callback without using EFA.
Value Range
Max. 16 digits consisting of 0–9, , # and special codes
D: Disconnecting
F: Flash (Recall)
R: Ringback Tone Detection
T: Dial Tone Detection
, : Dial Pause for 1 s (default)
; : Dial Pause for 3 s (default)
0–9, , #: Dial Code
Value Range
1–20
E-mail Option
E-mail Integration allows the system to send new message notification or to send recorded voice messages
or fax message data as file attachments to subscribers via e-mail. The following settings must be made in order
for the system to use E-mail Integration features.
Value Range
Max. 128 characters
Value Range
Max. 64 characters
Value Range
Unlimited, Other
Note
If you attach a voice message that is longer than this setting, surplus parts of the message may be discarded
when sending the e-mail.
Value Range
1–30 min
Message Client
Password Lockup Time (5-60 min)
Specifies the amount of time access will be locked after a password has been incorrectly entered 3 consecutive
times.
Value Range
5–60 min
Mailbox
Mailbox No. Max. Length (3-8)
Specifies the maximum allowed number of digits for a mailbox number.
Note
This setting cannot be changed to a smaller value if mailboxes exist with a number of digits greater than
that smaller value. Those mailboxes must be re-numbered or deleted before this setting can be changed
to a smaller value.
Value Range
3–8 digits
Maximum Time to Wait for Dial Tone (500-20000 ms, *100 ms)
Specifies the length of time that the system waits for dial tone detection.
Value Range
5–200 (´ 100 ms)
Value Range
0–250 s
Value Range
0–500 ms
Value Range
0–9 s
Value Range
1–99 times
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Max. 16 digits
Note
This setting requires the installation of an Activation Key for Unified Messaging E-mail Notification
(KX-NSU2xx) for the number of users that will be accessing their UM mailbox using a client software
programme.
Value Range
4–16 characters (A–Z, a–z, 1–9)
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Max. 16 digits
Note
This setting requires the installation of an Activation Key for Unified Messaging E-mail Notification
(KX-NSU2xx) for the number of users that will be accessing their UM mailbox using a client software
programme.
Value Range
4–16 characters (A–Z, a–z, 1–9)
Subscriber
Minimum Password Length (0-16 digits)
Specifies the minimum length (number of digits) of mailbox passwords.
Value Range
0–16
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
1–99 times
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Max. 16 digits
Value Range
1 digit: 0–9
2 digits: 00–99
Connection Mode
Indicates the connection mode of the WAN (reference only).
Value Range
Disable, Static IP, DHCPc, PPPoE
Router Status
Indicates the operation status of the router function (reference only).
If Disable is selected for Connection Mode, “Out-of-Service” is displayed.
Value Range
In-Service, Out-of-Service, Fault
WAN IP Address
Indicates the IP address of the WAN (reference only).
If Disable is selected for Connection Mode, information will not be displayed on this screen.
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Subnet Mask
Indicates the subnet mask of the LAN (reference only).
If Disable is selected for Connection Mode, information will not be displayed on this screen.
Value Range
Blank, 0–255.0-255.0-255.0–255 (except 0.0.0.0 and 255.255.255.255)
Gateway
Indicates the IP address of the gateway on the LAN (reference only).
If Disable is selected for Connection Mode, information will not be displayed on this screen.
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Max. 20 characters
Status
Indicates the PPPoE connection status (reference only).
To change the status, click the button next to the Status display (It will display Connect or Disconnect
depending on the current status).
Note
• If IP Address Configuration Mode shows "-", the button will be greyed out.
• If Connection Mode (refer to 27.2.1 Router Configuration—Setup—[1-2-1] WAN—Connection
Settings— Connection Mode) is PPPoE, and Session Enabled (refer to 27.2.1 Router
Configuration—Setup—[1-2-1] WAN—Connection Settings—PPPoE— Session Enabled) is set to
Disable, the button will be greyed out.
• The button is available only for Installer level and User (Administrator) level accounts.
Value Range
No Connect: The session is not connected.
Connecting: The session is in the process of being connected (not yet connected with the server).
Connected: The session is connected.
Fault: A fault has occurred (before or during connection).
Disconnected: The session was disconnected by the user.
Value Range
- (hyphen), Dynamic IP, Static IP, Unnumbered
IP Address
Indicates the PPPoE IP address provided by the ISP (reference only).
If Connection Mode (refer to 27.2.1 Router Configuration—Setup—[1-2-1] WAN—Connection Settings—
Connection Mode) is not PPPoE, "-" is displayed.
Value Range
0.0.0.0, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Elapsed Time
Indicates the time elapsed since this port acquired the link (reference only).
Value Range
00:00:00–99:59:59
Value Range
0–9999999
Value Range
0–9999999
Detail Information—MTU
Indicates the largest packet size permitted for network transmission (reference only).
If the MTU value range for PPPoE is outside of 256–1492, "-" is displayed.
If the MTU value range for PPP/Ethernet is outside of 256–1500, "-" is displayed.
Value Range
256–1500, [hyphen]
Name
Indicates the SA (Security Association) Names (reference only).
When connected with VPSS, "VPSS_xx" is displayed, where "xx" is the VPN location number (00–16).
The SA names are displayed in the order of VPSS settings, IPsec settings and the ISAKMP configuration.
If SA is not registered when the Remote IP Address of ISAKMP is static, the SA name is not displayed.
Value Range
ASCII characters (Max. 20 characters)
Type
Indicates the configured VPN protocol mode (reference only).
Value Range
Tunnel, Transport
Client
Indicates the IP address of the VPN client (reference only).
Value Range
0.0.0.0, 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Status
Indicates the status of each VPN tunnel connection (reference only).
Value Range
No Connect, Connected, Fault
Action
Click this button and select Connect or Disconnect for VPN tunnel connection. If No Connect or Fault is
indicated for Status, Connect is displayed. Otherwise Disconnect is displayed.
However, if Dynamic is selected for Remote IP Address Type in 27.10 Router
Configuration—VPN—[3-2] IPSec—SA (ISAKMP), Disconnect is always displayed. This setting is available
for the Installer level account and User (Administrator) level account.
Value Range
Disconnect, Connect
RCV
Indicates the number of packets received at this port since the last reset (reference only).
This value will reset to zero after the maximum value is reached.
Value Range
0–9999999
SEND
Indicates the number of packets sent from this port since the last reset (reference only).
This value will reset to zero after the maximum value is reached.
Value Range
0–9999999
Elapsed Time
Indicates the time elapsed since the last reset (reference only).
This value will reset to zero after the maximum value is reached.
Value Range
00:00:00–99:59:59
Value Range
Static IP, DHCP, PPPoE, Disable
Static IP
Allows the PBX to assign a specific IP address.
If Static IP is selected for Connection Mode, this screen is displayed.
WAN IP Address
Specifies the IP address of the WAN.
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Subnet Mask
Specifies the subnet mask of the WAN.
Value Range
Blank, 0–255.0–255.0–255.0–255 (except 0.0.0.0 and 255.255.255.255)
Gateway
Specifies the IP address of the default gateway of the WAN.
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Note
• Since communication over a VPN will not be possible, do not set a destination IP address in the VPN
for this setting.
• If this setting is configured at the same time as the following setting, the following setting takes
precedence.
28.1 Network Service—[1] IP Address/Ports—Basic Settings— DNS Setting—Preferred DNS IP
Address
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Note
• Since communication over a VPN will not be possible, do not set a destination IP address in the VPN
for this setting.
• If this setting is configured at the same time as the following setting, the following setting takes
precedence.
28.1 Network Service—[1] IP Address/Ports—Basic Settings— DNS Setting—Alternative DNS IP
Address
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
DHCP
Allows the PBX to receive an IP address automatically from a DHCP server.
If DHCP is selected for Connection Mode, this screen is displayed.
Host Name
Specifies the host name if a host name is assigned by the ISP.
Value Range
1–63 characters
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Gateway
Specifies the IP address of the default gateway of the WAN.
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
DNS Setting
Selects the method of specifying the IP address of a DNS server.
Value Range
Auto, Static
Note
• Since communication over a VPN will not be possible, do not set a destination IP address in the VPN
for this setting.
• If this setting is configured at the same time as the following setting, the following setting takes
precedence.
28.1 Network Service—[1] IP Address/Ports—Basic Settings— DNS Setting—Preferred DNS IP
Address
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Note
• Since communication over a VPN will not be possible, do not set a destination IP address in the VPN
for this setting.
• If this setting is configured at the same time as the following setting, the following setting takes
precedence.
28.1 Network Service—[1] IP Address/Ports—Basic Settings— DNS Setting—Alternative DNS IP
Address
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
PPPoE
Allows the PBX to receive an IP address from a PPPoE server.
If PPPoE is selected for Connection Mode, this screen is displayed.
Value Range
Max. 20 Characters
Session Enabled
Selects whether to initiate the PPPoE session.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
User name
Specifies the user name provided by the ISP.
Value Range
0–64 characters
Password
Specifies the password provided by the ISP.
Value Range
0–64 characters
Service Name
If requested by the ISP, enter the PPPoE service name.
Value Range
0–24 characters
Authentication Method
Selects the authentication method.
Auto means that PAP, CHAP or None is selected for the necessary authentication.
Value Range
Auto, CHAP
IP Address
Specifies the IP address when IP Address Configuration Mode is set to Static IP or Unnumbered.
If Static IP is selected for IP Address Configuration Mode, enter the IP address assigned by the DHCP
server.
If Unnumbered is selected for IP Address Configuration Mode, enter one of the global IP addresses provided
by the ISP.
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Subnet Mask
Specifies the subnet mask when IP Address Configuration Mode is set to Static IP or Unnumbered.
If Static IP is selected for IP Address Configuration Mode, enter the subnet mask assigned by the DHCP
server.
If Unnumbered is selected for IP Address Configuration Mode, enter one of the subnet mask provided by
the ISP.
Value Range
0–255.0–255.0–255.0–255 (except 0.0.0.0 and 255.255.255.255)
DNS Setting
Selects the method of setting the DNS address.
– Auto: Select this if the DNS IP address is assigned by the ISP.
– Static: Select this to enter the DNS IP address manually.
Value Range
Auto, Static
Note
• Since communication over a VPN will not be possible, do not set a destination IP address in the VPN
for this setting.
• If this setting is configured at the same time as the following setting, the following setting takes
precedence.
28.1 Network Service—[1] IP Address/Ports—Basic Settings— DNS Setting—Preferred DNS IP
Address
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Note
• Since communication over a VPN will not be possible, do not set a destination IP address in the VPN
for this setting.
• If this setting is configured at the same time as the following setting, the following setting takes
precedence.
28.1 Network Service—[1] IP Address/Ports—Basic Settings— DNS Setting—Alternative DNS IP
Address
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
PPP Keep-Alive
Selects whether Keep-Alive is enabled or not.
When the server of the ISP is disconnected for some reason, this function keeps the PPPoE Connection alive
automatically.
Value Range
LCP ECHO: Select to detect PPPoE link failures.
ICMP: Select to detect network failures.
Disable: Disables this setting.
Advanced Setting
Click here to open the advanced setting menu for PPPoE - Advanced.
PPPoE - Advanced
MTU
If the MTU value is assigned by the ISP, set it here (1280–1492).
If the MTU value is outside of the value range below, 1280 or 1492 is displayed.
Value Range
1280–1492
Connection on Demand
When PPPoE for IPv6 is used to connect to the ISP, this setting is always set to Enable.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
1–1440 min
LCP ECHO
If LCP ECHO is selected for PPP Keep-Alive, configure the parameters below.
Value Range
1–3600 s
Value Range
1–255
Value Range
1–255
TCP MSS
Selects the setting method of the TCP MSS (Maximum Segment Size) value.
This function is only available for IPv4 packets.
– Auto: MTU-40 is specified.
– Fixed: Specifies the TCP MSS Value.
If Auto is selected, MTU-40 is specified. However if MTU is smaller than MRU, MRU-40 is specified.
Note
MTU: Maximum Transmission Unit, MRU: Maximum Receive Unit
Value Range
Auto, Fixed, Disable
Value Range
536–1452
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Destination IP Address
Specifies the destination IP address for ICMP echo requests.
If Disable is selected for ICMP Keep-Alive Enabled, this setting cannot be specified.
Value Range
1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Advanced Setting
Click here to open the advanced setting menu for Network Monitor (Advanced).
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Destination IP Address
Specifies the destination IP address for ICMP echo requests.
If Disable is selected for ICMP Keep-Alive Enabled, this setting cannot be specified.
Value Range
1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Interval (s)
Specifies the interval of the polling timer used for sending ICMP echo requests.
Value Range
1–3600 s
Fail Count
Specifies the maximum count of ICMP echo failures.
If Disable is selected for ICMP Keep-Alive Enabled, this setting cannot be specified.
Value Range
1–255
Recovery Count
Specifies the number of ICMP echo replies received for ICMP recovery to be detected from the fault state.
If Disable is selected for ICMP Keep-Alive Enabled, this setting cannot be specified.
Value Range
1–255
IPv6 Bridge
Selects whether or not to enable IPv6 Pass Through.
If the IPv6 function is enabled, this setting is disabled.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
PPPoE Bridge
Select whether or not to enable PPPoE Bridge.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
DDNS Server
Selects the method of specifying a DDNS server.
If Disable is selected for Dynamic DNS, the settings on this screen cannot be configured.
Value Range
IP address, URL
IP Address
Specifies the DDNS Server IP Address.
If Disable is selected for Dynamic DNS or URL as DDNS Server, the settings on this screen cannot be
configured.
Value Range
Blank (0.0.0.0), 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
URL
Specifies the DDNS URL.
If Disable is selected for Dynamic DNS or IP Address as DDNS Server, the settings on this screen
cannot be configured.
Value Range
Maximum 253 characters
User Name
Specifies the use name for DDNS service.
If Disable is selected for Dynamic DNS, the settings on this screen cannot be configured.
Value Range
Maximum 64 characters
Password
Specifies the password for DDNS service.
If Disable is selected for Dynamic DNS, the settings on this screen cannot be configured.
Value Range
Maximum 64 characters
Domain Name
Specifies the domain name for DDNS service.
If Disable is selected for Dynamic DNS, the settings on this screen cannot be configured.
Value Range
Maximum 128 characters
Update Time
Specifies the update time for DDNS service.
If Disable is selected for Dynamic DNS, the settings on this screen cannot be configured.
Setting "0" specifies an unlimited update time.
Value Range
0, 10–1440 min
Value Range
1–63 characters
Value Range
1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
0–255.0–255.0–255.0–255 (except 0.0.0.0 and 255.255.255.255)
Value Range
1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Max. 128 characters
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Multicast—IGMP Proxy
Selects whether to use IGMP (Internet Group Management Protocol) which your multicasting server specifies
over IPv4.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Protocol—Advanced Setting
Click here to open the advanced setting menu for protocol.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Protocol
Selects a protocol type to be used when sending/receiving data over the Internet.
Value Range
TCP, UDP, TCP&UDP, ICMP
Note
• If neither the start port nor the end port is set, any port can be used.
• The user cannot reserve system ports for the WAN side.
• If a range is set, ensure that the number of internal ports and external ports match each other.
Value Range
1–65535
Note
• If neither the start port nor the end port is set, any port can be used.
• The user cannot reserve system ports for the WAN side.
• If a range is set, ensure that the number of internal ports and external ports match each other.
• Ensure that the end range value is greater than the start range value.
Value Range
1–65535
Local IP Address
Specifies the IP address of equipment on the LAN.
Value Range
1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Note
• If neither the start port nor the end port is set, any port can be used.
• The user cannot reserve system ports for the WAN side.
• If a range is set, ensure that the number of internal ports and external ports match each other.
Value Range
1–65535
Note
• If neither the start port nor the end port is set, any port can be used.
• The user cannot reserve system ports for the WAN side.
• If a range is set, ensure that the number of internal ports and external ports match each other.
• Ensure that the end range value is greater than the start range value.
Value Range
1–65535
Protocol Setting
ICMP (WAN/LAN)—Send ICMP Redirect
Selects whether to send ICMP redirect messages.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
53
Value Range
0–86400 s
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Host Name
Specifies a DNS host name.
Value Range
1–254 characters
IP Address
Specifies the IPv4 IP address for the DNS host name.
Value Range
1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Enable, Disable
IP Address
Specifies the IPv4 IP address.
Value Range
1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Host Name
Specifies the DNS host name for the DNS Server.
Value Range
1–254 characters
Value Range
Enable, Disable
CNAME
Specifies the CNAME for the DNS host name.
Value Range
1–254 characters
Host Name
Specifies the DNS host name.
Value Range
1–254 characters
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Destination IP Address
Specifies the IP address of the destination host or network.
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Netmask
Specifies the netmask for the Destination IP Address.
Value Range
Blank, 0–255.0–255.0–255.0–255 (except 0.0.0.0)
Interface or Gateway
Selects the method of specifying the Destination IP Address.
Value Range
Gateway, PPPoE
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
00:00:00:00:00:00–FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF
Value Range
Disable, Enable
SPI—Log Output
Selects whether to output logs.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Accept, Discard
Value Range
Accept, Discard
Filter
Indicates whether to enable the packet filtering function (reference only).
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Protocol No.
Indicates the protocol type or the protocol number (0–255) (reference only).
Value Range
ANY, ICMP, TCP, UDP, TCP&UDP, 0–255
Value Range
ANY, Protocol Name, Port Number Start-End
Note
Protocol Name is specified at 27.8 Router Configuration—Firewall—[2-2] Packet Filtering—Packet
Filtering - Advanced.
Source Port
Indicates the port name or the port number (reference only).
Value Range
ANY, Port Name, Port Number
Value Range
ANY, Protocol Name, Port Number Start-End
Note
Protocol Name is specified at 27.8 Router Configuration—Firewall—[2-2] Packet Filtering—Packet
Filtering - Advanced.
Destination Port
Indicates the port name or the port number (reference only).
Value Range
ANY, Port Name, Port number
ICMP Type
Indicates the ICMP type (reference only).
Value Range
ANY, Echo Reply, Destination Unreachable, Source Quench, Redirect, Echo Request, Router
Advertisement, Router Solicitation, Time Exceeded, Parameter Problem, Timestamp, Timestamp Reply,
Information Request, Information Reply, Address Mask Request, Address Mask Reply
Direction
Indicates the direction of IPv4 packets (reference only).
Value Range
LAN->WAN, WAN->LAN
Policy
Indicates the packet filtering policy (reference only).
Value Range
Accept, Discard
Logging
Selects whether to enable the packet filtering log. If Accept is selected for Policy, this setting is greyed out
and disabled.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Accept, Discard
Value Range
Accept, Discard
Filter—Entry No.
Selects the packet filter number. Once the Entry No. is selected, all following items on this screen can be
programmed for that packet filter.
Value Range
1–64
Filter—Filter
Selects whether to specify the packet filtering function.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Filter—Protocol Number
Selects the protocol type or the protocol number (0–255).
Value Range
ANY, Protocol Name, Other ( 0 - 255 )
Value Range
ICMP, TCP, UDP, TCP&UDP
Value Range
Blank, 0–255
Value Range
ANY, Protocol Name, Port Number
Note
• If TCP or TCP&UDP is selected for Protocol Number—Protocol Name, default value is FTP.
• If ICMP is selected for Protocol Number—Protocol Name or Protocol Name is not selected for TCP/
UDP Source Port, this item is greyed out.
Value Range
If TCP is selected for Protocol Number—Protocol Name, the following protocol types can be selected:
FTP(20/21), SSH(22), Telnet(23), HTTP(80), HTTPS(443), POP3(110), POS3S(995), IMAP(143), SMTP(25)
If UDP is selected for Protocol Number—Protocol Name, the following protocol types can be selected:
DNS(53), DHCP(67/68), TFTP(69), SNMP(161/162)
If TCP&UDP is selected for Protocol Number—Protocol Name, the following protocol types can be selected:
FTP(20/21), SSH(22), Telnet(23), HTTP(80), HTTPS(443), POP3(110), POS3S(995), IMAP(143), SMTP(25),
DNS(53), DHCP(67/68), TFTP(69), SNMP(161/162)
Value Range
0–65535
Value Range
ANY, Protocol Name, Port Number
Note
If TCP or TCP&UDP is selected for Protocol Number—Protocol Name, the default value is FTP. If
UDP is selected for Protocol Number—Protocol Name, the default value is DNS.
Value Range
If TCP is selected for Protocol Number—Protocol Name, the following protocol types can be selected:
FTP(20/21), SSH(22), Telnet(23), HTTP(80), HTTPS(443), POP3(110), POS3S(995), IMAP(143), SMTP(25)
If UDP is selected for Protocol Number—Protocol Name, the following protocol types can be selected:
DNS(53), DHCP(67/68), TFTP(69), SNMP(161/162)
If TCP&UDP is selected for Protocol Number—Protocol Name, the following protocol types can be selected:
FTP(20/21), SSH(22), Telnet(23), HTTP(80), HTTPS(443), POP3(110), POS3S(995), IMAP(143), SMTP(25),
DNS(53), DHCP(67/68), TFTP(69), SNMP(161/162)
Value Range
0–65535
Filter—Source
Selects the method of specifying the source packet.
Value Range
ANY, Address, Subnet
Filter—Source—IP Address
Specifies the IP address.
If ANY is selected for Source, this item is greyed out.
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Filter—Source—Subnet Mask
Specifies the subnet mask.
If Subnet is not selected for Source, this item is greyed out.
Value Range
Blank, 0.0.0.0–255.255.255.255
Filter—Destination
Selects the method of specifying the destination packet.
Value Range
ANY, Address, Subnet
Filter—Destination—IP Address
Specifies the IP address.
If ANY is selected for Destination, this item is greyed out.
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Filter—Destination—Subnet Mask
Specifies the subnet mask.
If Subnet is not selected for Destination, this item is greyed out.
Value Range
Blank, 0.0.0.0–255.255.255.255
Filter—ICMP Type
Selects the ICMP type.
Value Range
ANY, Echo Reply, Destination Unreachable, Source Quench, Redirect, Echo Request, Router
Advertisement, Router Solicitation, Time Exceeded, Parameter Problem, Timestamp, Timestamp Reply,
Information Request, Information Reply, Address Mask Request, Address Mask Reply
Filter—Direction
Selects the direction of the IPv4 packet.
Value Range
LAN->WAN, WAN->LAN
Filter—Policy
Selects whether to enable the packet filtering policy.
Value Range
Accept, Discard
Filter—Logging
Specifies whether to enable the packet filtering log.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
1–16
Value Range
Enable, Disable
VPSS—Advanced Setting
Click here to open the advanced setting menu for VPSS.
VPSS - Advanced
Additional LAN on VPN Tunnel sharing (MAX 4 Entries)—Local Network
Address
Specifies the local IP address at an adjacent segment or satellite office for use in VPN tunnel sharing. Up to
4 addresses can be specified (#1–#4).
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Value Range
Blank, 0.0.0.0–255.255.255.255
Value Range
1–86400 s
Value Range
1–86400 s
Value Range
1–86400 s
Value Range
1–86400 s
Value Range
1–86400 s
Value Range
1–86400 s
Value Range
1–86400 s
Value Range
1–86400 s
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Main—Advanced Setting
Click here to open the advanced setting menu for IKE Settings.
IKE Settings
IKE Settings—Version
Indicates the version of IKE (Internet Key Exchange) (reference only).
Value Range
v1
Value Range
1–50
Value Range
1–100 s
Value Range
1–86400 s
Value Range
1–86400 s
Value Range
1–65535
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Security Policy
SPD Check
Click the SPD Check button on this screen to perform checks such as network address duplication on SPD
(Security Policy Database) entries and display the results.
SP Name
Specifies the SP (Security Policy) name.
Value Range
1–16 characters
Setting
Specifies whether to enable the security policy.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
SA Name
Selects an SA (Security Association) name from the drop down list. SA is a connection between VPN gateways.
Value Range
SA Name
Source Type
Selects the source type of the SA.
Value Range
Any, IP Address
Source IP Address
Specify the source IP Address of the SA.
This setting is available only if IP Address is selected for Source Type.
This setting can be set to blank only if Any is selected for Source Type.
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Subnet Mask
Specifies the subnet mask for the source IP Address of the SA.
This setting can be set to blank only if Any is selected for Source Type.
Value Range
Blank, 0.0.0.0–255.255.255.255
Destination Type
Selects the destination type of the SA.
Value Range
Any, IP Address
Destination IP Address
Specifies the destination IP Address of the SA.
This setting is available only if IP Address is selected for Destination Type.
This setting can be set to blank only if Any is selected for Destination Type.
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Subnet Mask
Specifies the subnet mask for the destination IP Address of the SA.
This setting can be set to blank only if Any is selected for Destination Type.
Value Range
Blank, 0.0.0.0–255.255.255.255
Advanced Setting
Click here to open the advanced setting menu for Security Policy—Advance.
Security Policy—Advance
SPD Check
Click the SPD Check button on this screen to perform checks such as network address duplication on SPD
(Security Policy Database) entries and display the results.
SP Name
Specifies the SP (Security Policy) name.
Value Range
1–16 characters
Setting
Selects whether to enable the security policy.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
SA Name
Selects an SA (Security Association) name from drop down list. SA is a connection between VPN gateways.
Value Range
SA Name
Protocol Type
Selects the protocol to be controlled by IPSec.
Value Range
Any, TCP_UDP, TCP_UDP_ICMP_IGMP, Fixed Protocol No.
Value Range
0–255
Source Type
Selects the source type of the SA.
Value Range
Any, IP Address
Source IP Address
Specifies the source IP Address of the SA.
This setting is available only if IP Address is selected for Source Type.
This setting can be set to blank only if Any is selected for Source Type.
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Subnet Mask
Specifies the subnet mask for the source IP Address of the SA.
This setting can be set to blank only if Any is selected for Source Type.
Value Range
Blank, 0.0.0.0–255.255.255.255
Value Range
Any, Fixed
Value Range
1–65535
Destination Type
Selects the destination type of the SA.
Value Range
Any, IP Address
Destination IP Address
Specifies the destination IP Address of the SA.
This setting is available only if IP Address is selected for Destination Type.
This setting can be set to blank only if Any is selected for Destination Type.
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Subnet Mask
Specifies the subnet mask for destination IP Address of the SA.
This setting can be set to blank only if Any is selected for Destination Type.
Value Range
Blank, 0.0.0.0–255.255.255.255
Value Range
Any, Fixed
Value Range
1–65535
TCP MSS
Selects the method of specifying the TCP MSS (Maximum Segment Size).
Value Range
Auto, Fixed
Value Range
536–1460
SA (ISAKMP)
SA Name
Specifies the SA (Security Association) name.
Value Range
1–16 characters
Exchange Mode
Selects the IKE exchange mode.
Value Range
Main, Aggressive, Both
Remote Type
Selects the remote type for SA.
Value Range
Terminal, Multi Site
Value Range
Static, Dynamic
Remote IP Address
Specifies the remote IP address.
If Dynamic is selected for Remote IP Address Type, this item is greyed out.
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Any, Fixed
Value Range
1–65535
My Identifier Type
Selects the method of specifying My Identifier Type.
Value Range
FQDN, User FQDN, WAN IP Address
My Identifier
Specifies My Identifier when FQDN or User FQDN is selected for My Identifier Type. If WAN IP Address is
selected for My Identifier Type, this setting is greyed out.
Value Range
1–255 characters
Value Range
FQDN, User FQDN, IP Address
Peer Identifier
Specifies Peer Identifier.
Value Range
If FQDN or User FQDN is selected for Peer Identifier Type, enter the Peer Identifier: 1–255 characters
If IP Address is selected for Peer Identifier Type, enter the IP Address as the Peer Identifier: Blank,
1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Nonce (byte)
Specifies the Nonce (Number used ONCE).
Value Range
8–256
Value Range
obey, strict, claim
Initial - Contact
Selects whether to send an INITIAL-CONTACT message.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
SA Option
SA Name
Specifies the SA (Security Association) name.
Value Range
1–16 characters
XAuth Mode
Selects whether to enable XAuth Mode.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
IPComp Mode
Selects whether to deflate when using IPComp (IP Payload Compression Protocol).
Value Range
none, deflate
Keepalive Mode
Selects the keep alive mode.
Value Range
DPD (Dead Peer Protection), ICMP Echo, None
Value Range
Alarm, Alarm & SA Delete
Value Range
1–3600 s
Value Range
1–3600 s
Value Range
1–255
Value Range
1–3600 s
IKE Proposal
SA Name
Specifies the SA (Session Announcement) name.
Value Range
1–16 characters
Authentication
Selects the authentication method.
Value Range
Pre-Shared Key
Pre-Shared Key
Specifies the Pre-Shared Key.
Inputted characters are displayed as black circles.
Value Range
8–63 characters
Encryption Algorithm
Selects the encryption algorithm.
Value Range
AES-CBC-128, AES-CBC-192, AES-CBC-256, DES-CBC, 3DES-CBC
Hash Algorithm
Selects the hash algorithm.
Value Range
HMAC-MD5, HMAC-SHA1
Diffie-Hellman Group
Selects the Diffie-Hellman Group.
Value Range
Group1 (modp768), Group2 (modp1024), Group5 (modp1536), Group14 (modp2048)
Lifetime (s)
Selects the SA life time.
Value Range
300–691200 s
Value Range
On, Off
IPSec Proposal
SA Name
Specifies the SA (Session Announcement) name.
Value Range
1–16 characters
Security Protocol
Selects the protocol for IPSec.
Value Range
AH, ESP
Lifetime (s)
Specifies the SA life time.
Value Range
300–691200 s
Capsulation
Selects the IPSec mode.
Value Range
Transport, Tunnel
Encryption Algorithm
Selects the encryption algorithm.
Value Range
None, AES-CBC-128, AES-CBC-192, AES-CBC-256, DES-CBC, 3DES-CBC
Hash Algorithm
Selects the Hash algorithm.
Value Range
HMAC-MD5, HMAC-SHA1
Diffie-Hellman Group
Selects the Diffie-Hellman Group.
Value Range
None, Group1 (modp768), Group2 (modp1024), Group5 (modp1536), Group14 (modp2048)
XAuth ID
User Name (32 characters)
Specifies the user name.
Value Range
8–32 characters (a–z, 0–9, [hyphen], [underscore])
* The first character must be a letter.
Value Range
Maximum 32 characters (a–z, A–Z, 0–9, [hyphen], [underscore])
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
OFF, ON
Value Range
Priority Queue, TOS (DSCP)
Value Range
VoIP (RTP Packet), VoIP (Signaling), VoIP (All)
Upstream Bandwidth
Selects the method of specifying upstream bandwidth.
If Fixed Bandwidth Size (Kbps) is selected, specify the bandwidth.
If Automatic is selected, this item is greyed out.
Value Range
Automatic, Fixed Bandwidth Size (Kbps) (64–100000)
Advanced Setting
Click here to open the advanced setting menu for QoS Settings - Advanced.
Value Range
1–32
Value Range
On, Off
Value Range
0–3
Value Range
ANY, Select Protocol, Other ( 0 - 255 )
Value Range
ICMP, TCP, UDP, TCP&UDP
Value Range
Blank, 0–255
WAN QoS—Source
Selects the method of specifying a source.
If ANY is selected for Source, QoS is available for all IP addresses.
If Address is selected for Source, enter the IP address for IP Address below.
If Subnet is selected for Source, enter the subnet mask for Subnet Mask below.
Value Range
ANY, Address, Subnet
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Blank, 0.0.0.0–255.255.255.255
WAN QoS—Destination
Selects the method of specifying a destination IP address.
If ANY is selected for Destination, QoS is available for all IP addresses.
If Address is selected for Destination, enter the IP address for IP Address below.
If Subnet is selected for Destination, enter the subnet mask for Subnet Mask below.
Value Range
ANY, Address, Subnet
Value Range
Blank, 1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Blank, 0.0.0.0–255.255.255.255
Value Range
OFF, ON
Value Range
ANY, TOS(DSCP) Value (0-63)
Value Range
0–63
Value Range
OFF, ON
Value Range
0–63
Bandwidth Control—Enable
Selects whether to enable bandwidth control.
If Enable is not selected, Priority Queue 0(kbps), Priority Queue 1(kbps), Priority Queue 2(kbps) and
Priority Queue 3(kbps) are greyed out.
Value Range
OFF, ON
Value Range
Blank, 64–100000 Kbps
Value Range
Blank, 64–100000 Kbps
Value Range
Blank, 64–100000 Kbps
Value Range
Blank, 64–100000 Kbps
Value Range
68, 1024–65535
Value Range
Obtain an IP address automatically, Use the following IP address
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Value Range
00:00:00:00:00:00–FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF
Value Range
0–255.0–255.0–255.0–255 (except 0.0.0.0 and 255.255.255.255)
Value Range
0.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Value Range
Max. 128 characters
Value Range
53, 1024–65535
Value Range
Obtain DNS server address automatically, Use the following DNS server address
Note
• Since communication over a VPN will not be possible, do not set a destination IP address in the VPN
for this setting.
• If this setting is configured at the same time as the following settings, this setting takes precedence.
– 27.2.1 Router Configuration—Setup—[1-2-1] WAN—Connection Settings—Static IP— Preferred
DNS IP Address
– 27.2.1 Router Configuration—Setup—[1-2-1] WAN—Connection Settings—DHCP— Preferred
DNS IP Address
– 27.2.1 Router Configuration—Setup—[1-2-1] WAN—Connection Settings—PPPoE— Preferred
DNS IP Address
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Note
• Since communication over a VPN will not be possible, do not set a destination IP address in the VPN
for this setting.
• If this setting is configured at the same time as the following settings, this setting takes precedence.
– 27.2.1 Router Configuration—Setup—[1-2-1] WAN—Connection Settings—Static IP—
Alternative DNS IP Address
– 27.2.1 Router Configuration—Setup—[1-2-1] WAN—Connection Settings—DHCP— Alternative
DNS IP Address
– 27.2.1 Router Configuration—Setup—[1-2-1] WAN—Connection Settings—PPPoE— Alternative
DNS IP Address
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Value Range
Obtain DSP IP address automatically, Use the following DSP IP address
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Value Range
00:00:00:00:00:00–FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF
Advanced Settings
LAN Port—Speed & Duplex
Specifies the connection mode of the main port. The connection is made in 100 Mbps/half duplex when Auto
negotiation fails.
Value Range
Auto: Automatic mode selection
1000M-Full: 1000 Mbps/full duplex
100M-Full: 100 Mbps/full duplex
100M-Half: 100 Mbps/half duplex
10M-Full: 10 Mbps/full duplex
10M-Half: 10 Mbps/half duplex
LAN Port—MDI/MDIX
Specifies the cable type connected to the LAN port.
Value Range
Auto, MDI, MDIX
Value Range
Auto: Automatic mode selection
1000M-Full: 1000 Mbps/full duplex
100M-Full: 100 Mbps/full duplex
100M-Half: 100 Mbps/half duplex
10M-Full: 10 Mbps/full duplex
WAN Port—MDI/MDIX
Specifies the cable type connected to the WAN port.
Value Range
Auto, MDI, MDIX
WAN Port—Uplink
Specifies whether the WAN port data uplink is enabled.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Auto: Automatic mode selection
1000M-Full: 1000 Mbps/full duplex
100M-Full: 100 Mbps/full duplex
100M-Half: 100 Mbps/half duplex
10M-Full: 10 Mbps/full duplex
10M-Half: 10 Mbps/half duplex
Value Range
Disable
LAN (All packets)
Reference
The items displayed in this tab are the settings obtained from a DHCP server by the DHCP client of the PBX.
They are for reference only.
DSP Card #1 - 1/DSP Card #1 - 2/DSP Card #2 - 1/DSP Card #2 - 2—IP Address
Indicates the IP address assigned for an installed optional DSP card (reference only).
DSP Card #1 - 1/DSP Card #1 - 2/DSP Card #2 - 1/DSP Card #2 - 2—MAC Address
Indicates the MAC address of the DSP card (reference only).
DSP Card #1 - 1/DSP Card #1 - 2/DSP Card #2 - 1/DSP Card #2 - 2—Subnet Mask
Indicates the Subnet Mask address of the DSP card (reference only).
Basic Settings
DHCP Server
Specifies if the DHCP server functions of the PBX are enabled or not.
Note
If the PBX is in Backup Master mode of network survivability, it is recommended that an external DHCP
server is used instead of the PBX’s DHCP server.
Value Range
Disable, DHCP Server, DHCP Relay Agent
Port number
Specifies the port number used for the DHCP server.
Value Range
67, 1024–65535
Value Range
1.0.0.1–255.255.255.255
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Ending IP address
Specifies the ending IP address for the assignable range of IP addresses.
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Value Range
1–168 (hours)
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Value Range
00:00:00:00:00:00–FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF
IP Address
Specifies the IP addresses of the MAC address/IP address pairs to be subject to static DHCP allocation.
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Value Range
00:00:00:00:00:00–FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF
IP Address
Specifies IP addresses currently assigned by the system.
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Value Range
1–85777 s
FTP Server
Enables or disables the PBX’s FTP server function.
Notice
When operating in a One-look network, do not disable FTP server settings. For details, refer to
"5.5 Programming a One-look Network" in the Installation Manual.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
21, 1024–65535
Value Range
1024–65535
Value Range
1024–65535
Note
Be sure to change the user name from its initial, default value. Also, for security reasons, change the user
name regularly.
Value Range
Max. 24 characters (a–z, 0–9, [hyphen], [underscore])
Note
The first character must be a letter (a–z).
User Information—Password
Specifies the password for the PBX’s FTP server authentication.
Note
Be sure to change the password from its initial, default value. Also, for security reasons, change the
password regularly.
Value Range
Max. 24 characters (A–Z, a–z, 0–9, [hyphen], [underscore])
Note
The first character must be a letter or number.
Value Range
80, 1024–65535
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
443, 1024–65535
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
443, 1024–65535
Value Range
Automatic (24H), Manual
Value Range
5, 10, 30, 60´n (n=1–24) (minutes)
NTP server
Enables or disables NTP service with the PBX’s NTP server for connected KX-UT series SIP phones.
When this feature is enabled, the PBX will report to connected KX-UT series SIP phones the information
obtained from the SNTP server specified in 10.1.2 PBX Configuration—[2-1-2] System—Date &
Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving.
If this feature is disabled, connected KX-UT series SIP phones will use their individually programmed time
settings.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Max. 64 characters
Value Range
Max. 128 characters
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 (IP address), Max. 128 characters (host name)
Value Range
25, 465, 587, 1024–65535
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Note
When Enable is selected, the encryption method used is STARTTLS.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Max. 64 characters
SMTP Authentication—Password
Specifies the password required to access the SMTP server.
Value Range
Max. 64 characters
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 (IP address), Max. 128 characters (host name)
Value Range
110, 1024–65535
Value Range
Max. 64 characters
Value Range
Max. 64 characters
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
25, 465, 587, 1024–65535
Value Range
25, 465, 587, 1024–65535
IMAP4—IMAP4 server
Specifies whether to enable the IMAP4 server functions of the PBX.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
IMAP4—Port number
Specifies a port number for the IMAP server. The default value is 143.
Value Range
143, 1024–65535
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
993, 1024–65535
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
1, 2, 3, 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 60 (min)
TELNET Server
Specifies whether to enable the TELNET server functions of the PBX.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Port number
Specifies a port number for the TELNET server.
Value Range
23, 1024–65535
User name
Specifies a user name for the TELNET server to log in.
Value Range
Max. 24 characters (a–z, 0–9, $, [hyphen], [underscore])
Password
Specifies a password for the TELNET server to log in.
Value Range
Max. 24 characters (a–z, 0–9, $, [hyphen], [underscore])
Connection 1—Connection 5
Connection Name
Specifies the name of the connection to use for programming in other items.
Value Range
Max. 64 characters
IP Address
Specifies the IP address of the FTP site. Click the IP Address radio button when this is used.
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Name
Specifies the name of the FTP site. Click the Name radio button when this is used.
Value Range
FTP site name (max. 253 characters)
Value Range
21, 990, 1024–65535
User name
Specifies the user name required to log in to the FTP site.
Value Range
Max. 24 characters (a–z, 0–9, $, [hyphen], [underscore])
Note
• The first character must be a letter or number.
• $ may only be used as the final character.
Password
Specifies the password for the user name required to log in to the FTP site.
Value Range
Max. 24 characters (A–Z, a–z, 0–9, =, [hyphen], [underscore])
Note
The first character must be a letter, number, or =.
Protocol
Specifies the communication protocol for the FTP connection.
Value Range
FTP, FTPS (Explicit), FTPS (Implicit)
Remote Syslog
Specifies whether an external Syslog server will be used with the PBX.
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 (IP address), Max. 253 characters (host name)
Port
Specifies the connection port for the remote Syslog server.
Value Range
514, 1024–65535
SNMP agent
Enables the PBX to use its SNMP agent function.
Value Range
Disable, Enable
SNMP version
Specifies the version of the SNMP protocol to use.
Value Range
SNMP V1, SNMP V2c
Value Range
161, 1024–65535
MIB info—SysContact
Specifies the name and contact information of the system administrator.
Value Range
Max. 255 characters
MIB info—SysName
Specifies the administrative name for the system.
Value Range
Max. 255 characters
MIB info—SysLocation
Specifies the physical location for the system.
Value Range
Max. 255 characters
IP address
Specifies the IP address of an SNMP manager. Click the button next to IP Address and enter the address.
Value Range
1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255
Host name
Specifies the host name of an SNMP manager. Click the button next to Host Name and enter a name.
Value Range
Max. 253 characters (host name)
Trap port
Specifies a port number used to send trap messages from the agent to an SNMP manager.
Value Range
162, 1024–65535
Community name
Specifies a community name of an SNMP manager.
Value Range
Max. 32 characters
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Disable, Enable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
Value Range
Enable, Disable
SSL/TLS—Encryption Suite
Specifies the method of encryption used for SSL/TLS.
Value Range
AES256-SHA, DES-CBC3-SHA, AES128-SHA, DES-CBC-SHA
NAS Status
Displays/changes the connection status of the NAS.
Value Range
Connected, Disconnected
To change the connection status of the NAS, perform the following:
• Click Disconnect to set the NAS to disconnect status.
• Click Connect to set the NAS to connect status.
NAS Setting—Protocol
Specifies the communication protocol for the NAS connection.
Value Range
NFS, CIFS
Value Range
1.0.0.1–223.255.255.254
Value Range
Max. 253 characters
Value Range
445, 1024–65535
Value Range
Max. 128 characters (multi-byte characters allowed)
Value Range
Max. 24 characters (multi-byte characters allowed)
CIFS Setting—Password
Specifies the NAS connection password when NAS Setting—Protocol is set to CIFS.
Value Range
Max. 24 characters (multi-byte characters allowed)
– SIP Extension— Setting parameters assigned to Remote SIP-MLT—NAT - SIP Proxy Server Port
No.
– SIP Extension— Setting parameters assigned to Remote SIP-MLT—NAT - NTP Server IP Address
– SIP Extension— Setting parameters assigned to Remote SIP-MLT—NAT - NTP Server Port No.
– SIP Extension— Setting parameters assigned to Remote SIP-MLT—NAT - Keep Alive Packet Type
– SIP Extension— Setting parameters assigned to Remote SIP-MLT—NAT - Keep Alive Packet
Sending Interval Time (s)
– SIP Extension— Setting parameters assigned to Remote SIP-MLT—NAT - SIP Register Expire Time
(s)
– SIP Extension— Setting parameters for Networking Survivability, assigned to Remote
SIP-MLT—NAT - CWMP Server IP Address
– SIP Extension— Setting parameters for Networking Survivability, assigned to Remote
SIP-MLT—NAT - CWMP Server (HTTP) Port No.
– SIP Extension— Setting parameters for Networking Survivability, assigned to Remote
SIP-MLT—NAT - CWMP Server (HTTPS) Port No.
– SIP Extension— Control Condition of Remote SIP-MLT—PERIODIC Ability
– SIP Extension— Control Condition of Remote SIP-MLT—PERIODIC Packet Sending Interval Time
(s)
• 11.7.2 PBX Configuration—[3-7-2] Group—UM Group—Unit Settings— Fail Over Site Name
Changed Contents
• 3.1 Home Screen
Changed Contents
• 1.2.1 Starting Web Maintenance Console
• 1.2.2 PC Programming Using Off-line Mode
• 2.1.4 Easy Setup Wizard
• 2.3 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ)
• 7.3.1 Utility—Log—Error Log
• 12.1.4 PBX Configuration—[4-1-4] Extension—Wired Extension—Flexible Button
• 13.3.2 PBX Configuration—[5-3-2] Optional Device—Voice Message—DISA Message
• 19.1 PBX Configuration—[11-1] Maintenance—Main
• 20.1.2 UM Configuration—[1-2] Mailbox Settings—Full Setting
• 24.4 UM Configuration—[5-4] System Parameters—Parameters
Changed Contents
• Introduction
Changed Contents
• 1.2.1 Starting Web Maintenance Console
• 1.2.2 PC Programming Using Off-line Mode
• 2.1.2 Access Levels
• 4.1.3 Status—Equipment Status—PS Information
• 5.1 System Control—Program Update
• 5.1.2 System Control—Program Update—Update Program File
• 5.1.3 System Control—Program Update—Plug and Update
• 7.3.1 Utility—Log—Error Log
• 7.4.4 Utility—Monitor/Trace—Air Sync Group
• 7.5.2 Utility—Report—IP Extension Statistical Information
• 7.7.1 Utility—Email Notification—Alert
• 9.3 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Activation Key Status
• 9.5.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Site Property—Main
• 9.11 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—V-SIPGW—Port Property
• 9.15 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—V-IPEXT32—Port Property
• 9.18 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—V-IPCS4—Card Property
• 9.19 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—V-IPCS4—Port Property
• 9.24 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Card Property - LCO type
• 9.27 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Port Property - BRI Port
• 9.32 PBX Configuration—[1-3] Configuration—Option
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options
• 11.3.1 PBX Configuration—[3-3] Group—Call Pickup Group—All Setting
• 11.5.1 PBX Configuration—[3-5-1] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings
• 11.9 PBX Configuration—[3-9] Group—Conference Group
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings
• 12.1.4 PBX Configuration—[4-1-4] Extension—Wired Extension—Flexible Button
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings
• 12.2.3 PBX Configuration—[4-2-3] Extension—Portable Station—Flexible Button
• 19.2 PBX Configuration—[11-2] Maintenance—CS Synchronisation
• 25.1 UM Configuration—[6] H/W Settings
• 27.10 Router Configuration—VPN—[3-2] IPSec
• 28.2.3 Network Service—[2-4] Server Feature—HTTP
• Feature Programming References
Absent Message
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Absent Message Set /
Cancel
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 3—
Absent Message
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3— Absent
Message
• 14.5 PBX Configuration—[6-5] Feature—Absent Message
Automatic Setup
• 6.2 Tool—BRI Automatic Configuration
• 10.1.1 PBX Configuration—[2-1-1] System—Date & Time—Date & Time Setting
• 10.1.2 PBX Configuration—[2-1-2] System—Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving— Automatic Time
Adjustment—Automatic Time Correction on Stand-alone mode
• 10.1.2.1 PBX Configuration—[2-1-2] System—Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving—Daylight Saving
• 28.2.4 Network Service—[2-5] Server Feature—NTP— NTP server
Budget Management
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 3—
Charge Limit
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3—
Charge Limit
• 14.3 PBX Configuration—[6-3] Feature—Verification Code— Budget Management
• 14.2 PBX Configuration—[6-2] Feature—Hotel & Charge—Charge— Charge Options—Action at Charge
Limit
CA (Communication Assistant)
• 9.5 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Site Property—Port Number— Built-in
Communication Assistant Server
• 10.7.1 PBX Configuration—[2-7-1] System—Class of Service—COS Settings—CA
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options—Option 6 (CTI)
→ Built-in Communication Assistant—System status retry interval timer
→ Built-in Communication Assistant—System status retry counter
Call Hold
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone
– Recall—Hold Recall
– Recall—Disconnect after Recall
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features
– Call Hold / Call Hold Retrieve
– Call Hold Retrieve : Specified with a Holding Extension Number
– Hold Retrieve : Specified with a Held CO Line Number
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options
– Option 1— PT Operation—Automatic Hold by ICM / CO / ICD Group Key
– Option 1— PT Operation—Hold key mode
– Option 5— SLT—SLT Hold Mode
Call Monitor
• 10.6.3 PBX Configuration—[2-6-3] System—Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature— Call Monitor
• 10.7.1 PBX Configuration—[2-7-1] System—Class of Service—COS Settings—Executive— Call Monitor
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings
– Option 2— Data Mode
– Option 3— Executive Override Deny
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3—
Executive Override Deny
Call Park
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters
– Recall—Call Park Recall
– Recall—Disconnect after Recall
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Call Park / Call Park
Retrieve
• 12.1.4 PBX Configuration—[4-1-4] Extension—Wired Extension—Flexible Button
– Type
– Parameter Selection (for Call Park)
– Optional Parameter (Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Call Park)
• 12.2.3 PBX Configuration—[4-2-3] Extension—Portable Station—Flexible Button
– Type
– Parameter Selection (for Call Park)
– Optional Parameter (or Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Call Park)
Call Pickup
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features
– Group Call Pickup
– Directed Call Pickup
– Call Pickup Deny Set / Cancel
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options—Option 4
• 11.3 PBX Configuration—[3-3] Group—Call Pickup Group
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 3— Call
Pickup Deny
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3— Call
Pickup Deny
Call Transfer
• 10.2 PBX Configuration—[2-2] System—Operator & BGM— BGM and Music on Hold—Sound on
Transfer
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone—
Recall—Transfer Recall
• 10.7.1 PBX Configuration—[2-7-1] System—Class of Service—COS Settings
– CO & SMDR— Transfer to CO
– Assistant— Transfer to busy Extension w/o BSS Operation
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options—Option 4— DSS Key—Automatic Transfer
for Extension Call
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 1—
Transfer Recall Destination
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 1—
Transfer Recall Destination
Call Waiting
• 9.24 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Card Property - LCO type— Caller ID—Caller ID
Signalling
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features
– Manual Call Waiting for Extension Call
– Automatic Call Waiting
• 10.6.3 PBX Configuration—[2-6-3] System—Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature
– BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override
– BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override-2
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options—Option 5— Call Waiting—Automatic Call
Waiting for Extension Call
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings
– Option 2— Manual C. Waiting for Extension Call
– Option 2— Automatic C. Waiting
– Option 4— Call Waiting Tone Type
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings
– Option 2— Manual C. Waiting for Extension Call
– Option 2— Automatic C. Waiting
– Option 4— Call Waiting Tone Type
Caller ID
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous
– Caller ID—Waiting to receive
– Caller ID—Visual Caller ID Display
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options—Option 4— Private Network—Public Call
through Private Network—Minimum Public Caller ID Digits
• 10.10 PBX Configuration—[2-10] System—Extension CID Settings
• 11.1.1 PBX Configuration—[3-1-1] Group—Trunk Group—TRG Settings—Main— Caller ID Modification
Table
• 11.1.3 PBX Configuration—[3-1-3] Group—Trunk Group—Caller ID Modification
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 8
– Extension Caller ID Sending
– Incoming Call Wait Timer for Extension Caller ID
• 14.1 PBX Configuration—[6-1] Feature—System Speed Dial
Conference
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters—DISA / Door / Reminder / U. Conf
– Unattended Conference—Recall Start Timer
– Unattended Conference—Warning Tone Start Timer
– Unattended Conference—Disconnect Timer
• 10.7.1 PBX Configuration—[2-7-1] System—Class of Service—COS Settings—CO & SMDR— Transfer
to CO
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options—Option 2— CO - CO Call Limitation—After
Conference
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options—Option 3
– Confirmation Tone—Tone 4-1 : Start Conference
– Confirmation Tone—Tone 4-2 : Finish Conference
– Echo Cancel—Conference
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options—Option 8— Conference Group—Maximum
Number of Speakers During a Conference Group Call
• 12.1.4 PBX Configuration—[4-1-4] Extension—Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Type
• 12.2.3 PBX Configuration—[4-2-3] Extension—Portable Station—Flexible Button— Type
Confirmation Tone
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options—Option 3
– Confirmation Tone—Tone 1 : Called by Voice
– Confirmation Tone—Tone 2 : Paged / Automatic Answer
– Confirmation Tone—Tone 3-1 : Start Talking after Making Call / Call from DOORPHONE
– Confirmation Tone—Tone 3-2 : Start Talking after Answering Call
– Confirmation Tone—Tone 4-1 : Start Conference
– Confirmation Tone—Tone 4-2 : Finish Conference
– Confirmation Tone—Tone 5 : Hold
Dial Tone
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options—Option 3
– Dial Tone—Distinctive Dial Tone
– Dial Tone—Dial Tone for Extension
– Dial Tone—Dial Tone for ARS
– Pulse Speed
Display Information
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options—Option 5— PT Feature Access—No. 1–8
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 5
– Display Language
– Incoming Call Display
– Automatic LCD Switch when Start Talking
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 5
– Display Language
– Incoming Call Display
– Automatic LCD Switch when Start Talking
• 14.2 PBX Configuration—[6-2] Feature—Hotel & Charge—Charge
– Charge Options—Digits After Decimal Point
– Charge Options—Currency
– Charge Options—Currency Display Position
• 18.1 PBX Configuration—[10-1] CO & Incoming Call—CO Line Settings— CO Name
Door Open
• 9.30 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—DOORPHONE Card—Card Property
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters—DISA / Door / Reminder / U. Conf—
Doorphone—Open Duration
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Door Open
• 10.7.1 PBX Configuration—[2-7-1] System—Class of Service—COS Settings—Optional Device & Other
Extensions— Door Unlock
Door Open
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters—DISA / Door / Reminder / U. Conf—
Doorphone—Open Duration
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Door Open
• 10.7.1 PBX Configuration—[2-7-1] System—Class of Service—COS Settings—Optional Device & Other
Extensions— Door Unlock
Doorphone Call
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters—DISA / Door / Reminder / U. Conf
– Doorphone—Call Ring Duration
– Doorphone—Call Duration
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features— DOORPHONE Call
• 10.7.1 PBX Configuration—[2-7-1] System—Class of Service—COS Settings—TRS— TRS
Level—Day, Lunch, Break, Night
• 10.8.2 PBX Configuration—[2-8-2] System—Ring Tone Patterns—Call from DOORPHONE
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options—Option 3— Confirmation Tone—Tone 1 :
Called by Voice
• 13.1 PBX Configuration—[5-1] Optional Device—Doorphone
Emergency Call
• 15.4 PBX Configuration—[7-4] TRS—Emergency Dial
External Sensor
• 9.30 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—DOORPHONE Card—Card Property
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— External Sensor—Ring
Duration
• 10.8.3 PBX Configuration—[2-8-3] System—Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Others— External
Sensor—Ring Tone Pattern Plan 1–8
• 13.5 PBX Configuration—[5-5] Optional Device—External Sensor
Flash/Recall/Terminate
• 9.25 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Port Property - LCO Port— Disconnect Time
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 7— Flash
Mode during CO Conversation
• 12.1.4 PBX Configuration—[4-1-4] Extension—Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Type
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 7— Flash
Mode during CO Conversation
• 12.2.3 PBX Configuration—[4-2-3] Extension—Portable Station—Flexible Button— Type
Flexible Buttons
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— PT Display—PT Last
Display Duration in Idle Mode
• 12.1.4 PBX Configuration—[4-1-4] Extension—Wired Extension—Flexible Button
• 12.1.4.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-4] Extension—Wired Extension—Flexible Button—Flexible button data
copy
• 12.1.5 PBX Configuration—[4-1-5] Extension—Wired Extension—PF Button
• 12.2.3 PBX Configuration—[4-2-3] Extension—Portable Station—Flexible Button
Floating Extension
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Extension
• 11.5.1 PBX Configuration—[3-5-1] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Main
Group
• Section 11 PBX Configuration—[3] Group
Hands-free Answerback
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Tone
Length—Reorder Tone for PT Hands-free
• 10.7.1 PBX Configuration—[2-7-1] System—Class of Service—COS Settings—Assistant— Automatic
Answer (Caller)
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options
– Option 1— PT Operation—Automatic Answer for Call from CO after
– Option 3— Confirmation Tone—Tone 2 : Paged / Automatic Answer
– Option 4— Transfer—Automatic Answer for Transferred Call
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings
– Option 5— Automatic Answer for CO Call
– Option 6— Forced Automatic Answer
Hands-free Operation
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Tone
Length—Reorder Tone for PT Hands-free
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 4— LCS
Answer Mode
Headset Operation
• 12.1.4 PBX Configuration—[4-1-4] Extension—Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Type
Host PBX Access Code (Access Code to the Telephone Company from a Host PBX)
• 11.1.1 PBX Configuration—[3-1-1] Group—Trunk Group—TRG Settings—Host PBX Access Code
• 19.1 PBX Configuration—[11-1] Maintenance—Main—SMDR Options— Option—ARS Dial
2.5.4.8 Host PBX Access Code (Access Code to the Telephone Company from a Host PBX)
Hot Line
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Dial—Hot
Line (Pickup Dial) Start
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Hot Line (Pickup Dial)
Program Set / Cancel
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 2
– Pickup Dial Set
– Pickup Dial No.
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 2
– Pickup Dial Set
– Pickup Dial No.
Intercept Routing
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Intercept
Routing No Answer (IRNA)—Day, Lunch, Break, Night
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters—DISA / Door / Reminder / U. Conf—
DISA—Intercept Timer—Day, Lunch, Break, Night
• 11.5.1 PBX Configuration—[3-5-1] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Overflow
No Answer— Time out & Manual Queue Redirection—Destination-Day, Lunch, Break, Night
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings
– Intercept Destination
– Intercept No Answer Time
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings
– Intercept Destination
– Intercept No Answer Time
• 18.5 PBX Configuration—[10-5] CO & Incoming Call—Miscellaneous
Intercom Call
• 10.6.3 PBX Configuration—[2-6-3] System—Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature— Alternate
Calling - Ring / Voice
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings
– Main— Extension Number
– Main— Extension Name
– Option 3— Intercom Call by Voice
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main
– Extension Number
– Extension Name
IP-CS (KX-NS0154)
• 7.4.4 Utility—Monitor/Trace—Air Sync Group
• 7.4.5 Utility—Monitor/Trace—LAN Sync Group
• 7.5.5 Utility—Report—IP-CS Information
• 9.5.1 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Site Property—Main—Main
– LLDP Packet Sending Ability
ISDN Extension
• 9.27 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—ISDN Extension
• 9.28 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Extension Setting
LED Indication
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options
– Option 1— PT Fwd / DND—Fwd LED
– Option 1— PT Fwd / DND—DND LED
Line Preference—Incoming
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 4—
Incoming Preferred Line
Line Preference—Outgoing
• 10.7.2 PBX Configuration—[2-7-2] System—Class of Service—External Call Block
• 11.1.2 PBX Configuration—[3-1-2] Group—Trunk Group—Local Access Priority
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 4—
Outgoing Preferred Line
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 4—
Outgoing Preferred Line
Log-in/Log-out
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features
– Log-in / Log-out
– Not Ready (Manual Wrap-up) Mode On / Off
• 11.5.1 PBX Configuration—[3-5-1] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group
Settings—Miscellaneous
– No. of Unanswered Calls for Automatic Log-out
– Last Extension Log-out
• 11.5.1.1 PBX Configuration—[3-5-1] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member
List— Wrap-up Timer
• 11.5.3 PBX Configuration—[3-5-3] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous—
Options—Wrap-up Timer based on
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 8—
Wrap-up Timer
• 12.1.4 PBX Configuration—[4-1-4] Extension—Wired Extension—Flexible Button
– Type
– Parameter Selection (for Log-in/Log-out)
– Extension Number (for Log-in/Log-out)
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 8—
Wrap-up Timer
Manager Features
• 10.7.1 PBX Configuration—[2-7-1] System—Class of Service—COS Settings—Manager— Manager
• 19.1 PBX Configuration—[11-1] Maintenance—Main—Password— Manager Password - PT
Programming—Prog *1
Message Waiting
• 9.17 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—V-SIPEXT32—Port Property
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Message Waiting
Set / Cancel / Call Back
• 10.6.3 PBX Configuration—[2-6-3] System—Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature— Message
Waiting Set
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options
– Option 3— Dial Tone—Distinctive Dial Tone
– Option 5— SLT—Message Waiting Lamp Pattern
• 12.1.4 PBX Configuration—[4-1-4] Extension—Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Type
• 12.2.3 PBX Configuration—[4-2-3] Extension—Portable Station—Flexible Button— Type
Music on Hold
• 10.2 PBX Configuration—[2-2] System—Operator & BGM
• 10.11.1 PBX Configuration—[2-11-1] System—Audio Gain—Paging/MOH
– External MOH—MOH 1 (Music On Hold 1)
Off-hook Monitor
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options—Option 1— PT Operation—Off Hook Monitor
One-look Networking
• 1.2.3 PBX Configuration Types
• 3.1.1 Home Screen—Add Site Wizard
• 2.1.4 Easy Setup Wizard
One-numbered Extension
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Parallel Telephone
(Ring) Mode Set / Cancel
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings
– Option 1— Wireless XDP / Shared Extension
– Option 1— Ring Pattern Table
– Option 5— Automatic Answer for CO Call
– Option 6— Forced Automatic Answer
– Option 7— ISDN Bearer
One-touch Dialling
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 6—
Flexible Button Programming Mode
• 12.1.4 PBX Configuration—[4-1-4] Extension—Wired Extension—Flexible Button
– Type
– Dial (for One-touch)
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 6—
Flexible Button Programming Mode
• 12.2.3 PBX Configuration—[4-2-3] Extension—Portable Station—Flexible Button
– Type
– Dial (for One-touch)
Operator Features
• 10.2 PBX Configuration—[2-2] System—Operator & BGM— PBX Operator—Day, Lunch, Break, Night
• 14.6 PBX Configuration—[6-6] Feature—Tenant— Operator (Extension Number)
Overflow Feature
• 11.5.1 PBX Configuration—[3-5-1] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings
– Overflow Queuing Busy
– Overflow No Answer
• 11.5.2 PBX Configuration—[3-5-2] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Queuing Time Table
• 11.5.3 PBX Configuration—[3-5-3] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous—
Options—Overflow immediately when All Logout
Paging
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features
– Group Paging
– Group Paging Answer
– Paging Deny Set / Cancel
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options
– Option 1— PT Fwd / DND—Paging to DND Extension
– Option 3— Confirmation Tone—Tone 2 : Paged / Automatic Answer
• 10.11.1 PBX Configuration—[2-11-1] System—Audio Gain—Paging/MOH
– Paging—EPG 1 (External Pager 1)
– Paging—Paging Level from PT Speaker
• 11.4 PBX Configuration—[3-4] Group—Paging Group
• 11.4.1 PBX Configuration—[3-4] Group—Paging Group—All Setting
Pause Insertion
• 9.25 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Port Property - LCO Port— Pause Time
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— During
Conversation—Pause Signal Time
• 14.4 PBX Configuration—[6-4] Feature—Second Dial Tone
Ping
• 7.1.2 Utility—Diagnosis—Ping
Printing Message
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Printing Message
• 14.2 PBX Configuration—[6-2] Feature—Hotel & Charge—Main— SMDR for External Hotel Application
2—Printing Message 1–8
Privacy Release
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options—Option 1— PT Operation—Privacy Release
by SCO key
• 12.1.4 PBX Configuration—[4-1-4] Extension—Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Type
• 12.2.3 PBX Configuration—[4-2-3] Extension—Portable Station—Flexible Button— Type
PS Directory
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— Extension
Name
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— Extension
Name
• 14.1 PBX Configuration—[6-1] Feature—System Speed Dial
– Name
– CO Line Access Number + Telephone Number
PS Ring Group
• 11.5.1 PBX Configuration—[3-5-1] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Main—
Distribution Method
• 11.8 PBX Configuration—[3-8] Group—PS Ring Group
• 11.8.1 PBX Configuration—[3-8] Group—PS Ring Group—Member List
PT Programming
• 10.7.1 PBX Configuration—[2-7-1] System—Class of Service—COS Settings—Manager— PT
Programming Mode
• 19.1 PBX Configuration—[11-1] Maintenance—Main—Password
– Manager Password - PT Programming—Prog *1
Queuing Feature
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Incoming Call Queue
Monitor
• 11.5.1 PBX Configuration—[3-5-1] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings
– Overflow Queuing Busy
– Overflow No Answer
– Queuing Time Table
– Miscellaneous— Extension No Answer Redirection Time
– Miscellaneous— Maximum No. of Busy Extension
• 11.5.3 PBX Configuration—[3-5-3] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous
• 11.7.1 PBX Configuration—[3-7-1] Group—UM Group—System Settings— Call Waiting on VM Group
• 12.1.4 PBX Configuration—[4-1-4] Extension—Wired Extension—Flexible Button
– Type
– Extension Number (for Hurry-up)
• 12.2.3 PBX Configuration—[4-2-3] Extension—Portable Station—Flexible Button
– Type
– Extension Number (for Hurry-up)
Quick Dialling
• 10.6.2 PBX Configuration—[2-6-2] System—Numbering Plan—Quick Dial
Reverse Circuit
• 9.25 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Port Property - LCO Port— Reverse Detection
Software Upgrading
• 5.1 System Control—Program Update
Speed Dialling—Personal/System
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features
– System Speed Dialling / Personal Speed Dialling
– Personal Speed Dialling - Programming
• 10.7.1 PBX Configuration—[2-7-1] System—Class of Service—COS Settings—TRS— TRS Level for
System Speed Dialling
• 12.1.3 PBX Configuration—[4-1-3] Extension—Wired Extension—Speed Dial
• 14.1 PBX Configuration—[6-1] Feature—System Speed Dial
• 14.6 PBX Configuration—[6-6] Feature—Tenant
– Extension Directory
– System Speed Dial
Supervisory Feature
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Incoming Call Queue
Monitor
• 11.5.1 PBX Configuration—[3-5-1] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group
Settings—Miscellaneous— Supervisor Extension Number
Tenant Service
• 10.2 PBX Configuration—[2-2] System—Operator & BGM
– PBX Operator—Day, Lunch, Break, Night
– BGM and Music on Hold—Music on Hold
• 10.4 PBX Configuration—[2-4] System—Week Table
• 10.5 PBX Configuration—[2-5] System—Holiday Table
• 10.7.3 PBX Configuration—[2-7-3] System—Class of Service—Internal Call Block
• 11.2 PBX Configuration—[3-2] Group—User Group
• 11.5.1 PBX Configuration—[3-5-1] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Main—
Tenant Number
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— User
Group
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— User
Group
• 13.1 PBX Configuration—[5-1] Optional Device—Doorphone— Tenant Number
• 13.5 PBX Configuration—[5-5] Optional Device—External Sensor— Tenant No.
• 14.6 PBX Configuration—[6-6] Feature—Tenant
• Section 16 PBX Configuration—[8] ARS
• 16.5 PBX Configuration—[8-5] ARS—Carrier—Authorisation Code for Tenant
• 18.2 PBX Configuration—[10-2] CO & Incoming Call—DIL Table & Port Settings—DIL— Tenant Number
• 18.3 PBX Configuration—[10-3] CO & Incoming Call—DDI / DID Table— Tenant Number
• 18.4 PBX Configuration—[10-4] CO & Incoming Call—MSN Table—MSN— Tenant Number
Time Service
• 10.4 PBX Configuration—[2-4] System—Week Table
• 10.5 PBX Configuration—[2-5] System—Holiday Table
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Time Service (Day /
Lunch / Break / Night) Switch
• 10.7.1 PBX Configuration—[2-7-1] System—Class of Service—COS Settings—Manager— Time Service
Switch
• 12.1.4 PBX Configuration—[4-1-4] Extension—Wired Extension—Flexible Button
– Type
– Parameter Selection (for Time Service)
– Parameter Selection (for Time Service - Automatic/Manual)
– Optional Parameter (Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Time Service)
• 12.2.3 PBX Configuration—[4-2-3] Extension—Portable Station—Flexible Button
– Type
– Parameter Selection (for Time Service)
– Parameter Selection (for Time Service - Automatic/Manual)
– Optional Parameter (or Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Time Service)
Timed Reminder
• 10.3 PBX Configuration—[2-3] System—Timers & Counters—DISA / Door / Reminder / U. Conf
Trunk Access
• 9.23 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—SLC2 - Port Property— Connection
• 9.25 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Port Property - LCO Port— Connection
• 9.27 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Port Property - BRI Port— Connection
• 9.28 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—Port Property - PRI Port— Connection
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features
– Idle Line Access (Local Access)
– Trunk Group Access
– Single CO Line Access
• 10.7.2 PBX Configuration—[2-7-2] System—Class of Service—External Call Block
UM Group Failover
• 11.7.2 PBX Configuration—[3-7-2] Group—UM Group—Unit Settings— Fail Over Site Name
Unified Messaging—Hold
• 23.1 UM Configuration—[4-1] Service Settings—Caller ID / PIN Call Routing—23.2 UM
Configuration—[4-2] Service Settings—Parameters
– Operator Service—Busy Coverage Mode
– Call Hold Mode
– Call Hold Mode—Call Queuing Announcement Mode
– Call Hold Mode—Call Retrieval Announcement Timing (1-30 s)
Unified Messaging—Mailbox
• 7.5.3 Utility—Report—UM View Reports
• 20.1 UM Configuration—[1] Mailbox Settings
User Profiles
• Section 8 Users
• Section 12 PBX Configuration—[4] Extension
• Section 20 UM Configuration—[1] Mailbox Settings
VIP Call
• 11.5.1 PBX Configuration—[3-5-1] Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group
Settings—Miscellaneous— VIP Call Mode
Virtual PS
• 9.31 PBX Configuration—[1-2] Configuration—Portable Station— Registration
Walking COS
• 10.6.1 PBX Configuration—[2-6-1] System—Numbering Plan—Main—Features— User Remote
Operation / Walking COS / Verification Code
• 10.7.1 PBX Configuration—[2-7-1] System—Class of Service—COS Settings—Optional Device & Other
Extensions— Remote Operation by Other Extension
• 12.1.1 PBX Configuration—[4-1-1] Extension—Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— Extension
PIN
• 12.2.1 PBX Configuration—[4-2-1] Extension—Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— Extension
PIN
Whisper OHCA
• 9.15 PBX Configuration—[1-1] Configuration—Slot—V-IPEXT32—Port Property—Option— IP Codec
Priority
• 10.6.3 PBX Configuration—[2-6-3] System—Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature
– BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override
– BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override-2
• 10.7.1 PBX Configuration—[2-7-1] System—Class of Service—COS Settings—Assistant— OHCA /
Whisper OHCA
• 10.9 PBX Configuration—[2-9] System—System Options—Option 5— Whisper OHCA—for SLT
Copyright:
This material is copyrighted by Panasonic System Networks Co., Ltd., and may be reproduced for internal use
only. All other reproduction, in whole or in part, is prohibited without the written consent of Panasonic System
Networks Co., Ltd.
PNQX3643PA DD1111HH10074